PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
497, 1996-05-03
Previous: WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST, 497, 1996-05-03
Next: AIRTOUCH COMMUNICATIONS, S-4, 1996-05-03



<PAGE>
 
   
Prospectus                                                     May 1, 1996     
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                        THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY
                                ISSUED THROUGH
                      PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
                         BY PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
  This Prospectus describes the PFL Wright flexible premium group and individ-
ual variable annuity contracts offered by PFL Life Insurance Company ("PFL").
The Group Contract is designed primarily for use by bank trust and agency ac-
counts (although it may be issued in other circumstances). A separate Certifi-
cate under the Group Contract, or an individual policy will be issued to the
bank trust or agency account (as nominee or agent or trustee) for each Partic-
ipant on whose behalf an annuity is purchased. An individual annuity policy
and a Certificate under a Group Contract may also be issued in certain other
circumstances. The term "Certificate" refers both to an individual certificate
issued under a Group Contract and to an individual annuity policy, and the
term "Certificate Owner" refers to both the owner of an individual annuity
policy and to the owner of a Certificate issued under a Group Contract, as the
case may be.
  Premium payments may be allocated to one or more Subaccounts of the PFL
Wright Variable Annuity Account (the "Variable Account") or to the Fixed Ac-
count or both. The Variable Account has four different Subaccounts (the
"Subaccounts"). Assets of each Subaccount are invested in a corresponding
portfolio ("Portfolio") of a mutual fund, the Wright Managed Blue Chip Series
Trust (the "Trust"). The Trust currently has four Portfolios available for in-
vestment: the Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio; the Wright Total Return Bond
Portfolio; the Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio; and the Wright Interna-
tional Blue Chip Portfolio. The Portfolios are described in a separate pro-
spectus that accompanies this Prospectus.
  The value of a Certificate will vary in accordance with the investment per-
formance of the Subaccounts of the Variable Account selected by the Certifi-
cate Owner. Therefore, the Participant or individual policy owner bears the
entire investment risk for all amounts allocated to the Variable Account. PFL
guarantees that all amounts allocated to the Fixed Account will be returned
with at least 3% interest per year, after any Excess Interest Adjustment on
premature withdrawals or transfers out of the Fixed Account.
   
  THE CERTIFICATE IS NOT A DEPOSIT OR OBLIGATION OF, OR GUARANTEED OR ENDORSED
BY, ANY BANK OR DEPOSITORY INSTITUTION, AND THE CERTIFICATE IS NOT FEDERALLY
INSURED BY THE FEDERAL DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION OR ANY OTHER AGENCY, AND
INVOLVES INVESTMENT RISK, INCLUDING POSSIBLE LOSS OF PRINCIPAL AMOUNT INVEST-
ED.     
  THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION NOR HAS THE COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADE-
QUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OF-
FENSE.
  This Prospectus sets forth the information that a prospective investor
should consider before investing in a Certificate. A Statement of Additional
Information about the Certificate and the Variable Account, which has the same
date as this Prospectus, has been filed with the Securities and Exchange Com-
mission and is incorporated herein by reference. The Statement of Additional
Information is available at no cost to any person requesting a copy by writing
PFL at the Administrative and Service Office or by calling 1-800-525-6205. The
table of contents of the Statement of Additional Information is included at
the end of this Prospectus.
  THIS PROSPECTUS MUST BE ACCOMPANIED OR PRECEDED BY A CURRENT PROSPECTUS FOR
THE WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST
 
WVA  Please Read this Prospectus Carefully and Retain it For Future Reference.
 
                                       1
<PAGE>
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
  Page
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<TABLE>   
<S>                                                                          <C>
DEFINITIONS................................................................   3
SUMMARY....................................................................   6
CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION............................................  12
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS.......................................................  13
PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY.................................................  13
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT....................................  14
 The Variable Account......................................................  14
 The Portfolios............................................................  14
 Addition, Deletion or Substitution of Investments.........................  15
THE FIXED ACCOUNT..........................................................  16
 Guaranteed Periods........................................................  17
 Guaranteed Interest Rates.................................................  18
BANK TRUST OR AGENCY ARRANGEMENTS..........................................  19
THE CERTIFICATES...........................................................  19
 Issuance of a Certificate.................................................  19
 Certificate Owner.........................................................  20
 Premium Payments..........................................................  20
 Annuity Purchase Value....................................................  21
 Transfers.................................................................  22
 Dollar Cost Averaging.....................................................  22
 Telephone Transactions....................................................  23
DISTRIBUTIONS UNDER THE CERTIFICATES.......................................  23
 Withdrawals...............................................................  23
 Systematic Withdrawal Plan................................................  25
 Annuity Payments..........................................................  25
 Annuity Payment Options...................................................  26
 Death Benefit.............................................................  29
 Restrictions Under the Texas Optional Retirement Program..................  31
 Restrictions Under Section 403(b) Plans...................................  31
 Restrictions Under Other Qualified Certificates...........................  31
CHARGES AND DEDUCTIONS.....................................................  32
 Excess Interest Adjustment................................................  32
 Mortality and Expense Risk Charge.........................................  33
 Administrative Charges....................................................  34
 Premium Taxes.............................................................  34
 Federal, State and Local Taxes............................................  34
 Transfer Charge...........................................................  34
 Other Expenses............................................................  35
HISTORICAL PERFORMANCE DATA................................................  35
 Standardized Performance Data.............................................  35
 Non-Standardized Performance Data.........................................  36
CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES....................................  36
 Tax Status of the Certificates............................................  37
 Taxation of Annuities.....................................................  39
DISTRIBUTOR OF THE CERTIFICATES............................................  43
VOTING RIGHTS..............................................................  43
LEGAL PROCEEDINGS..........................................................  43
APPENDIX A - Excess Interest Adjustment Calculations.......................  44
APPENDIX B - Statement of Additional Information - Table of Contents.......  46
</TABLE>    
 
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                       2
<PAGE>
 
                                  DEFINITIONS
 
ACCUMULATION UNIT - An accounting unit of measure used in calculating the An-
nuity Purchase Value in the Variable Account.
 
ADMINISTRATIVE AND SERVICE OFFICE - Financial Markets Division, Variable Annu-
ity Dept., 4333 Edgewood Road, N.E., Cedar Rapids, Iowa 52499-0001.
 
ANNUITANT - The person entitled to receive Annuity Payments after the Annuity
Commencement Date and during whose life any Annuity Payments involving life
contingencies will continue. The Participant or Policy Owner will normally be
the Annuitant and must be a natural person.
 
ANNUITY COMMENCEMENT DATE - The date upon which Annuity Payments are to com-
mence.
 
ANNUITY PAYMENT - One of a series of payments under an Annuity Payment Option.
 
ANNUITY PAYMENT OPTION OR PAYMENT OPTION - A method of receiving a stream of
Annuity Payments.
 
ANNUITY PURCHASE VALUE - The sum of the value of all Accumulation Units cred-
ited to a Certificate in the Variable Account and the value of the Fixed Ac-
count credited to a Certificate, which will be equal to premiums paid, minus
any partial withdrawals, including any applicable Excess Interest Adjustments
on prior withdrawals or transfers, plus accumulated gains or losses in the
Variable Account, accumulated interest in the Fixed Account, minus any appli-
cable charges, premium taxes, and transfer fees, if any.
 
ANNUITY UNIT - An accounting unit of measure used in the calculation of the
amount of the second and each subsequent Variable Annuity Payment.
 
BENEFICIARY - Before the Annuity Commencement Date, the person to whom the
death proceeds will be paid if the Annuitant dies. After the Annuity Commence-
ment Date, the person to whom the remaining portion of Annuity Payments, if
any, will be made if the Annuitant dies.
 
BUSINESS DAY - A day when the New York Stock Exchange is open for business and
that is a regular business day of the Administrative and Service Office.
 
CASH VALUE - The Annuity Purchase Value less any applicable premium taxes and
increased or decreased by any applicable Excess Interest Adjustment.
 
CERTIFICATE - (i) A separate certificate that is issued under a Group Contract
or (ii) an individual annuity policy.
 
                                       3
<PAGE>
 
CERTIFICATE OWNER - In the case of Certificates issued under a Group Contract,
generally the bank trust or agency account to which such Certificates are is-
sued (that is, the bank or its trust department, as nominee, agent, or trust-
ee), and, in the case of an individual annuity policy, the Policy Owner.
 
CODE - The Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.
 
DATE OF ISSUE - The date the Certificate is issued, as shown on the Certifi-
cate Data Page.
 
DUE PROOF OF DEATH - A certified copy of a death certificate, a certified copy
of a decree of a court of competent jurisdiction as to the finding of death, a
written statement by the attending physician, or any other proof satisfactory
to PFL will constitute Due Proof of Death.
 
EXPIRATION DATE - The expiration date of a Guaranteed Period.
 
FIXED ACCOUNT - PFL's general account, consisting of all of PFL's assets other
than those in the Variable Account or any other segregated asset account of
PFL.
 
FIXED ACCOUNT VALUE - The portion of the Annuity Purchase Value allocated to
the Fixed Account.
 
FIXED ANNUITY PAYMENTS - Payments made pursuant to an Annuity Payment Option
which do not fluctuate in amount.
 
GROUP CONTRACT - A group flexible premium variable annuity contract, generally
issued to a trust (e.g., the Group Contract owner) by PFL under which Certifi-
cates are issued to bank trust or agency accounts with respect to individual
Participants in those trust or agency accounts.
 
GUARANTEED PERIOD AMOUNT - Any portion of Annuity Purchase Value allocated to
a specific Guaranteed Period with a specific expiration date (including inter-
est earned thereon).
 
GUARANTEED INTEREST RATE - The rate of interest credited by PFL on a compound
annual basis during a Guaranteed Period.
 
GUARANTEED PERIOD - The period of at least one year for which interest at the
Guaranteed Interest Rate will be credited to any amounts allocated to the
Fixed Account.
 
NONQUALIFIED CERTIFICATE - A Certificate other than a Qualified Certificate.
 
PFL - PFL Life Insurance Company, the issuer of the Group Contract and Certif-
icates.
 
PARTICIPANT - The person on whose behalf a Certificate under a Group Contract
is issued to a bank trust or agency account.
 
POLICY OWNER - The Owner of an individual annuity policy.
 
                                       4
<PAGE>
 
PORTFOLIOS - The portfolios of the Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust, a
diversified, open-end management company in which the Variable Account in-
vests.
 
QUALIFIED CERTIFICATE - A Certificate that receives favorable tax treatment
under Section 401(a), 403(a), 403(b), 408(a), 408(b) or 457. NOTE: THE USE OF
BANK TRUST OR AGENCY ARRANGEMENTS MAY NOT BE SUITABLE FOR CERTAIN TYPES OF
QUALIFIED CERTIFICATES.
 
SUBACCOUNT - A segregated account within the Variable Account which invests in
a specified Portfolio of the Trust.
 
SUBACCOUNT VALUE - The sum of the value of all Accumulation Units allocated to
a Subaccount for any particular Valuation Period.
 
TRUST - The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust, the open-end diversified
management investment company in which the Variable Account invests.
 
VALUATION PERIOD - The period of time from the close of the New York Stock Ex-
change on one Business Day to the close of the Exchange on the next Business
Day.
 
VARIABLE ACCOUNT OR ACCOUNT - The PFL Wright Variable Annuity Account, a sepa-
rate account established and registered as a unit investment trust under the
Investment Company Act of 1940 to which premium payments may be allocated and
which invests in the Trust.
 
VARIABLE ANNUITY PAYMENTS - Payments made pursuant to an Annuity Payment Op-
tion which fluctuate as to dollar amount or payment term in relation to the
investment performance of the specified Subaccounts within the Variable Ac-
count.
 
WRITTEN NOTICE OR WRITTEN REQUEST - A written notice from the Certificate
Owner that gives PFL the information it requires and is received at the Admin-
istrative and Service Office.
 
  THIS PROSPECTUS AND THE STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION GENERALLY DE-
SCRIBE ONLY THE VARIABLE ACCOUNT, EXCEPT WHEN THE FIXED ACCOUNT IS SPECIFI-
CALLY MENTIONED.
 
THIS PROSPECTUS DOES NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFERING IN ANY JURISDICTION IN WHICH
SUCH OFFERING MAY NOT LAWFULLY BE MADE. NO DEALER, SALESPERSON OR OTHER PERSON
IS AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY INFORMATION OR MAKE ANY REPRESENTATIONS IN CONNEC-
TION WITH THIS OFFERING OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS, AND, IF
GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH OTHER INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST NOT BE RELIED
UPON.
 
    ADMINISTRATIVE AND SERVICE OFFICE:
    Financial Markets Division - Variable Annuity Dept.
    4333 Edgewood Road, N.E.
    Cedar Rapids, Iowa 52499-0001
 
                                       5
<PAGE>
 
                        THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY
 
                                    SUMMARY
 
THE CERTIFICATES
 
  The PFL Wright Variable Annuity is a flexible premium group and individual
variable annuity contract. Certificates can be purchased on a non-tax-quali-
fied basis ("Nonqualified Certificates") or with the proceeds from certain
plans qualifying for favorable federal income tax treatment ("Qualified Cer-
tificates"). Certificates under the Group Contract generally are sold in con-
nection with bank trust or agency arrangements. Under such arrangements, the
Certificate is legally or nominally owned by the bank trust or agency account
(that is, by the bank or its trust department as nominee, agent, or trustee)
for the benefit of a bank client. Accordingly, as used herein, the term "Cer-
tificate Owner" means the bank trust or agency account, and the term "Partici-
pant" refers to the bank client on whose behalf the bank trust or agency ac-
count purchases the Certificate. The Certificate Owner directs the amount and
allocation of premium payments among one or more Subaccounts of the PFL Wright
Variable Annuity Account (the "Variable Account") of PFL Life Insurance Com-
pany ("PFL"), one or more Guaranteed Periods of the Fixed Account, or a combi-
nation of both. The Certificate Owner also may choose to make additional pre-
mium payments, transfers, withdrawals, and other choices under the Certifi-
cate. The terms of a bank trust or agency arrangement may affect the tax
treatment of the Certificate to the Participant, and these arrangements may
not be suitable for certain types of Qualified Certificates. Individual annu-
ity policies (also referred to as "Certificates") may be issued in certain
circumstances.
 
THE VARIABLE ACCOUNT
 
  The Variable Account is a separate account of PFL, which invests exclusively
in shares of the Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust (the "Trust"). The
Trust is a mutual fund whose investment adviser is Wright Investors' Service.
The Trust currently has four Portfolios: the Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio;
the Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio; the Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfo-
lio; and the Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio. Each of the four
Subaccounts of the Variable Account invests solely in a corresponding Portfo-
lio of the Trust. Because the Annuity Purchase Value may depend on the invest-
ment experience of the selected Subaccounts, the Participant or the Policy
Owner bears the entire investment risk with respect to premium payments and
transfers allocated to the Variable Account. (See the "Variable Account," p.
14.)
 
FIXED ACCOUNT
 
  Values under the Certificates may be accumulated on a fixed basis whereby a
premium payment is allocated to one or more Guaranteed Periods available in
connection with the Fixed Account. Each Guaranteed Period available within the
Fixed Account has a specified duration of at least one year. The Fixed Account
is the general account of PFL (See "The Fixed Account," p. 15.) PFL guarantees
these amounts and specifies various interest rates (the "Guaranteed Interest
Rates") which will be earned by amounts allocated to each particular Guaran-
teed Period within the Fixed Account if the amounts remain in that Guaranteed
Period for the duration of the
 
                                       6
<PAGE>
 
Guaranteed Period. PFL may not change a Guaranteed Interest Rate for the dura-
tion of the Guaranteed Period. PFL will credit interest at a rate of not less
than three percent (3%) per year, compounded annually, to amounts allocated to
any of the Guaranteed Periods within the Fixed Account. However, Guaranteed
Interest Rates applicable to subsequent Guaranteed Periods cannot be predicted
and will be determined at the sole discretion of PFL (subject to the minimum
guarantee of three percent (3%)). There is no assurance that Guaranteed Inter-
est Rates will ever exceed 3% per year. Amounts that are withdrawn or trans-
ferred prior to the end of the Guaranteed Period will be subject to an Excess
Interest Adjustment. The Excess Interest Adjustment could be positive or nega-
tive. (See "Example of Excess Interest Adjustment" p. 44.)
 
PREMIUM PAYMENTS
 
  Each Certificate may be purchased with an initial premium payment of at
least $5,000 for a Nonqualified Certificate and $1,000 for a Qualified Certif-
icate. Additional premium payments of at least $500 each may be made at any
time before the Annuity Commencement Date. The minimum initial and subsequent
premium payment is $50 for tax deferred Section 403(b) Annuities. Currently,
there is nothing deducted from premium payments, so all funds are invested im-
mediately.
 
  On the Date of Issue, the initial premium payment is allocated among the
Subaccounts of the Variable Account and the Guaranteed Periods of the Fixed
Account in accordance with the allocation percentages specified by the Certif-
icate Owner. Any allocation must be in whole percentages, and the total allo-
cation must equal 100%. Allocations for additional premium payments may be
changed by the Certificate Owner sending Written Notice to the Administrative
and Service Office. (See "Premium Payments," p. 20.)
 
WITHDRAWALS
 
  All or a portion of the Cash Value may be withdrawn ($500 minimum) by the
Certificate Owner in exchange for a cash withdrawal payment from PFL at any-
time prior to the earlier of the Annuitant's death or the Annuity Commencement
Date. The Cash Value equals the Annuity Purchase Value less any applicable
premium taxes and, except during the 30 days prior to the expiration of a
Guaranteed Period, plus or minus any Excess Interest Adjustment. The Annuity
Purchase Value is equal to premiums paid, minus any partial withdrawals, plus
or minus any applicable Excess Interest Adjustments on prior withdrawals or
transfers, plus or minus accumulated gains or losses in the Variable Account,
plus accumulated interest in the Fixed Account, minus any applicable charges,
premium taxes, and transfer fees, if any. A withdrawal request must be made by
Written Request, and a request for a partial withdrawal must specify the
Subaccounts or the Guaranteed Period from which the withdrawal is requested.
There is currently no limit on the frequency or timing of withdrawals. (See
"Withdrawals," p. 23.) Withdrawals may be taxable and subject to a penalty tax
and withdrawals from the Fixed Account may be subject to an Excess Interest
Adjustment. Withdrawals with respect to Qualified Certificates may be re-
stricted or penalized by the terms of the applicable retirement plan or appli-
cable law.
 
TRANSFERS
 
  A Certificate Owner may transfer the Annuity Purchase Value among the
Subaccounts and, prior to the Annuity Commencement Date, to or from the Fixed
Account with certain limitations. The minimum amount which may be transferred
is the lesser of $500 or the entire portion of the
 
                                       7
<PAGE>
 
Annuity Purchase Value held in that Subaccount or Guaranteed Period. However,
after a transfer out of a particular Subaccount or Guaranteed Period, at least
$500 must remain in that Subaccount or Guaranteed Period. Transfers from a
Guaranteed Period will, except during the 30 days prior to the expiration of
the Guaranteed Period, be subject to an Excess Interest Adjustment (which
could be positive or negative). Transfers currently may be made as frequently
as desired either by telephone (subject to the provisions described below un-
der "Telephone Transactions," p. 23) or by sending Written Notice to the Ad-
ministrative and Service Office.
 
  A charge may be imposed for any transfers in excess of 12 per Certificate
Year, but currently there is no charge for any transfers. (See "Transfers, "
p. 22.)
 
CHARGES AND DEDUCTIONS
 
  EXCESS INTEREST ADJUSTMENT. An Excess Interest Adjustment may be applied in
the event of any premature withdrawal or transfer of amounts allocated to a
Guaranteed Period of the Fixed Account. The Excess Interest Adjustment does
not apply during the 30 days prior to the end of a Guaranteed Period or to
amounts invested in the Variable Account.
 
  The Excess Interest Adjustment may increase or decrease the amount payable
by PFL upon withdrawal or transfer. It is based on a comparison of PFL's de-
clared rates of interest at the time of withdrawal or transfer with the
rate(s) of interest applicable to the amount(s) withdrawn or transferred. The
Excess Interest Adjustment will be added to or subtracted from the gross
amount being withdrawn or transferred. The Excess Interest Adjustment will
never result in a reduction of the annual rate of interest credited to less
than 3%. (See "Excess Interest Adjustment," p. 32.)
 
  VARIABLE ACCOUNT CHARGES. PFL deducts a daily charge equal to a percentage
of the net assets in the Variable Account for the mortality and expense risks
assumed by PFL. The effective annual rate of this charge, which is guaranteed
not to increase, is 1.00% of the value of the Variable Account's net assets.
(See "Mortality and Expense Risk Charge," p. 33.)
 
  ADMINISTRATIVE CHARGES. There is also an annual Administrative Charge each
year for administrative expenses. This charge is $30 per year. Currently,
there is no fee for transfers, but in the future, a charge of $25 may be im-
posed for each transfer in excess of 12 in any year. (See "Administrative
Charges," p. 34.)
 
  TAXES. PFL may incur premium taxes relating to the Certificates. PFL will
deduct any premium taxes related to a particular Certificate from the Annuity
Purchase Value upon complete withdrawal of the Annuity Purchase Value, at pay-
ment of the death benefit, or at the Annuity Commencement Date. (See "Premium
Taxes," p. 34.)
 
  No charges are currently made against the Subaccounts for federal, state, or
local income taxes or the economic burdens of such taxes. PFL may deduct
charges in the future for such taxes or economic burdens from the Certificate
or from amounts held in the relevant Subaccount. (See "Federal, State and Lo-
cal Taxes," p. 34.)
 
 
                                       8
<PAGE>
 
  CHARGES AGAINST THE PORTFOLIOS. The value of the net assets of the
Subaccounts of the Variable Account will reflect the investment advisory fee
and other expenses incurred by the Portfolios.
 
  FEE TABLE. The charges and deductions with respect to the Variable Account
are summarized in the following tables. These tables assume that the entire
Annuity Purchase Value is in the Variable Account. The following tables are
intended to assist in understanding the various costs and expenses that will
be borne, directly or indirectly. These include the expenses of the Portfo-
lios. (See "Charges and Deductions," p. 32, and the Trust's prospectus.) In
addition to the expenses listed below, premium taxes may be applicable.
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                 Near Term Total Return Selected  International
Transaction Expenses               Bond        Bond     Blue Chip   Blue Chip
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                              <C>       <C>          <C>       <C>
Sales Load on Purchase Payments      $0          $0         $0          $0
Withdrawal Charge                    $0          $0         $0          $0
                                -----------------------------------------------
Annual Certificate Charge        $30 Per Certificate
                                -----------------------------------------------
Transfer Fee                     First 12 Transfers Per Year: NO FEE
                                 More than 12 in One Year: Currently no fee
 
Variable Account Annual Expenses
(as a percentage of account value)
 
Mortality and Expense              1.00%       1.00%      1.00%       1.00%
  Risk Fees
</TABLE>
 
Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust Annual Expenses*
(as a percentage of average net assets)
 
<TABLE>
<S>                                     <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>   <C>
  Investment Adviser Fee
    (after reduction)(1)                0.25% 0.00% 0.45% 0.00% 0.00% 0.00%
  Other Expenses
    (after expense reduction, including
    administration fee of .05%)(2)      0.20% 1.39% 0.45% 1.60% 1.26% 2.28%
                                        ----  ----  ----  ----  ----  ----
  Total Operating Expenses
    (after reductions)(3)               0.45% 1.39% 0.90% 1.60% 1.26% 2.28%
</TABLE>
 
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
(1) After reduction by Investment Adviser. If no reductions were made,
    investment advisory fees would have been as follows: WNTBP--0.45%; WTRBP--
    0.45%; WSBCP--0.65%; and WIBCP--0.80% of each Portfolio's average daily
    net assets.
 
(2) After reductions by Administrator. If no reductions were made,
    administration fees would have been 0.05% of each Portfolio's average
    daily net assets. The Investment Adviser was allocated a portion of the
    expenses of each Portfolio. If such allocations were not made, Other
    Expenses net of administration fees would have amounted to the following
    percentage of average daily net assets: WNTBP--10.01%; WTRBP--7.88%;
    WSBCP--2.02%; and WIBCP--3.33%.
 
                                       9
<PAGE>
 
(3) If no fee reductions or expense allocations were made, the Total Operating
    Expenses would have been the following percentage of average daily net
    assets; WNTBP--10.51%; WTRBP--8.38%; WSBCP--2.72%; and WIBCP--4.18%. In
    addition, during the year ended December 31, 1995, custodian fees were
    reduced by credits resulting from cash balances maintained with Investment
    Bank & Trust Company. If these credits were reflected in the above table,
    the Total Operating Expenses shown above would have been: WNTBP--0.90%;
    WTRBP--0.90%; WSBCP--1.15%; and WIBCP--1.85%.
 
* Information regarding the Portfolios has been provided by the Trust. While
  PFL has no reason to doubt the accuracy of these figures, PFL does not
  guarantee their accuracy and does not represent that they are true and
  complete.
 
Example
 
  A Certificate Owner would pay the following expenses on a $1,000 investment,
assuming a 5% annual return on assets (and assuming the entire Annuity Pur-
chase Value is in the Variable Account):
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
      Portfolio                   1 Year       3 Years       5 Years       10 Years
    -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      <S>                         <C>          <C>           <C>           <C>
      Near Term Bond               $25          $ 76          $129           $276
      Total Return Bond            $23          $ 72          $123           $263
      Selected Blue Chip           $27          $ 82          $140           $297
      International Blue Chip      $33          $102          $173           $361
</TABLE>
    ---------------------------------------------------------------
 
  The example factors in the $30 annual Administrative Charge based on an av-
erage Annuity Purchase Value per Certificate of $94,726 as of December 31,
1995 which translates that charge into an assumed charge at an annual rate of
0.0317% of the Variable Account Value. The example assumes that no premium tax
has been assessed, although premium taxes may be applicable. (See "Premium
Taxes," p. 34.) The example should not be considered a representation of past
or future expenses, and actual expenses may be greater or lesser than those
shown. The figures and data for the Trust's Annual Expenses have been provided
by Wright Investors' Service, and while PFL does not dispute these figures,
PFL does not guaranty their accuracy or completeness, and therefore PFL cannot
guarantee that the examples are accurate.
 
DEATH BENEFIT
 
  A Death Benefit is payable if the Annuitant dies before the Annuity Com-
mencement Date, and either (a) the Annuitant is the Certificate Owner, or (b)
the Certificate Owner is not a natural person. In those circumstances, upon
receipt of proof of the Annuitant's death, the Death Benefit is calculated and
is payable to the Beneficiary when PFL receives an election of the method of
settlement and return of the Certificate. The Death Benefit will be the
greater of (a) the Annuity Purchase Value on the date proof of death and elec-
tion of the method of settlement are received; or (b) the total premiums paid
less any partial withdrawals plus interest at an annual rate of 5.0%. The
Death Benefit may be paid as either a lump sum cash benefit or as an Annuity
Payment Option. (See "Death Benefit," p. 29.)
 
FREE LOOK RIGHT
 
  The Certificate Owner may return the Certificate for a refund within the pe-
riod of time specified in the Certificate. The applicable period will depend
on the state in which the Certificate is issued. In most states, it is ten
(10) days after the Certificate is delivered to the Certificate
 
                                      10
<PAGE>
 
   
Owner. The amount of the refund will also depend on the state in which the
Certificate is issued. Ordinarily the amount of the refund will be the sum of
all premium payments made under the Certificate and the accumulated gains or
losses in the Variable Account, if any. However, some states require a return
of the premium(s) paid, or the greater of premium(s) paid or the Annuity Pur-
chase Value. PFL will pay the refund within seven (7) days after it receives
Written Notice of cancellation and the returned Certificate.     
 
  If the Certificate is issued in California (a) to an Owner who is age 60 or
more, or (b) with a premium payment of less than $10,000, then the amount re-
turned will be the premium and any charges deducted; otherwise, the sum of the
premium payments and the accumulated gains and losses in the Variable Account,
if any, as of the date the cancellation request is received will be returned.
 
FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES OF INVESTMENT IN THE CERTIFICATE
   
  With respect to Certificate Owners who are natural persons, there should be
no federal income tax on increases in the Annuity Purchase Value until a dis-
tribution under the Certificate occurs (e.g., a withdrawal or Annuity Payment)
or is deemed to occur (e.g., a pledge or assignment of a Certificate). Gener-
ally, a portion of any distribution or deemed distribution will be taxable as
ordinary income. The taxable portion of certain distributions will be subject
to withholding unless the recipient elects otherwise (although withholding is
mandatory for certain qualified plans. In addition, a ten percent federal pen-
alty tax may apply to certain distributions or deemed distributions. The pen-
alty tax generally does not apply, inter alia, to any distribution made on or
after the taxpayer attains age 59 1/2. For Non-Qualified Certificates, PFL be-
lieves that the same tax consequences should apply under bank trust or agency
arrangements where the Participant is a natural person, assuming the arrange-
ment is structured properly. (See "Certain Federal Income Tax Consequences,"
p. 36.)     
 
INQUIRIES AND WRITTEN NOTICES AND REQUESTS
   
  Any questions about procedures or the Certificate, or any Written Notice or
Written Request, should be sent to PFL's Administrative and Service Office,
Financial Markets Division - Variable Annuity Dept., 4333 Edgewood Road N.E.,
Cedar Rapids, IA 52499-0001. Telephone inquires may be made by calling 800-
525-6205. All inquiries, Written Notices and Written Requests should include
the Certificate number, the Certificate Owner's name, and the Annuitant's
name.     
 
VARIATIONS IN CERTIFICATE PROVISIONS
 
  Certain provisions of the Certificates may vary from the descriptions in
this Prospectus in order to comply with different state laws. See the Certifi-
cate itself for variations. Any such variations will be included in the Cer-
tificate itself or in riders or endorsements.
 
                                    -  -  -
 
NOTE: The foregoing summary is qualified in its entirety by the detailed in-
formation in the remainder of this Prospectus and in the Statement of Addi-
tional Information and in the prospectus for the Trust and in the Certificate,
all of which should be referred to for more detailed information. This Pro-
spectus generally describes only the Certificate and the Variable Account. A
separate prospectus describes the Trust.
 
                                      11
<PAGE>
 
                        CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
  The Accumulation Unit Values and the number of Accumulation Units outstanding
for each Subaccount from the date of inception:
 
WRIGHT NEAR TERM BOND SUBACCOUNT
 
<TABLE>   
<CAPTION>
             Accumulation    Accumulation      Number of
             Unit Value at   Unit Value at Accumulation Units
           Beginning of Year  End of Year    At End of Year
- -------------------------------------------------------------
<S>        <C>               <C>           <C>
1995           $0.952933       $1.046259       312,204.941
1994(/1/)      $0.996743       $0.952933       474,237.369
1993(/3/)         N/A
- -------------------------------------------------------------
 
WRIGHT TOTAL RETURN BOND SUBACCOUNT
 
<CAPTION>
             Accumulation    Accumulation      Number of
             Unit Value at   Unit Value at Accumulation Units
           Beginning of Year  End of Year    At End of Year
- -------------------------------------------------------------
<S>        <C>               <C>           <C>
1995           $0.912223       $1.055619       509,157.449
1994           $0.991759       $0.912223       569,877.796
1993(/2/)      $1.000000       $0.991759       168,578.241
- -------------------------------------------------------------
 
WRIGHT SELECTED BLUE CHIP SUBACCOUNT
 
<CAPTION>
             Accumulation    Accumulation      Number of
             Unit Value at   Unit Value at Accumulation Units
           Beginning of Year  End of Year    At End of Year
- -------------------------------------------------------------
<S>        <C>               <C>           <C>
1995           $0.925964       $1.157532     1,934,519.692
1994(/1/)      $0.996743       $0.925964     1,567,081.382
1993(/3/)         N/A
- -------------------------------------------------------------
 
WRIGHT INTERNATIONAL BLUE CHIP SUBACCOUNT
 
<CAPTION>
             Accumulation    Accumulation      Number of
             Unit Value at   Unit Value at Accumulation Units
           Beginning of Year  End of Year    At End of Year
- -------------------------------------------------------------
<S>        <C>               <C>           <C>
1995           $0.902655       $0.988643     1,380,932.622
1994(/1/)      $0.996743       $0.902655     1,360,360.040
1993(/3/)         N/A
</TABLE>    
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
(/1/) Period from January 6, 1994 through December 31, 1994.
(/2/) Period from December 6, 1993 through December 31, 1993.
(/3/) Did not commence business until 1994.
 
                                       12
<PAGE>
 
                             FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
  The financial statements of the Variable Account and PFL and the independent
auditors' reports thereon are contained in the Statement of Additional Infor-
mation which is available free upon request.
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
  PFL Life Insurance Company ("PFL"), 4333 Edgewood Road N.E., Cedar Rapids,
Iowa 52499-0001, is a stock life insurance company. It was incorporated under
the name NN Investors Life Insurance Company, Inc. under the laws of the State
of Iowa on April 19, 1961. It is principally engaged in the sale of life in-
surance and annuity policies, and is licensed in the District of Columbia,
Guam, and in all states except New York. As of December 31, 1995, PFL had as-
sets of approximately $7.2 billion. PFL is a wholly-owned indirect subsidiary
of AEGON USA, Inc., which conducts substantially all of its operations through
subsidiary companies engaged in the insurance business or in providing non-in-
surance financial services. All of the stock of AEGON USA, Inc. is indirectly
owned by AEGON n.v. of the Netherlands. AEGON n.v., a holding company, con-
ducts its business through subsidiary companies engaged primarily in the in-
surance business.
 
  PFL may from time to time publish (in advertisements, sales literature and
reports to Certificate Owners) the ratings and other information assigned to
it by one or more independent rating organizations such as A.M. Best Company,
Standard & Poor's, and Duff & Phelps. The purpose of the ratings is to reflect
the financial strength and/or claims-paying ability of PFL, and the ratings
should not be considered as bearing on the investment performance or safety of
assets held in the Variable Account. Each year the A.M. Best Company reviews
the financial status of thousands of insurers, culminating in the assignment
of Best's Ratings. These ratings reflect A.M. Best Company's current opinion
of the relative financial strength and operating performance of an insurance
company in comparison to the norms of the life/health insurance industry. In
addition, the claims-paying ability of PFL as measured by Standard & Poor's
Insurance Ratings Services or Duff & Phelps may be referred to in such adver-
tisements, sales literature, or reports. These ratings are opinions regarding
an operating insurance company's financial capacity to meet the obligations of
its insurance and annuity policies in accordance with their terms. Such rat-
ings do not reflect the investment performance of the Variable Account or the
degree of risk associated with an investment in the Variable Account.
 
                                      13
<PAGE>
 
                    THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
 
THE VARIABLE ACCOUNT
 
  The PFL Wright Variable Annuity Account of PFL Life Insurance Company (the
"Variable Account") was established as a separate investment account of PFL
under the laws of the State of Iowa on April 7, 1993. The Variable Account re-
ceives and invests the premiums under the Certificates that are allocated to
it for investment in shares of the Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust.
 
  The Variable Account currently is divided into four Subaccounts. Additional
Subaccounts may be established in the future at the discretion of PFL. Each
Subaccount invests exclusively in shares of one of the Portfolios of the
Trust. Under Iowa law, the assets of the Variable Account are owned by PFL,
but they are held separately from the other assets of PFL and are not charge-
able with liabilities incurred in any other business operation of PFL (except
to the extent that assets in the Variable Account exceed the reserves and
other liabilities of the Variable Account). Income, gains, and losses incurred
on the assets in the Subaccounts of the Variable Account, whether or not real-
ized, are credited to or charged against that Subaccount without regard to
other income, gains or losses of any other account or Subaccount of PFL.
Therefore, the investment performance of any Subaccount should be entirely in-
dependent of the investment performance of PFL's general account assets or any
other segregated asset account or subaccount maintained by PFL.
 
  The Variable Account is registered with the Securities and Exchange Commis-
sion ("SEC") under the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the "1940 Act") as a
unit investment trust and meets the definition of a separate account under
federal securities laws. However, the SEC does not supervise the management or
the investment practices or policies of the Variable Account or PFL.
 
THE PORTFOLIOS
 
  The Variable Account will invest exclusively in shares of the Wright Managed
Blue Chip Series Trust (the "Trust"). The Trust is a series-type mutual fund
registered with the SEC under the 1940 Act as an open-end, diversified manage-
ment investment company.* The Trust currently issues shares of the following
four Portfolios: the Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio; the Wright Total Return
Bond Portfolio; the Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio; and the Wright Inter-
national Blue Chip Portfolio. The assets of each Portfolio are held separate
from the assets of the other Portfolios, and each Portfolio has its own dis-
tinct investment objectives and policies. Each Portfolio operates as a sepa-
rate investment fund, and the income or losses of one Portfolio have no effect
on the investment performance of any other Portfolio.
 
  Wright Investors' Service (the "Adviser"), an investment adviser registered
with the SEC under the Investment Advisers Act of 1940, is the Trust's invest-
ment manager. The Adviser
 
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
* The registration of the Trust does not involve supervision of the management
  or investment practices or policies of the Trust by the SEC.
 
                                      14
<PAGE>
 
provides investment advice to each of the Portfolios of the Trust and other-
wise performs administerial and managerial functions for the Portfolios. The
Adviser is responsible for selecting the investments of each Portfolio consis-
tent with the investment objectives and policies of that Portfolio, and will
conduct securities trading for the Portfolios.
 
  The investment objectives of each Portfolio are summarized as follows:
 
  WRIGHT NEAR TERM BOND PORTFOLIO seeks high total return, to the extent con-
sistent with reasonable safety, by investing primarily in debt securities di-
rectly issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government. The Portfolio expects to
maintain an average weighted portfolio maturity of five years or less.
 
  WRIGHT TOTAL RETURN BOND PORTFOLIO seeks high total return, consisting of
current income and capital appreciation, by investing primarily in obligations
issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government and its agencies or instrumentali-
ties and in high-grade corporate debt securities of any maturity.
 
  WRIGHT SELECTED BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO seeks long-term capital appreciation
and, as a secondary objective, reasonable current income by investing primar-
ily in equity securities of well-established U.S. companies that meet the Ad-
viser's quality standards.
 
  WRIGHT INTERNATIONAL BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO seeks long-term capital apprecia-
tion by investing primarily in equity securities of well-established, non-U.S.
companies that meet the Adviser's quality standards.
 
  THERE IS NO ASSURANCE THAT ANY PORTFOLIO WILL ACHIEVE ITS STATED
OBJECTIVE. MORE DETAILED INFORMATION, INCLUDING A DESCRIPTION OF EACH PORTFO-
LIO'S INVESTMENT OBJECTIVE AND POLICIES AND A DESCRIPTION OF RISKS INVOLVED IN
INVESTING IN EACH PORTFOLIO AND OF EACH PORTFOLIO'S FEES AND EXPENSES IS CON-
TAINED IN THE PROSPECTUS FOR THE TRUST, A CURRENT COPY OF WHICH IS ATTACHED TO
THIS PROSPECTUS. INFORMATION CONTAINED IN THE TRUST'S PROSPECTUS SHOULD BE
READ CAREFULLY BEFORE INVESTING IN A SUBACCOUNT OF THE VARIABLE ACCOUNT.
 
  An investment in the Variable Account, or in any Portfolio, is not a deposit
or obligation of, or guaranteed or endorsed by, any bank or depository insti-
tution, and the investment is not federally insured by the Federal Deposit In-
surance Corporation or any other agency, and involves investment risk, includ-
ing possible loss of principal amount invested.
 
ADDITION, DELETION, OR SUBSTITUTION OF INVESTMENTS
 
  PFL cannot and does not guarantee that any of the Portfolios will always be
available for premium payments, allocations, or transfers. PFL retains the
right, subject to any applicable law, to make certain changes in the Variable
Account and its investments. PFL reserves the right to eliminate the shares of
any Portfolio held by a Subaccount and to substitute shares of another Portfo-
lio of the Trust, or of another registered open-end management investment com-
pany for the
 
                                      15
<PAGE>
 
shares of any Portfolio, if the shares of the Portfolio are no longer avail-
able for investment or if, in PFL's judgment, investment in any Portfolio
would be inappropriate in view of the purposes of the Variable Account. To the
extent required by the 1940 Act, substitutions of shares attributable to a
Certificate Owner's interest in a Subaccount will not be made without prior
notice to the Certificate Owner and the prior approval of the SEC. Nothing
contained herein shall prevent the Variable Account from purchasing other se-
curities for other series or classes of variable annuity policies, or from ef-
fecting an exchange between series or classes of variable annuity policies on
the basis of requests made by the Certificate Owner.
 
  New Subaccounts may be established when, in the sole discretion of PFL, mar-
keting, tax, investment or other conditions warrant. Any new Subaccounts may
be made available with respect to existing Certificates on a basis to be de-
termined by PFL. Each additional Subaccount will purchase shares in a Portfo-
lio of the Trust or in another mutual fund or investment vehicle. PFL may also
eliminate one or more Subaccounts if, in its sole discretion, marketing, tax,
investment or other conditions warrant such change. In the event any
Subaccount is eliminated, PFL will notify the Certificate Owners and will re-
quest a reallocation of the amounts invested in the eliminated Subaccount. If
no such reallocation is provided by the Certificate Owner, PFL will reinvest
the amounts invested in the eliminated Subaccount in the Subaccount that in-
vests in the Near-Term Bond Portfolio (or in a similar portfolio of short term
instruments).
 
  In the event of any such substitution or change, PFL may, by appropriate en-
dorsement make such changes in the Certificates as may be necessary or appro-
priate to reflect such substitution or change. Furthermore, if deemed to be in
the best interests of persons having voting rights under the Certificates, the
Variable Account may be (i) operated as a management company under the 1940
Act or any other form permitted by law, (ii) deregistered under the 1940 Act
in the event such registration is no longer required or (iii) combined with
one or more other separate accounts. To the extent permitted by applicable
law, PFL also may transfer the assets of the Variable Account associated with
the Certificates to another account or accounts.
 
                               THE FIXED ACCOUNT
 
  Premiums allocated and amounts transferred to the Fixed Account become part
of the general assets of PFL, which support insurance and annuity obligations.
Interests in the Fixed Account have not been registered under the Securities
Act of 1933 (the "1933 Act"), nor is the Fixed Account registered as an in-
vestment company under the 1940 Act. Accordingly, neither the Fixed Account
nor any interests therein are generally subject to the provisions of the 1933
or 1940 Acts, and PFL has been advised that the staff of the Securities and
Exchange Commission has not reviewed the disclosures in this Prospectus that
relate to the Fixed Account. This Prospectus is generally intended to serve as
a disclosure document only for the Certificate and the Variable Account. For
complete details regarding the Fixed Account, see the Certificate and any ap-
plicable endorsement(s).
 
                                      16
<PAGE>
 
  The initial premium payment and any subsequent premium payment(s) will be
allocated to Guaranteed Periods available in connection with the Fixed Account
to the extent elected at the time such payment is made. In addition, all or
part of the Annuity Purchase Value may be transferred to such Guaranteed Peri-
ods available under the Certificate as described under "Transfers." Instead of
the Participant or Policy Owner assuming all of the investment risk as is the
case for premium payments allocated to the Variable Account, PFL guarantees it
will credit a specified minimum interest rate to amounts allocated to the
Fixed Account.
 
  Assets supporting amounts allocated to Guaranteed Periods within the Fixed
Account become part of PFL's general assets and are available to fund the
claims of all creditors of PFL. All PFL's general account assets will be
available to fund benefits under the Certificate. The Certificate does not
participate in the investment performance of the assets of the Fixed Account
or PFL's general account. Instead, a specified rate of interest, the Guaran-
teed Interest Rate, declared in advance, is credited to amounts allocated to
the Fixed Account.
 
  PFL will invest the assets of its general account in those assets chosen by
PFL and allowed by applicable state laws regarding the nature and quality of
investments that may be made by life insurance companies and the percentage of
their assets that may be committed to any particular type of investment. In
general, these laws permit investments, within specified limits and subject to
certain qualifications, in federal, state and municipal obligations, corporate
bonds, preferred and common stocks, real estate mortgages, real estate and
certain other investments.
 
  If Annuity Purchase Value is maintained within a Fixed Account for the dura-
tion of the Guaranteed Period, PFL guarantees that it will credit interest to
that amount at the guaranteed rate specified for the Guaranteed Period. Howev-
er, in the event any amount from the Guaranteed Period is withdrawn or trans-
ferred prior to the expiration of the Guaranteed Period for any reason, PFL
will subject that amount to an Excess Interest Adjustment which could be posi-
tive or negative. (See "Excess Interest Adjustment," p. 32.) PFL reserves the
right to defer the payment of amounts withdrawn from the Fixed Account for a
period not to exceed six (6) months from the date written request for such
withdrawal is received by PFL.
 
GUARANTEED PERIODS
 
  Premium payments and transfers may be allocated to one or more Guaranteed
Periods within the Fixed Account. Each Guaranteed Period will have a duration
of at least one year and a specified Guaranteed Interest Rate. Initial premium
payments and subsequent premium payments, or portions thereof, and transfer
amounts allocated to a Fixed Account Guaranteed Period, will earn interest at
the Guaranteed Interest Rate during the particular Guaranteed Period unless
prematurely withdrawn or transferred prior to the end of the Guaranteed Peri-
od. Initial Guaranteed Periods begin on the date a premium payment is accepted
or, in the case of a transfer, on the effective date of the transfer, and end
on the specified anniversary, depending on the Guaranteed Period selected, of
the day immediately preceding the date on which the premium payment acceptance
or transfer occurred (the "Expiration Date"). Any portion of Annuity Purchase
Value allocated to a specific Guaranteed Period with a specified Expiration
Date (including interest earned thereon) will be referred to herein as a
"Guaranteed Period Amount." Interest will be
 
                                      17
<PAGE>
 
credited daily at a rate equivalent to the compound annual rate. As a result
of the timing of premium payments and renewals and transfers of portions of
the Annuity Purchase Value, which will begin new Guaranteed Periods, amounts
allocated to Guaranteed Periods of the same duration may have different Expi-
ration Dates. Thus each Guaranteed Period Amount will be treated separately
for purposes of determining any applicable Excess Interest Adjustment (see
"Excess Interest Adjustment," p. 32.)
 
  PFL will notify the Certificate Owner in writing at least 45 days prior to
the Expiration Date for any Guaranteed Period Amount. A new Guaranteed Period
of the same duration as the previous Guaranteed Period will commence automati-
cally on the Expiration Date of the previous Guaranteed Period unless PFL re-
ceives, within the 30 day period prior to the Expiration Date of such Guaran-
teed Period, a written election by the Certificate Owner to transfer the Guar-
anteed Period Amount to a different Fixed Account Guaranteed Period or to a
Variable Account Subaccount from among those being offered by PFL at such
time.
 
GUARANTEED INTEREST RATES
 
  PFL periodically will establish an applicable Guaranteed Interest Rate for
each of the Guaranteed Periods within the Fixed Account. Current Guaranteed
Interest Rates may be changed by PFL frequently or infrequently depending on
interest rates on investments available to PFL and other factors as described
below, but once established, the rate will be guaranteed for the entire dura-
tion of the Guaranteed Period. However, any amount withdrawn or transferred
will be subject to an Excess Interest Adjustment, except during the 30 day pe-
riod prior to the Expiration Date. (See "Excess Interest Adjustment," p. 32.)
 
  The Guaranteed Interest Rate will not be less than 3% per year compounded
annually, regardless of any application of the Excess Interest Adjustment. PFL
has no specific formula for determining the rate of interest that it will de-
clare as a Guaranteed Interest Rate, as this rate will be reflective of inter-
est rates available on the types of debt instruments in which PFL intends to
invest amounts allocated to the Fixed Account (See "The Fixed Account," p.
16.) In addition, PFL's management may consider other factors in determining
Guaranteed Interest Rates for a particular Guaranteed Period including but not
limited to: regulatory and tax requirements; sales commissions and administra-
tive expenses borne by the Company; general economic trends; and competitive
factors. There is no obligation to declare a rate in excess of 3%; the Partic-
ipant or the Policy Owner, as the case may be, assumes the risk that declared
rates will not exceed 3%. PFL has complete discretion to declare any rate of
at least 3%, regardless of market interest rates, the amounts earned by PFL on
its investments, or any other factors.
 
  PFL'S MANAGEMENT HAS COMPLETE AND SOLE DISCRETION TO DETERMINE THE GUARAN-
TEED INTEREST RATES. PFL CANNOT PREDICT OR GUARANTEE THE LEVEL OF FUTURE GUAR-
ANTEED INTEREST RATES, EXCEPT THAT PFL GUARANTEES THAT FUTURE GUARANTEED IN-
TEREST RATES WILL NOT BE BELOW 3% PER YEAR COMPOUNDED ANNUALLY.
 
                                      18
<PAGE>
 
                       BANK TRUST OR AGENCY ARRANGEMENTS
 
  The Certificates are designed to be issued to trust or agency accounts main-
tained by bank trust departments (although in certain circumstances they may
be issued to individuals). Under such arrangements, the Certificate is issued
to and held in the name of the bank trust or agency account (that is, the bank
or its trust department as nominee, agent, or trustee) for the benefit of the
Participant (i.e., the bank client). A bank trust or agency account is re-
ferred to herein as a "Certificate Owner." Individual policies may also be
used in connection with such bank agency or trust arrangements. Pursuant to
such arrangements, the bank typically charges trust, management, or other fees
that may vary from bank to bank and that may also vary depending on the type
of arrangement, the amounts involved, and/or other factors.
 
  These arrangements may have federal income tax consequences (for both Non-
qualified and Qualified Certificates) and there is no guidance, and hence some
uncertainty, as to the tax effects of certain aspects of such arrangements.
Consequently, Participants in such arrangements should obtain competent tax
advice. Moreover, bank trust or agency arrangements may not be suitable for
certain tax qualified plans because such arrangements may be incompatible with
the qualification requirements for those plans. Individual annuity policies,
where available, may be purchased directly (not through bank trust or agency
arrangements) for these plans. (See "Certain Federal Income Tax Consequences,"
p. 36.)
 
  An investment or interest in a Certificate, including a Certificate issued
pursuant to a bank trust or agency arrangement or some other bank-related ar-
rangement, is not a deposit in the bank or an obligation of the bank, and is
not insured or guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or any
other agency or instrumentality of the U.S. Government.
 
                               THE CERTIFICATES
 
  The PFL Wright Variable Annuity is a flexible premium group and individual
variable annuity contract. The rights and benefits with respect to a Certifi-
cate are summarized below; however, the description of the Certificate con-
tained in this Prospectus is qualified in its entirety by the Certificate it-
self, including any endorsements thereto, a copy of which is available upon
request from PFL. The Certificates may be purchased on a non-tax-qualified ba-
sis ("Nonqualified Certificate"). The Certificates may also be purchased to be
used in connection with retirement plans or individual retirement accounts
that qualify for favorable special federal income tax treatment ("Qualified
Certificates") under Sections 401, 403, 408, or 457 or other Sections of the
Internal Revenue Code.
 
ISSUANCE OF A CERTIFICATE
 
  Before it will issue a Certificate, PFL must receive a completed Certificate
application and an initial premium payment of at least $5,000 for a Nonquali-
fied Certificate and $1,000 for a Qualified Certificate ($50 for tax deferred
403(b) Annuities). A Certificate ordinarily will be
 
                                      19
<PAGE>
 
issued only in respect of Annuitants Age 0 through 80. Acceptance or declina-
tion of an application will be based on PFL's underwriting standards, and PFL
reserves the right to reject any application or premium payment based on those
underwriting standards.
 
  If the application can be accepted in the form received, the initial premium
payment will be credited to the Annuity Purchase Value within two Business
Days after the later of receipt of the application or receipt of the initial
premium payment. If the initial premium payment cannot be credited because the
application or other issuing requirements are incomplete, the applicant (i.e.,
the Certificate Owner) will be contacted within five Business Days and given
an explanation for the delay, and the initial premium payment will be returned
at that time unless the applicant consents to PFL's retaining the initial pre-
mium payment and crediting it as soon as the necessary requirements are ful-
filled.
 
  The date on which the initial premium payment is credited to the Annuity
Purchase Value is the Date of Issue which is used to determine Certificate
Years and Certificate Anniversaries.
 
CERTIFICATE OWNER
 
  The term "Certificate Owner" refers to, (i) in the case of a Certificate is-
sued under bank trust or agency arrangements, the bank trust or agency account
to which such Certificate is issued, and (ii) in the case of a Certificate
that is an individual annuity policy, the Policy Owner.
 
PREMIUM PAYMENTS
 
  All initial premium payment checks or drafts should be made payable to PFL
Life Insurance Company and sent to the Administrative and Service Office. Ad-
ditional premium payments should be sent to the Administrative and Service Of-
fice. The Death Benefit will not take effect until the check or draft for the
premium payment is honored.
 
  INITIAL PREMIUM PAYMENT. The minimum initial premium payment that PFL cur-
rently will accept is $5,000 under a Nonqualified Certificate and $1,000 under
a Qualified Certificate ($50 for tax deferred Section 403(b) Annuities). PFL
reserves the right to increase or decrease this amount for a class of Certifi-
cates issued after some future date. The initial premium payment is the only
premium payment required to be paid under a Certificate. The maximum premium
payment that PFL will currently accept without its prior approval is $1 mil-
lion.
 
  ADDITIONAL PREMIUM PAYMENTS. While the Annuitant is living and prior to the
Annuity Commencement Date, additional premium payments may be made at any
time, and in any frequency. The minimum additional premium payment for Non-
qualified Certificates is $500 ($50 for tax deferred Section 403(b) Annui-
ties). The maximum total amount of premium payments that may be made for a
Certificate without PFL's prior approval is $1 million. Additional premium
payments will be credited to the Certificate and added to the Annuity Purchase
Value as of the Business Day when they are received at the Administrative and
Service Office.
 
                                      20
<PAGE>
 
  ALLOCATION OF PREMIUM PAYMENTS. The Certificate Owner must allocate premium
payments to one or more of the Subaccounts or Guaranteed Periods. The initial
allocation must be specified in the Certificate application. This allocation
will be used for additional premium payments unless a change of allocation is
requested. All allocations must be made in whole percentages and must total
100%. The minimum amount that can be allocated to any Subaccount or to a Guar-
anteed Period is $500. If no allocation is specified, then the premium pay-
ment(s) cannot be accepted. All additional premium payments will be allocated
and credited to the Certificate as of the Valuation Period during which they
are received.
 
  The allocation of future additional premium payments may be changed by send-
ing Written Notice to PFL's Administrative and Service Office, or by telephone
(subject to the provisions described below under "Telephone Transactions," p.
23.) The allocation change will apply to payments received after the date the
Written Notice or telephone request is received.
 
  PAYMENT NOT HONORED BY BANK. Any payment under the Certificate that is de-
rived, all or in part, from any amount paid to PFL by check or draft may be
postponed until such time as PFL determines that such instrument has been hon-
ored.
 
ANNUITY PURCHASE VALUE
 
  On the date the Certificate is issued, the Annuity Purchase Value equals the
initial premium payment. Thereafter, the Annuity Purchase Value will increase
by (1) any additional premium payments received by PFL; and (2) any increases
in the Annuity Purchase Value due to investment results of the selected
Subaccounts and interest credited to the Fixed Account. The Annuity Purchase
Value will decrease by (1) any withdrawals; (2) any decreases in the Annuity
Purchase Value due to investment results of the selected Subaccounts; (3) the
charges imposed by PFL and (4) any applicable premium taxes. Additionally, a
withdrawal or transfer of amounts from a Guaranteed Period under the Fixed Ac-
count may result in an Excess Interest Adjustment which could increase or de-
crease the Annuity Purchase Value (or withdrawal proceeds).
 
  The Annuity Purchase Value is expected to change from Valuation Period to
Valuation Period, reflecting the investment experience of the selected
Subaccount(s) and interest credited to the selected Guaranteed Periods of the
Fixed Account, as well as the deductions for applicable charges. A Valuation
Period is the period between successive Business Days. It begins at the close
of business on each Business Day and ends at the close of business on the next
succeeding Business Day. A Business Day is each day that both the New York
Stock Exchange and PFL's Administrative and Service Office are open for busi-
ness. Holidays are generally not Business Days.
 
  When a premium payment is allocated to or an amount is transferred to a
Subaccount of the Variable Account, it is credited to the Certificate in the
form of Accumulation Units. Each Subaccount of the Variable Account has a dis-
tinct Accumulation Unit value (the "Unit Value"). The number of Units credited
is determined by dividing the premium payment or amount transferred by the
Unit Value of the Subaccount as of the end of the Valuation Period during
which the allocation is made. When amounts are transferred out of or withdrawn
from a Subaccount, Units are cancelled or redeemed in a similar manner.
 
 
                                      21
<PAGE>
 
  For each Subaccount, the Unit Value for a given Business Day is based on the
net asset value of a share of the corresponding Portfolio of the Trust. There-
fore, the Unit Values will fluctuate from day to day based on the investment
experience of the corresponding Portfolio. The determination of Subaccount
Unit Values is described in detail in the Statement of Additional Information.
 
  When a premium payment is allocated to or an amount is transferred to the
Fixed Account, it is credited to the selected Guaranteed Period as described
in "The Fixed Account," p. 16. In addition, interest at a specified interest
rate is credited to such amounts. When amounts are transferred out of or with-
drawn from a Guaranteed Period, the applicable Guaranteed Period Amount is re-
duced accordingly. Unlike the Variable Account, there are no Accumulation
Units in the Fixed Account.
 
TRANSFERS
 
  The Certificate Owner can transfer Annuity Purchase Value among Subaccounts
and to or from Guaranteed Periods within certain limits.
 
  Subject to the limitations and restrictions described below, transfers from
a Subaccount or a Guaranteed Period may be made up to thirty days prior to the
Annuity Commencement Date. The minimum amount that may be transferred is the
lesser of $500 or the entire amount in the Subaccount or Guaranteed Period. If
the Annuity Purchase Value remaining in a Subaccount or Guaranteed Period af-
ter a transfer is less than $500, PFL reserves the right, at its discretion,
to include that amount as part of the transfer.
 
  Transfers currently may be made as often as desired, subject to the minimum
amount specified above (PFL reserves the right to otherwise limit or restrict
transfers in the future). A transfer charge may be imposed for any transfer in
excess of 12 per year; however, currently there is no charge for any transfer.
 
  Transfers may be made by sending Written Notice to the Administrative and
Service Office or by telephone, subject to the provisions described below un-
der "Telephone Transactions," p. 23.
 
  In addition, transfers from the Guaranteed Periods of the Fixed Account will
be subject to the Excess Interest Adjustment unless the transfer occurs during
the 30 days prior to the Expiration Date applicable to the Guaranteed Period
Amount. (See "Excess Interest Adjustment," p. 32.)
 
  Transfers among the Subaccounts of the Variable Account may also be made af-
ter the Annuity Commencement Date. (See "Annuity Payment Options - Transfers,"
p. 29.)
 
DOLLAR COST AVERAGING
 
  Under the Dollar Cost Averaging program, if elected, the Certificate Owner
can instruct PFL to automatically transfer a specified amount from the Near
Term Bond Subaccount to any other Subaccount(s). The automatic transfers can
occur monthly or quarterly, and the amount transferred each time must be at
least $500.00. At the time the program begins, there must be sufficient Annu-
ity Purchase Value in the Near Term Bond Subaccount to cover at least one
year's transfers.
 
                                      22
<PAGE>
 
  Dollar Cost Averaging results in the purchase of more Units when the Unit
Value is low, and fewer Units when the Unit Value is high. However, there is
no guarantee that the Dollar Cost Averaging program will result in a higher
Annuity Purchase Value or otherwise be successful.
 
  The Dollar Cost Averaging program can be elected when purchasing the Certif-
icate or at a later date, and the election can specify that only a certain
number of transfers will be made, in which case the program will terminate
when that number of transfers has been made. Otherwise, the program will ter-
minate when the amount in the Near Term Bond Subaccount is insufficient for
the next transfer. There is no charge for this program.
 
TELEPHONE TRANSACTIONS
 
  Certificate Owners (or their designated account executive) can make trans-
fers and/or change the allocation of subsequent premium payments by telephone
if the "Telephone Transfer/Reallocation Authorization" box in the application
has been checked or telephone transfers have been subsequently authorized in
writing. PFL and/or the Administrative and Service Office will not be liable
for following instructions communicated by telephone that it reasonably be-
lieves to be genuine. However, PFL and/or the Administrative and Service Of-
fice will employ reasonable procedures to confirm that instructions communi-
cated by telephone are genuine. If PFL and/or the Administrative and Service
Office fails to do so, it may be liable for any losses due to unauthorized or
fraudulent instructions. All telephone requests will be recorded on voice re-
corder equipment for the protection of the Certificate Owner. A Certificate
Owner, when making telephone requests, may be required to provide the Partici-
pant's or Policy Owner's social security number and/or other information for
identification purposes.
 
  Telephone requests must be received at the Administrative and Service Office
no later than 3:00 p.m. Central time in order to assure same-day pricing of
the transaction.
 
  The telephone transaction privilege may be discontinued at any time as to
some or all Certificates, and PFL may require written confirmation of a trans-
action request.
 
                     DISTRIBUTIONS UNDER THE CERTIFICATES
 
WITHDRAWALS
 
  The Certificate Owner may withdraw all or a portion of the Cash Value of a
Certificate at any time during the life of the Annuitant and prior to the An-
nuity Commencement Date by sending a Written Request to PFL's Administrative
and Service Office. The Cash Value is the Annuity Purchase Value less any ap-
plicable premium taxes and plus or minus any Excess Interest Adjustment. (See
"Excess Interest Adjustment," p. 32.) The Annuity Purchase Value is equal to
premiums paid, minus any partial withdrawals, plus or minus any applicable Ex-
cess Interest
 
                                      23
<PAGE>
 
Adjustments on prior withdrawals or transfers, plus or minus accumulated gains
or losses in the Variable Account, plus accumulated interest in the Fixed Ac-
count, minus any applicable charges, premium taxes and transfer fees, if any.
There will be no Excess Interest Adjustment with respect to withdrawals from
the Fixed Account made within 30 days prior to the Expiration Date of the ap-
plicable Guaranteed Period. Any Excess Interest Adjustment imposed on a with-
drawal will affect only the amount withdrawn from the Fixed Account.
 
  The minimum amount that can be withdrawn from any Subaccount or Guaranteed
Period of the Fixed Account is $500. After the Annuity Commencement Date, the
Annuity Purchase Value can only be withdrawn if Annuity Payment Option 4-V is
in effect. (See "Annuity Payments," p. 25.)
 
  The Subaccount or Guaranteed Period from which partial withdrawal amounts
should be taken must be specified in the request. Otherwise, the withdrawal
request cannot be processed. ALL WITHDRAWALS FROM ANY GUARANTEED PERIOD, EX-
CEPT THOSE EFFECTIVE WITHIN 30 DAYS PRIOR TO THE EXPIRATION DATE OF THE APPLI-
CABLE GUARANTEED PERIOD, WILL BE SUBJECT TO THE EXCESS INTEREST ADJUSTMENT.
(See "Excess Interest Adjustment," p. 32.)
 
  PFL will process all withdrawal requests within seven (7) calendar days fol-
lowing receipt by the Service Center of Written Request, except that
 
  .   Variable Account - PFL reserves the right to defer the payment of any
      withdrawal from the Variable Account as permitted by the 1940 Act.
      Such delay may occur because (i) the New York stock exchange is closed
      for trading; (ii) the SEC determines that a state of emergency exists;
      or (iii) an order or pronouncement of the SEC permits a delay for the
      protection of investors.
 
  .   Fixed Account - PFL reserves the right to defer payment of any
      withdrawal from the Fixed Account for up to six (6) months.
 
  The Participant or individual Policy Owner assumes the investment risk with
respect to all premium payments allocated or transferred to the Subaccounts.
Because withdrawals or transfers of amounts allocated to the Fixed Account may
be subject to a negative Excess Interest Adjustment, because the performance
of the Subaccounts is not guaranteed, and because all withdrawals may be sub-
ject to premium taxes, the total Cash Value (taking any prior withdrawals into
account) may be more or less than the total premium payments made. However,
the Cash Value of amounts transferred or allocated to the Fixed Account will
never be less than the amounts originally transferred or allocated, with in-
terest accumulated at 3% annually less any premium taxes. Following a with-
drawal of the total Cash Value, or at any time the Annuity Purchase Value is
zero, all rights of the Certificate Owner and the Annuitant will terminate.
 
  Withdrawals may be taxable, and a ten percent federal tax penalty generally
applies to withdrawals made before the taxpayer reaches age 59 1/2 for Non-
qualified Certificates; withdrawal restrictions and penalties may apply to
Qualified Certificates.
 
                                      24
<PAGE>
 
SYSTEMATIC WITHDRAWAL PLAN
 
  Under the Systematic Withdrawal Plan, the Certificate Owner can instruct PFL
to make automatic withdrawal payments to it monthly, quarterly, semi-annually
or annually from a specified Subaccount. Monthly and quarterly payments can
only be sent by electronic funds transfer directly to a checking or savings
account. The minimum monthly payment is $50.00, the minimum quarterly payment
is $100.00, and the minimum semi-annual or annual payment is $250.00. If the
withdrawal is less than the minimum, it can only be sent on an annual basis.
The "Request for Systematic Withdrawal" form must specify a date for the first
payment, which must be at least 30 but not more than 90 days after the form is
submitted. Amounts withdrawn from the Fixed Account will be subject to the Ex-
cess Interest Adjustment.
 
  Systematic Withdrawals will not be available for 403(b) annuities under age
59 1/2.
 
  Qualified Policies are subject to complex rules with respect to restrictions
on and taxation of distributions, including the applicability of penalty tax-
es. A qualified tax adviser should be consulted before a Systematic Withdrawal
Plan is requested. (See "Certain Federal Income Tax Consequences," page 36.)
 
  A ten percent federal tax penalty may be assessed on withdrawals made before
reaching age 59 1/2 for Nonqualified Certificates; different penalties may ap-
ply to Qualified Certificates.
 
  When using Systematic Withdrawals, no additional premium payments will be
allowed.
 
ANNUITY PAYMENTS
 
  PFL will make Annuity Payments beginning on the Annuity Commencement Date,
provided no Death Benefit has become payable and an available Annuity Payment
Option and payment schedule has been selected by Written Request. The Annuity
Payment Option and frequency of Annuity Payments may not be changed after An-
nuity Payments begin. The dollar amount and frequency of the payments will de-
pend on numerous factors such as the Annuity Purchase Value on the Annuity
Commencement Date, the Annuity Payment Option elected, and age and possibly
sex, of the Annuitant.
 
  ANNUITY COMMENCEMENT DATE. Unless the Annuity Commencement Date is changed,
Annuity Payments under a Certificate will begin on the Annuity Commencement
Date which is selected at the time the Certificate is applied for. The Annuity
Commencement Date may be changed from time to time by Written Notice to PFL,
provided that notice of each change is received by PFL at its Administrative
and Service Office at least thirty (30) days prior to the then current Annuity
Commencement Date. Except as otherwise permitted by PFL, a new Annuity Com-
mencement Date must be a date which is: (1) after the Annuitant attains age 40
and (2) at least thirty (30) days after the date notice of the change is re-
ceived by PFL. The Annuity Commencement Date may also be changed by the
Beneficiary's election of the Annuity Option after the death of the Annuitant.
 
  ELECTION OF PAYMENT OPTION. During the lifetime of the Annuitant and prior
to the Annuity Commencement Date, the Certificate Owner may choose an Annuity
Payment Option or change
 
                                      25
<PAGE>
 
the election, but Written Notice of any election or change of election must be
received by PFL at its Administrative and Service Office at least thirty (30)
days prior to the Annuity Commencement Date. If no election is made prior to
the Annuity Commencement Date, Annuity Payments will be made (i) under Option
3, life income with level payments for 10 years certain, using the existing
Annuity Purchase Value of the Fixed Account, or (ii) under Option 3-V, life
income with variable payments for 10 years certain, using the existing Annuity
Purchase Value of the Variable Account, or (iii) in a combination of (i) and
(ii). If the Annuity Purchase Value, net of any applicable premium taxes, on
the Annuity Commencement Date is less than $2,000, PFL reserves the right to
pay it in one lump sum in lieu of applying it under an Annuity Payment Option.
 
  Prior to the Annuity Commencement Date, the Beneficiary may elect to receive
the Death Benefit (if it becomes payable) in a lump sum or under one of the
Annuity Payment Options, to the extent allowed by law and subject to the terms
of any settlement agreement. (See "Death Benefit," p. 29.)
 
  Annuity Payments will be made on either a fixed basis or a variable basis as
selected by the Certificate Owner (or the Beneficiary, after the Annuitant's
death).
 
  Unless the Certificate Owner specifies otherwise, the payee shall be the An-
nuitant, or, after the Annuitant's death, the Beneficiary. PFL may require
written proof of the age of any person who elects Annuity Payment Option 3, 3-
V, 5 or 5-V.
 
  PREMIUM TAX. PFL may be required by state law to pay premium tax on the
amount applied to an Annuity Payment Option or upon withdrawal. If so, PFL
will deduct the premium tax before applying or paying the proceeds.
 
  SUPPLEMENTARY CERTIFICATE. Once proceeds become payable and a choice has
been made, PFL will issue a Supplementary Certificate in exchange for the Cer-
tificate setting forth the terms of the option elected. The Supplementary Cer-
tificate will name the payees and will describe the payment schedule.
 
ANNUITY PAYMENT OPTIONS
 
  The Certificate provides five Annuity Payment Options which are described
below. Three of these are offered as either "Fixed Annuity Payment Options" or
"Variable Annuity Payment Options," and two are only available as Fixed Pay-
ment Options. The Certificate Owner may elect a Fixed Payment Option, a Vari-
able Payment Option, or a combination of both. If the Participant or Policy
Owner elects a combination, he must specify the portions of the Annuity Pur-
chase Value (less any applicable premium taxes) to be applied to the Fixed and
Variable Options. For Variable Options, the Participant or Policy Owner must
specify the amount of the Annuity Purchase Value (less any applicable premium
taxes) to be applied to each Subaccount.
 
  NOTE CAREFULLY: UNDER PAYMENT OPTIONS 3(1) AND 5 (INCLUDING 3(1)-V AND 5-V),
IT WOULD BE POSSIBLE FOR ONLY ONE ANNUITY PAYMENT TO BE MADE IF THE
ANNUITANT(S) WERE TO DIE BEFORE THE DUE DATE OF THE SECOND ANNUITY PAYMENT;
ONLY TWO ANNUITY PAYMENTS IF THE ANNUITANT(S) WERE TO DIE BEFORE THE DUE DATE
OF THE THIRD ANNUITY PAYMENT; AND SO FORTH.
 
 
                                      26
<PAGE>
 
  On the Annuity Commencement Date, the Certificate's Annuity Purchase Value
for the Valuation Period which ends immediately preceding the Annuity Com-
mencement Date, less any applicable premium taxes, will be applied to provide
for Annuity Payments under the selected Annuity Payment Option.
 
  The effect of choosing a Fixed Annuity Payment Option is that the amount of
each Annuity Payment will be set on the Annuity Commencement Date and will not
change. If a Fixed Annuity Payment Option is selected, the Annuity Purchase
Value, less any applicable premium taxes, will be transferred to the general
account of PFL, and the Annuity Payments will be fixed in amount by the fixed
annuity provisions selected and the age and sex (if consideration of sex is
allowed) of the Annuitant. For further information, contact PFL at its Admin-
istrative and Service Office.
 
  FIXED ANNUITY PAYMENT OPTIONS. There are five Fixed Annuity Payment Options.
Options 1, 2, and 4 are based on a guaranteed interest rate of 3%. Options 3
and 5 are based on a guaranteed interest rate of 3% using the "1983 Table a"
mortality table with projection of improved mortality.
 
  OPTION 1 - INTEREST PAYMENTS. The Certificate proceeds may be left with PFL
for any term agreed to. PFL will pay the interest in equal payments or it may
be left to accumulate. Withdrawal rights will be agreed upon by the Certifi-
cate Owner and PFL when the option is elected.
 
  OPTION 2 - INCOME FOR A SPECIFIED PERIOD. Level payments of the proceeds
with interest are made for the fixed period elected, at which time the funds
are exhausted.
 
  OPTION 3 - LIFE INCOME. An election may be made between:
 
  1.  "No Period Certain" - Level payments will be made during the lifetime
      of the Annuitant.
 
  2.  "10 Years Certain" - Level payments will be made for the longer of the
      Annuitant's lifetime or ten years.
 
  3.  "Guaranteed Return of Certificate Proceeds" - Level payments will be
      made for the longer of the Annuitant's lifetime or the number of
      payments which, when added together, equals the proceeds applied to
      the income option.
 
  OPTION 4 - INCOME OF A SPECIFIED AMOUNT. Payments are made for any specified
amount until the proceeds with interest are exhausted.
 
  OPTION 5 - JOINT AND SURVIVOR ANNUITY. Payments are made during the joint
lifetime of the payee and a joint payee of the Certificate Owner's selection.
Payments will be made as long as either person is living.
 
  Other options may be arranged by agreement with PFL. Certain options may not
be available in some states.
 
 
                                      27
<PAGE>
 
  Current immediate annuity rates for the same class of annuities will be used
if higher than the guaranteed rate (guaranteed rates are based upon the tables
contained in the Certificate). Current rates may be obtained from PFL.
 
  VARIABLE ANNUITY PAYMENT OPTIONS. The dollar amount of the first Variable
Annuity Payment will be determined in accordance with the annuity payment
rates set forth in the applicable table contained in the Certificate. The ta-
bles are based on the "1983 Table a" mortality table with projection of im-
proved mortality with a 5% effective annual assumed interest rate and assume a
retirement date in the year 2000. The dollar amount of every subsequent Vari-
able Annuity Payment will vary based on the investment performance of the
Subaccounts of the Variable Account selected by the Annuitant or Beneficiary.
If the actual investment performance exactly matched the assumed interest rate
of 5% at all times, the amount of each Variable Annuity Payment would remain
equal. If actual investment performance exceeds the 5% assumed interest rate,
the amount of the payments would increase. Conversely, if actual investment
performance is worse than the 5% assumed interest rate, the amount of the pay-
ments would decrease.
 
  DETERMINATION OF THE FIRST VARIABLE PAYMENT. The amount of the first vari-
able payment depends upon the sex (if consideration of sex is allowed) and ad-
justed age of the Annuitant (the use of adjusted age results in lower payments
than use of actual age). The adjusted age is the Annuitant's actual age near-
est birthday, at the Annuity Commencement Date, adjusted as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
Annuity Commencement Date      Adjusted Age
   --------------------------------------------
<S>                        <C>
            Before 2001    Actual Age
            2001-2010      Actual Age minus 1
            2011-2020      Actual Age minus 2
            2021-2030      Actual Age minus 3
            2031-2040      Actual Age minus 4
            After 2040     As Determined by PFL
   --------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
 
  The following Variable Payment Options generally are available:
 
  OPTION 3-V - LIFE INCOME. An election may be made between:
 
  1.  "No Period Certain" - Payments will be made during the lifetime of the
      Annuitant.
 
  2.  "10 Years Certain" - Payments will be made for the longer of the
      Annuitant's lifetime or ten years.
 
  OPTION 4-V - INCOME OF A SPECIFIED AMOUNT. Payments are made for any speci-
fied amount until the proceeds with accumulated gains or losses are exhausted.
At any time this option is in effect, the Annuitant can withdraw the remaining
value. The mortality and expense risk charge is applicable to this option (and
all other variable options) although PFL incurs no mortality risk under this
option once annuity payments begin. Payments under this option are considered
withdrawals for Federal Income Tax purposes.
 
 
                                      28
<PAGE>
 
  OPTION 5-V - JOINT AND SURVIVOR ANNUITY. Payments are made as long as either
the Annuitant or the joint Annuitant is living.
 
  DETERMINATION OF SUBSEQUENT VARIABLE PAYMENTS. All Variable Annuity Payments
other than the first are calculated using "Annuity Units" which are credited
to the Certificate. The number of Annuity Units to be credited in respect of a
particular Subaccount is determined by dividing that portion of the first
Variable Annuity Payment attributable to that Subaccount by the Annuity Unit
Value of that Subaccount for the Annuity Commencement Date. The number of An-
nuity Units of each particular Subaccount credited to the Certificate then re-
mains fixed. The dollar value of Annuity Units in the chosen Subaccount will
increase or decrease reflecting the investment experience of the chosen
Subaccount. The dollar amount of each Variable Annuity Payment after the first
may increase, decrease or remain constant, and is equal to the sum of the
amounts determined by multiplying the number of Annuity Units of each particu-
lar Subaccount credited to the Certificate by the Annuity Unit Value for the
particular Subaccount on the date the payment is made.
   
  TRANSFERS. The value of the Annuity Units may be transferred from one
Subaccount to another within the Variable Account or to the Fixed Account. The
minimum amount which may be transferred is the lesser of $10 of monthly income
or the entire monthly income of the variable Annuity Units in the Subaccount
from which the transfer is being made. The remaining Annuity Units in the
Subaccount must provide at least $10 of monthly income. If, after a transfer,
the monthly income of the remaining Annuity Units in a Subaccount would be
less than $10, PFL reserves the right to include those Annuity Units as part
of the transfer. PFL reserves the right to limit transfers between Subaccounts
to once per Certificate Year. After the Annuity Commencement Date no transfers
may be made from the Fixed Account.     
 
                                  -  -  -  -
 
  A portion or the entire amount of the Annuity Payments may be taxable as or-
dinary income. If, at the time the Annuity Payments begin, a written election
has not been made, PFL will deduct withholding for such taxes from the taxable
portion of such Annuity Payments and remit that amount to the federal govern-
ment. (See "Certain Federal Income Tax Consequences," p. 36.)
 
  ADJUSTMENT OF ANNUITY PAYMENTS. Payments will be made at 1, 3, 6, or 12
month intervals. If the individual payments provided for would be or become
less than $30, PFL may change, at its discretion, the frequency of payments to
such intervals as will result in payments of at least $30. If the Annuity Pur-
chase Value, net of any applicable premium taxes, on the Annuity Commencement
Date is less than $2,000, PFL may pay such value in one sum in lieu of the
payments otherwise provided for.
 
DEATH BENEFIT
 
  Federal tax law requires that if any Certificate Owner (of a Nonqualified
Certificate) is a natural person and dies before the Annuity Commencement
Date, then the entire value of the
 
                                      29
<PAGE>
 
Certificate must generally be distributed within five years of the date of
death of the Certificate Owner. If the Certificate Owner is not a natural per-
son, the death of the primary Annuitant triggers the same distribution re-
quirement. For purposes of this distribution requirement, under certain bank
agency or trust arrangements, the Participant may be treated as the Certifi-
cate Owner. Special rules may apply to a surviving spouse. Other rules apply
to Qualified Certificates. See "Certain Federal Tax Consequences," below, for
more information.
 
  DEATH OF ANNUITANT PRIOR TO ANNUITY COMMENCEMENT DATE. A Death Benefit is
payable if the Annuitant dies before the Annuity Commencement Date, and either
(a) the Annuitant is the Certificate Owner, or (b) the Certificate Owner is
not a natural person. In those circumstances, upon receipt of proof of the
Annuitant's death, the Death Benefit is calculated and is payable to the Bene-
ficiary when PFL receives an election of the method of settlement and return
of the Certificate. The Death Benefit will be the greater of (a) the Annuity
Purchase Value on the date proof of death and election of the method of set-
tlement are received; or (b) the total premiums paid less any partial with-
drawals plus interest at an annual rate of 5.0%. The Death Benefit may be paid
as either a lump sum cash benefit or as an Annuity Payment Option.
 
  Note that the Death Benefit is payable on the death of the Annuitant under
the circumstances described above, and not on the death of the Certificate
Owner, if different. The Certificate Owner, if a natural person, will become
the Annuitant if the Annuitant who is not the Certificate Owner dies before
the Annuity Commencement Date.
 
  Due Proof of Death of the Annuitant is proof that the Annuitant died prior
to the commencement of Annuity Payments. Upon receipt of this proof and an
election of a method of settlement and return of the Certificate, the Death
Benefit generally will be paid within seven days, or as soon thereafter as PFL
has sufficient information about the Beneficiary to make the payment. The Ben-
eficiary may receive the amount payable in a lump sum cash benefit, or, sub-
ject to any limitation under any state or federal law, rule, or regulation,
under one of the Annuity Payment Options described above, unless a settlement
agreement is effective at the death of the Annuitant preventing such election.
 
  If the Beneficiary was not the Annuitant's spouse, the Death Benefit must
(1) be distributed within five years of the Annuitant's death, or (2) payments
under a Payment Option must begin within one year of the Annuitant's death and
must be made for the Beneficiary's lifetime or for a period certain (so long
as any certain period does not exceed the Beneficiary's life expectancy).
Death proceeds which are not paid to or for the benefit of a natural person
must be distributed within five years of the date of death. A Beneficiary who
is the Certificate Owner's surviving spouse may elect to continue the Certifi-
cate as the new Annuitant and Participant or Policy Owner instead of receiving
the Death Benefit.
 
  DEATH OF ANNUITANT ON OR AFTER ANNUITY COMMENCEMENT DATE. The Death Benefit,
if any, payable if the Annuitant dies on or after the Annuity Commencement
Date depends on the Annuity Payment Option selected. Upon the Annuitant's
death, the remaining portion of the Annuitant's interest in the Certificate
will be distributed at least as rapidly as under the method of distribution
being used as of the date of the Annuitant's death.
 
                                      30
<PAGE>
 
  BENEFICIARY. The Beneficiary designation in the application will remain in
effect until changed. The Certificate Owner may change the designated Benefi-
ciary by sending Written Notice to PFL. The Beneficiary's consent to such
change is not required unless the Beneficiary was irrevocably designated or
consent is required by law. (If an irrevocable Beneficiary dies, the Certifi-
cate Owner may then designate a new Beneficiary.) The change will take effect
as of the date the Certificate Owner signs the Written Notice, whether or not
the Certificate Owner (if a natural person) is living when the Notice is re-
ceived by PFL. PFL will not be liable for any payment made before the Written
Notice is received. If more than one Beneficiary is designated, and their in-
terests have not been specified, they will share equally.
 
  DEATH OF NATURAL PERSON CERTIFICATE OWNER. If the Certificate Owner is a
natural person and is not the Annuitant and that Certificate Owner dies before
the Annuity Commencement Date, the successor owner (or the Certificate Owner's
estate, if there is no successor owner) will become the new Certificate Owner.
If ownership of the Certificate is transferred (except to the Certificate Own-
er's spouse) because the Certificate Owner dies before the Annuitant, the Cash
Value generally must be distributed within five years of the Certificate Own-
er's death, or payments must be made for a period certain or for the successor
owner's lifetime so long as any period certain does not exceed that successor
owner's life expectancy, if the first payment begins within one year of the
Certificate Owner's death.
 
RESTRICTIONS UNDER THE TEXAS OPTIONAL RETIREMENT PROGRAM
 
  Section 36.105 of the Texas Educational Code permits participants in the
Texas Optional Retirement Program (ORP) to withdraw their interest in a vari-
able annuity policy issued under the ORP only upon: (1) termination of employ-
ment in the Texas public instructions of higher education; (2) retirement; or
(3) death. Accordingly, a Participant or Policy Owner in the ORP (or the Par-
ticipant's or Policy Owner's estate if the Participant or Policy Owner has
died) will be required to obtain a certificate of termination from the em-
ployer or a certificate of death before a Certificate can be redeemed.
 
RESTRICTIONS UNDER SECTION 403(b) PLAN
 
  Section 403(b) of the Internal Revenue Code provides for tax deferred re-
tirement savings plans for employees of certain non-profit and educational or-
ganizations. In accordance with the requirements of Section 403(b), any Cer-
tificate used for a 403(b) plan will prohibit distributions of elective con-
tributions and earnings on elective contributions except upon death of the em-
ployee, attainment of age 59 1/2, separation from service, disability, or fi-
nancial hardship. In addition, income attributable to elective contributions
may not be distributed in the case of hardship.
   
RESTRICTIONS UNDER OTHER QUALIFIED CERTIFICATES     
   
  Other restrictions on surrenders or with respect to the election, commence-
ment or distribution of benefits may apply under Qualified Certificates or un-
der the terms of the plans in respect of which the Certificates are issued.
    
                                      31
<PAGE>
 
                            CHARGES AND DEDUCTIONS
 
  No deductions are made from premium payments, so that the full amount of
each premium payment is invested in the Variable Account. PFL will make cer-
tain charges and deductions in connection with the Certificate in order to
compensate it for bearing mortality and expense risks under the Certificate
and for administering the Variable Account and the Certificates. Charges may
also be made for premium taxes, federal, state or local taxes, any economic
burden resulting from such taxes or for certain transfers or other transac-
tions. Charges and expenses are also deducted from the Portfolios.
 
EXCESS INTEREST ADJUSTMENT
 
  Any full or partial withdrawal of a Guaranteed Period Amount which is not
effective during the 30 days prior to the Expiration Date of the applicable
Guaranteed Period will be subject to an Excess Interest Adjustment. For this
purpose, transfers and systematic withdrawals are treated as withdrawals. The
Excess Interest Adjustment will be added to or subtracted from the gross
amount being withdrawn after deductions of any applicable charges.
 
  Generally, if PFL's Guaranteed Interest Rate declines, the Cash Value will
be increased in inverse proportion to the decline as a result of the applica-
tion of the Excess Interest Adjustment. Similarly, if PFL's Guaranteed Inter-
est Rate increases, the Cash Value will be correspondingly reduced. However,
in no event will the reductions in the amount withdrawn ever result in less
than a 3% annual interest rate on amounts allocated to the Fixed Account.
 
  The Excess Interest Adjustment will reflect the relationship between PFL's
current guaranteed interest rate (defined as "C" below) for the Guaranteed Pe-
riod which is next longer than the remaining time until expiration of the
Guaranteed Period from which the withdrawal is being made and the guaranteed
interest rate applicable to the amount being withdrawn (defined as "G" below).
It also reflects the time remaining in the applicable Guaranteed Period. The
application of the Excess Interest Adjustment upon withdrawal may result in a
higher or lower payment than the Guarantee Period Amount.
 
  The Excess Interest Adjustment ("EIA") is determined by the application of
the following formula:
 
                           EIA = S X (G-C) X (M/12)
 
Where:
 
  S is the gross withdrawal as of the effective date of the application of the
Excess Interest Adjustment, prior to the application of the Excess Interest
Adjustment and any applicable charges;
 
  C is the guaranteed interest rate declared by PFL, as of the effective date
of the application of the Excess Interest Adjustment, for the Guaranteed Pe-
riod which is next longer than the
 
                                      32
<PAGE>
 
remaining time until expiration of the Guaranteed Period from which the with-
drawal is being made. If such an option is no longer offered, "C" will be the
U.S. Treasury rate on the twenty-fifth day of the previous calendar month for
the next longer maturity (in whole years) than "M," plus 2%;
 
  G is the Guaranteed Interest Rate currently being credited to the Guaranteed
Period Amount subject to the Excess Interest Adjustment; and
 
  M is the number of months remaining in the Guaranteed Period rounded up to
the next higher whole number of months.
 
  Notwithstanding application of the foregoing formula, the gross withdrawal
minus the Excess Interest Adjustment will not be less than the amount of the
premium payment being withdrawn, accumulated at three (3%) percent interest
compounded annually since the beginning of the Guaranteed Period. Thus, a neg-
ative Excess Interest Adjustment could result in the loss of all previously
credited interest in excess of 3% per year, but it will not result in any loss
of principal (the premium payments) or the 3% guaranteed minimum interest.
 
  See Appendix A for examples of the Excess Interest Adjustment calculation.
 
MORTALITY AND EXPENSE RISK CHARGE
 
  PFL imposes a daily charge as compensation for bearing certain mortality and
expense risks in connection with the Certificates. This charge is equal to an
effective annual rate of 1.00% of the value of net assets in the Variable Ac-
count. The Mortality and Expense Risk Charge is reflected in the Accumulation
Unit or Annuity Unit values for the Certificate for each Subaccount. The rate
of this charge is guaranteed not to increase.
 
  Annuity Purchase Value and annuity payments are neither affected by changes
in actual mortality experience nor by actual expenses incurred by PFL. The
mortality risks assumed by PFL arise from its contractual obligations to make
annuity payments (determined in accordance with the annuity tables and other
provisions contained in the Certificate). Thus, Participants and Policy Owners
(i.e., the Annuitants) are assured that neither an Annuitant's own longevity
nor an unanticipated improvement in general life expectancy will adversely af-
fect the monthly Annuity Payments that the Annuitant will receive under the
Certificate.
 
  PFL also bears substantial risk in connection with its Death Benefit guaran-
tee since PFL will pay a Death Benefit equal to the premium payments, less
withdrawals, plus interest at 5% per year, if that amount is higher than the
Annuity Purchase Value. The Death Benefit is paid without imposition of the
Excess Interest Adjustment.
 
  The expense risk assumed by PFL is the risk that PFL's actual expenses in
administering the Certificate and the Variable Account will exceed the amount
recovered through the Administrative Charge.
 
 
                                      33
<PAGE>
 
  If the Mortality and Expense Risk Charge is insufficient to cover PFL's ac-
tual costs, PFL will bear the loss; conversely, if the charge is more than
sufficient to cover costs, the excess will be profit to PFL. PFL expects a
profit from this charge. PFL's expenses for distributing the Certificates will
be borne by the general assets of PFL which may include amounts, if any, de-
rived from the Mortality and Expense Risk Charge.
 
ADMINISTRATIVE CHARGE
 
  In order to cover the costs of administering the Certificates and the Vari-
able Account, PFL deducts an Administrative Charge from the Annuity Purchase
Value of each Certificate.
 
  The annual Administrative Charge is deducted from the Annuity Purchase Value
of each Certificate on each anniversary of the issuance of the Certificate
prior to the Annuity Commencement Date to cover the cost of administering the
Certificate during the prior year. On or after the Annuity Commencement Date,
the charge is not deducted. This annual Administrative Charge is $30, and it
will not be increased. It will never exceed 2% of the Annuity Purchase Value.
PFL does not anticipate realizing any profit from this charge. The Administra-
tive Charge will be deducted from each Subaccount in the Variable Account, in
the same proportion that the Certificate Owner's interest in each Subaccount
before such charge bears to the Annuity Purchase Value in the Variable Ac-
count. The Administrative Charge is not deducted from the Annuity Purchase
Value in the Fixed Account.
 
PREMIUM TAXES
 
  PFL currently makes no deduction from the premium payments for any state
premium taxes PFL pays in connection with premium payments under the Certifi-
cates. However, PFL will deduct the aggregate premium taxes paid on behalf of
a particular Certificate from the Annuity Purchase Value on (i) the Annuity
Commencement Date, (ii) the total withdrawal of a Certificate, or (iii) pay-
ment of the Death Benefit.
 
FEDERAL, STATE AND LOCAL TAXES
 
  No charges are currently made for federal, state, or local taxes or the eco-
nomic burden resulting from the application of the tax laws other than premium
taxes. However, PFL reserves the right to deduct charges in the future from
the Subaccounts and Guaranteed Periods for any taxes or other economic burden
resulting from the application of any tax laws that PFL determines to be at-
tributable to the Certificates.
 
TRANSFER CHARGE
 
  There is no charge for the first 12 transfers among Subaccounts or to and
from the Fixed Account Guaranteed Periods in each Certificate Year. PFL re-
serves the right to impose a $25 charge for the thirteenth and each subsequent
transfer request during a single Certificate Year. For the purpose of deter-
mining whether a transfer charge is payable, initial premium payment alloca-
tions are not considered transfers. All transfer requests made simultaneously
will be treated as a
 
                                      34
<PAGE>
 
single request. No transfer charge will be imposed for any transfer which is
not at the Certificate Owner's request.
 
OTHER EXPENSES
 
  Each of the Portfolios is responsible for all of its expenses. In addition,
charges will be made against each of the Portfolios for investment advisory
services provided to the Portfolio. The net assets of each Portfolio will re-
flect deductions in connection with the investment advisory fee and other ex-
penses.
 
  For more information concerning the investment advisory fee and other
charges against the Portfolios, see the prospectus for the Trust, a current
copy of which accompanies this Prospectus.
 
  With respect to Certificates sold in bank trust or agency arrangements, the
bank typically charges trust, management, or other fees that may vary from
bank to bank and that may also vary depending on the type of arrangement, the
amounts involved, and/or other factors.
 
                          HISTORICAL PERFORMANCE DATA
 
STANDARDIZED PERFORMANCE DATA
 
  From time to time, PFL may advertise historical yields and total returns for
the Subaccounts of the Variable Account. These figures will be calculated ac-
cording to standardized methods prescribed by the SEC. They will be based on
historical earnings and are not intended to indicate future performance.
 
  The yield of a Subaccount of the Variable Account for a Certificate refers
to the annualized income generated by an investment under a Certificate in the
Subaccount over a specified thirty-day period. The yield is calculated by as-
suming that the income generated by the investment during that thirty-day pe-
riod is generated each thirty-day period over a 12-month period and is shown
as a percentage of the investment.
 
  The total return of a Subaccount of the Variable Account refers to return
quotations assuming an investment under a Certificate has been held in the
Subaccount for various periods of time including, but not limited to, a period
measured from the date the Subaccount commenced operations. When a Subaccount
has been in operation for one, five, and ten years, respectively, the total
return for these periods will be provided. The total return quotations for a
Subaccount will represent the average annual compounded rates of return that
equate an initial investment of $1,000 in the Subaccount to the redemption
value of that investment as of the first day of each of the periods for which
total return quotations are provided.
 
                                      35
<PAGE>
 
  The yield and total return calculations for a Subaccount do not reflect the
effect of any premium taxes that may be applicable to a particular Certifi-
cate. To the extent that a premium tax is applicable to a particular Certifi-
cate, the yield and/or total return of that Certificate will be reduced. For
additional information regarding yields and total returns calculated using the
standard formats briefly summarized above, please refer to the Statement of
Additional Information, a free copy of which may be obtained from PFL.
 
NON-STANDARDIZED PERFORMANCE DATA
 
  PFL may from time to time also advertise or disclose average annual total
return or other performance data in non-standard formats for a Subaccount of
the Variable Account. The non-standard performance data may make certain as-
sumptions.
 
  All non-standard performance data will be advertised only if the standard
performance data is also disclosed. For additional information regarding the
calculation of other performance data, please refer to the Statement of Addi-
tional Information, a copy of which may be obtained from PFL.
 
                    CERTAIN FEDERAL INCOME TAX CONSEQUENCES
 
  The following summary does not constitute tax advice. It is a general dis-
cussion of certain of the expected federal income tax consequences of invest-
ment in and distributions with respect to a Certificate, based on the Internal
Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), proposed and final Treasury
Regulations thereunder, judicial authority, and current administrative rulings
and practice. This summary discusses only certain federal income tax conse-
quences to "United States Persons," and does not discuss state, local, or for-
eign tax consequences. United States Persons means citizens or residents of
the United States, domestic corporations, domestic partnerships and trusts or
estates that are subject to United States federal income tax regardless of the
source of their income.
 
  A Qualified Certificate may be purchased by retirement plans intended to
qualify for special tax treatment under Code sections 401, 403, 408 and 457,
although bank trust or agency arrangements may not be suitable for certain
types of Qualified Certificates. A Non-Qualified Certificate may be purchased
for deferred compensation plans and other purposes which do not qualify for
such special federal income tax treatment. The ultimate effect of federal in-
come taxes on the value of a Certificate, on income Payments, and on the eco-
nomic benefit of the Certificate to the Participant, or the Certificate Owner,
the Annuitant, or the Beneficiary depends upon several factors. These factors
include: (1) the type of retirement plan, if any; (2) the tax status and em-
ployment status of the individual concerned; and (3) PFL's tax status.
 
  In addition, certain requirements must be satisfied if a Qualified Certifi-
cate is purchased with proceeds from a tax-qualified retirement plan in order
to continue receiving favorable tax treatment. Therefore, competent legal
counsel and tax advisers should be consulted regarding the suitability of the
Certificates, the applicable requirements and the tax treatment of the rights
and
 
                                      36
<PAGE>
 
benefits of the Certificate. This summary assumes that Qualified Certificates
are purchased with proceeds from retirement plans that qualify for the in-
tended special federal income tax treatment.
 
THE DISCUSSION SET FORTH BELOW IS INCLUDED FOR GENERAL PURPOSES ONLY. EACH PO-
TENTIAL PURCHASER IS URGED TO CONSULT HIS/HER OWN TAX ADVISER AS TO THE CONSE-
QUENCES OF INVESTMENT IN A CERTIFICATE UNDER FEDERAL AND APPLICABLE STATE, LO-
CAL AND FOREIGN TAX LAWS.
 
TAX STATUS OF THE CERTIFICATE
 
  DIVERSIFICATION REQUIREMENTS. Section 817(h) of the Code provides that, in
order for a variable contract which is based on a segregated asset account to
qualify as an annuity contract under the Code, the investments made by such
account must be "adequately diversified" in accordance with Treasury regula-
tions. The Treasury regulations issued under Section 817(h) (Treas. Reg.
1.817-5) apply a diversification requirement to each of the Subaccounts of the
Variable Account. The Variable Account, through the Trust and its Portfolios,
intends to comply with the diversification requirements of the Treasury. PFL
has entered into agreements regarding participation in the Trust that requires
the Portfolios to be operated in compliance with the Treasury regulations.
 
  CERTIFICATE OWNER CONTROL. In certain circumstances, owners of variable an-
nuity contracts may be considered the owners, for Federal income tax purposes,
of the assets of the separate account used to support their contracts. In
those circumstances, income and gains from the separate account assets would
be includable in the variable annuity contractowner's gross income. The IRS
has stated in published rulings that a variable contractowner will be consid-
ered the owner of separate account assets if the contractowner possesses inci-
dents of ownership in those assets, such as the ability to exercise investment
control over the assets. The Treasury Department has also announced, in con-
nection with the issuance of regulations concerning investment diversifica-
tion, that those regulations "do not provide guidance concerning the circum-
stances in which investor control of the investments of a segregated asset ac-
count may cause the investor, rather than the insurance company, to be treated
as the owner of the assets in the account." This announcement also stated that
guidance would be issued by way of regulations or rulings on the "extent to
which policyholders may direct their investments to particular subaccounts
without being treated as owners of the underlying assets."
 
  The ownership rights under the Certificate are similar to, but different in
certain respects from, those described by the Service in rulings in which it
was determined that contractowners were not owners of separate account assets.
For example, the Certificate Owner has the choice of one or more Subaccounts
in which to allocate premiums and Certificate values, and may be able to
transfer among Subaccounts more frequently than in such rulings, or if a
Subaccount is too narrow in its investment strategy (e.g., a fund that invests
only in gold or stock of gold mining companies), or if Certificate Owners have
too many subaccount options to select. These differences could result in the
Certificate Owner being treated as the owner of the assets of the Variable Ac-
count. In addition, PFL does not know what standards will be set forth, if
any, in the regulations or rulings which the Treasury Department has stated it
expects to issue. PFL therefore reserves
 
                                      37
<PAGE>
 
the right to modify the Certificate as necessary to attempt to prevent the
Certificate Owner from being considered the owner of a pro rata share of as-
sets of Variable Account.
 
  NON-NATURAL PERSONS. Pursuant to Section 72(u) of the Code, an annuity con-
tract held by a taxpayer other than a natural person generally will not be
treated as an annuity contract under the Code; accordingly, a Certificate
Owner who is not a natural person will recognize as ordinary income for a tax-
able year the excess of (i) the sum of the net surrender value as of the close
of the taxable year and all previous distributions under the Certificate over
(ii) the sum of the premium payments paid for the taxable year and any prior
taxable year and the amounts includable in gross income for any prior taxable
year with respect to the Certificate. Notwithstanding the preceding sentence,
Section 72(u) of the Code does not apply to, among other things, (i) a Certif-
icate the nominal owner of which is not a natural person but the beneficial
owner of which is a natural person (including a situation where the Certifi-
cate is held by a trust or other entity as an agent for a natural person),
(ii) a single-payment annuity the Annuity Commencement Date for which is no
later than one year from the date of the single premium payment, or (iii) a
qualified funding asset. Accordingly, a Certificate owned by a grantor trust
(as defined in Sections 671 through 678 of the Code) in which the grantor is a
natural person, should be treated as an annuity contract under the Code. Under
certain circumstances, a trust may be a grantor trust where the grantor of the
trust retains any one or more of a number of powers over the trust property,
including but not limited to the power to revoke the trust and revest the
trust property in the grantor, the power to control beneficial enjoyment of
the trust property, or the right to receive trust income. If a Certificate may
be held by a non-natural person (including bank trust or agency arrangements),
advice on the possible application of Section 72(u) should be sought from a
competent tax advisor.
 
  DISTRIBUTION REQUIREMENTS. The Code also requires that Nonqualified Certifi-
cates contain specific provisions for distribution of Certificate proceeds
upon the death of certain individuals. If the Certificate Owner is a natural
person, then the death of the Certificate Owner triggers the distribution re-
quirement. If the Certificate Owner is not a natural person, then the death of
the primary Annuitant triggers the distribution requirement. For this purpose,
it is unclear whether, in certain circumstances, the Participant may be
treated as the Certificate Owner. In order to be treated as an annuity con-
tract for federal income tax purposes, the Code requires that Certificates
provide that if the death occurs on or after the Annuity Commencement Date and
before the entire interest in the Certificate has been distributed, the re-
maining portion must be distributed at least as rapidly as under the method in
effect on the date of death. If the death occurs before the Annuity Commence-
ment Date, the entire interest in the Certificate must generally be distrib-
uted within 5 years after the date of death or be used to purchase an immedi-
ate annuity under which payments will begin within one year of the date of
death and will be made for the life of the Beneficiary or for a period not ex-
tending beyond the life expectancy of the Beneficiary. If the designated Bene-
ficiary is the spouse of the deceased, and the death occurs before the Annuity
Commencement Date, the Certificate may be continued with the surviving spouse
as the new owner. The Certificate contains provisions intended to comply with
these requirements of the Code. No regulations interpreting these requirements
of the Code have yet been issued and thus no assurance can be given that the
provisions contained in the Certificates satisfy all such Code requirements.
The provisions contained in the Certificates will be reviewed and modified if
necessary to assure that they comply with the Code requirements when clarified
by regulation or otherwise. Other, similar rules apply to Qualified Certifi-
cates.
 
                                      38
<PAGE>
 
TAXATION OF ANNUITIES
 
  The discussion below applies only to those Certificates owned or deemed to
be owned by natural persons and that qualify as annuity contracts for federal
income tax purposes.
 
  IN GENERAL. Except as described above with respect to Certificate Owners who
are not natural persons, an owner of a Certificate satisfying the diversifica-
tion and distribution requirements described above should not be taxed on in-
creases in the Annuity Purchase Value until distribution occurs either in the
form of amounts received in partial or full withdrawal or as Annuity Payments
under the Annuity Payment Option selected or as a Death Benefit payment. The
taxable portion of any such distribution generally will be taxed as ordinary
income. For this purpose, the assignment, pledge or agreement to assign or
pledge any portion of the Annuity Purchase Value (including assignment of Cer-
tificate Owner's right to receive Annuity Payments prior to the Annuity Com-
mencement Date) generally will be treated as a distribution in the amount of
such portion of the Annuity Purchase Value. Additionally, if the Certificate
Owner designates a new owner prior to the Annuity Commencement Date without
receiving full and adequate consideration, the old owner generally will be
treated as receiving a distribution under the Certificate in an amount equal
to the excess (if any) of the Annuity Purchase Value at the time of such des-
ignation over the "Investment in the Certificate" at such time. "Investment in
the Certificate" means (i) the aggregate amount of any premium payments by or
on behalf of the recipient or deemed recipient which was not excluded from the
gross income of the recipient or deemed recipient minus (ii) the aggregate
amount received under the Certificate which was excluded from the gross income
of the recipient or deemed recipient. Any such deemed distributions occurring
before the Annuity Commencement Date generally will be taxable only up to an
amount equal to the excess (if any) of the Annuity Purchase Value immediately
before the distribution is deemed to occur over the Investment in the Certifi-
cate at such time.
 
  A transfer of ownership of a Certificate, or designation of a Beneficiary or
payee who is not also the owner, may result in certain tax consequences to the
owner that are not discussed herein. Any person contemplating making, any such
transfer or assignment of rights under a Certificate should contact a compe-
tent tax adviser with respect to the potential tax effects of such a transac-
tion.
 
  WITHDRAWALS. In the case of a partial Withdrawal under a Qualified Certifi-
cate, under section 72(e) of the Code a ratable portion of the amount received
is taxable, generally based on the ratio of the "Investment in the Certifi-
cate" to the individual's total accrued benefit under the retirement plan. The
"Investment in the Certificate" generally equals the amount of any premium
payments paid by or on behalf of any individual. For a Certificate issued in
connection with qualified plans, the "Investment in the Certificate" can be
zero. Special tax rules may be available for certain distributions from a
Qualified Certificate.
 
  With respect to Nonqualified Certificates, partial withdrawals are generally
treated as taxable income to the extent that the Annuity Purchase Value imme-
diately before the Withdrawal exceeds the "Investment in the Certificate" at
that time. The Annuity Purchase Value immediately before a partial Withdrawal
may have to be increased by any positive Excess Interest Adjustment which re-
sults from such a Withdrawal. There is, however, no definitive guidance on the
proper tax
 
                                      39
<PAGE>
 
treatment of Excess Interest Adjustments, and the Certificate Owner should
contact a competent tax advisor with respect to the potential tax consequence
of an Excess Interest Adjustment. Full Withdrawals are treated as taxable in-
come to the extent that the amount received exceeds the "Investment in the
Certificate."
 
  ANNUITY PAYMENTS. Although the tax consequences may vary depending on the
Annuity Payment Option elected under the Certificate, in general, only the
portion of the Annuity Payment that represents the amount by which the Cash
Value exceeds the "Investment in the Certificate" will be taxed; after the
"Investment in the Certificate" is recovered, the full amount of any addi-
tional Annuity Payments is taxable. For Variable Annuity Payments, the taxable
portion is generally determined by an equation that establishes a specific
dollar amount of each payment that is not taxed. The dollar amount is deter-
mined by dividing the "Investment in the Certificate" by the total number of
expected periodic payments. However, the entire distribution will be taxable
once the recipient has recovered the dollar amount of his or her "Investment
in the Certificate." For Fixed Annuity Payments, in general there is no tax on
the portion of each payment which represents the same ratio that the "Invest-
ment in the Certificate" bears to the total expected value of the Annuity Pay-
ments for the term of the payments; however, the remainder of each Annuity
Payment is taxable. Once the "Investment in the Certificate" has been fully
recovered, the full amount of any additional Annuity Payments is taxable. If
Annuity Payments cease as a result of an Annuitant's death before full recov-
ery of the "Investment in the Certificate," consult a competent tax advisor
regarding deductibility of the unrecovered amount.
 
  PENALTY TAXES. In the case of a withdrawal or a deemed distribution (result-
ing from a pledge, assignment or an agreement to pledge or assign) or an Annu-
ity Payment, there may be imposed on the recipient a federal penalty tax equal
to 10% of the amount of the distribution (or deemed distribution) that is
includable in gross income. The penalty tax on Nonqualified Certificates gen-
erally will not apply to any distribution: (i) made on or after the date on
which the taxpayer attains age 59 1/2; (ii) made as a result of the death of
the holder (generally the Participant or Policy Owner); (iii) attributable to
the disability of the taxpayer; or (iv) which is part of a series of substan-
tially equal periodic payments made (not less frequently than annually) for
the life (or life expectancy) of the taxpayer or the joint lives (or joint
life expectancies) of such taxpayer and his/her beneficiary. Other tax penal-
ties may apply to Qualified Certificates.
 
  DEATH BENEFIT. Amounts may be distributed from a Certificate because of the
death of an Annuitant or Certificate Owner. Generally, such amounts are
includable in the income of the recipient as follows: (i) if distributed in a
lump sum, they are taxed in the same manner as a full withdrawal, as described
above, or (ii) if distributed under an annuity option, they are taxed in the
same manner as annuity payments, as described above. For these purposes, the
"Investment in the Certificate" is not affected by the Certificate Owner's or
Annuitant's death. That is, the "Investment in the Certificate" remains the
amount of any purchase payments paid which were not excluded from gross in-
come.
 
  WITHHOLDING. The portion of any distribution under a Certificate that is
includable in gross income will be subject to federal income tax withholding,
although generally the recipient of such distribution can elect not to have
federal income tax withheld. Election forms will be provided at the time dis-
tributions are requested or made. Certain distributions from Qualified Certif-
icates are subject to mandatory federal income tax withholding.
 
                                      40
<PAGE>
 
  SERIAL CONTRACTS. All non-qualified deferred annuity contracts issued by the
same company (or an affiliated company) in respect of the same policyholder
during any calendar year shall be treated as one annuity contract, and "aggre-
gated" for purposes of determining the amount includable in gross income. It
is unclear whether all Certificates issued through the same bank trust depart-
ment, or held in the same bank trust or agency account, or held in the same
nominal name by a bank or its trust department, will be treated as having the
same policyholder, and therefore "aggregated" for this purpose.
 
  QUALIFIED CERTIFICATES. Qualified Certificates are designed for use with
several types of retirement plans. The tax rules applicable to participants
and beneficiaries in retirement plans vary according to the type of plan and
the terms and conditions of the plan. Special favorable tax treatment may be
available for certain types of contributions and distributions. Adverse tax
consequences may result from contributions in excess of specified limits; dis-
tributions prior to age 59 1/2 (subject to certain exceptions); distributions
that do not conform to specified commencement and minimum distribution rules;
aggregate distributions in excess of a specified annual amount, and in other
specified circumstances.
 
  This prospectus makes no attempt to provide more than general information
about use of the Certificates with the various types of retirement plans. Cer-
tificate Owners and participants under retirement plans as well as Annuitants
and Beneficiaries are cautioned that the rights of any person to any benefits
under Qualified Certificates may be subject to the terms and conditions of the
plans themselves, regardless of the terms and conditions of the Certificate
issued in connection with such a plan. Some retirement plans are subject to
distribution and other requirements that are not incorporated into our admin-
istration procedures for Qualified Certificates. Owners, participants and ben-
eficiaries are responsible for determining that contributions, distributions
and other transactions with respect to the Qualified Certificates comply with
applicable law. Purchasers of Certificates for use with any retirement plan
should consult their legal counsel and tax adviser regarding the suitability
of the Certificate.
 
  In particular, a competent tax adviser should be consulted before a Certifi-
cate held through a bank trust or agency arrangement is purchased in connec-
tion with a Section 403(a), 403(b), or 408(b) arrangement. It is unclear
whether such an arrangement satisfies the tax qualification requirements and
thus is suitable for these types of plans. Individual annuity policies, where
available, may be purchased directly (not through bank trust or agency ar-
rangements) for these plans.
 
  CODE SECTION 403(B) PLANS. Under Code section 403(b), payments made by pub-
lic school systems and certain tax exempt organizations to purchase annuity
contracts for their employees are excludable from the gross income of the em-
ployee, subject to certain limitations. However, these payments may be subject
to FICA (Social Security) taxes.
 
  Code section 403(b)(11) restricts the distribution under Code section 403(b)
annuity contracts of: (1) elective contributions made in years beginning after
December 31, 1988; (2) earnings on those contributions; and (3) earnings in
such years on amounts held as of the last year beginning before January 1,
1989. Distribution of those amounts may only occur upon death of the employee,
attainment of age 59 1/2, separation from service, disability, or financial
hardship. In addition, income attributable to elective contributions may not
be distributed in the case of hardship.
 
                                      41
<PAGE>
 
  INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT ACCOUNTS. Section 408(a) of the Code permits individu-
als to establish individual retirement accounts with banks or other qualified
IRA sponsors. Certificates may be purchased by the IRA trustee or custodian to
fund these IRA's.
 
  INDIVIDUAL RETIREMENT ANNUITIES. In order to qualify as an individual re-
tirement annuity under Section 408(b) of the Code, a Certificate must contain
certain provisions: (i) the Participant or Policy Owner must be the Annuitant;
(ii) the Certificate may not be transferable by the Participant or Policy Own-
er, e.g., the Participant or Policy Owner may not designate a new Participant
or Policy Owner, a successor Participant or Policy Owner, or assign the Cer-
tificate as collateral security; (iii) the total premium payments for any cal-
endar year may not exceed $2,000, unless the portion of such premium payments
in excess of $2,000 qualifies as a rollover amount which meets the definition
of 408(d)(3) of the Code; (iv) annuity payments or withdrawals must begin no
later than April 1 of the calendar year following the calendar year in which
the Annuitant attains age 70 1/2; (v) an Annuity Payment Option with a Period
Certain that will guarantee Annuity Payments beyond the life expectancy of the
Annuitant and the Beneficiary may not be selected; and (vi) certain payments
of Death Benefits must be made in the event of the Annuitant dies prior to the
distribution of the Annuity Purchase Value. Certificates intended to qualify
as individual retirement annuities under Section 408(b) of the Code contain
such provisions.
 
  CORPORATE PENSION AND PROFIT SHARING PLANS AND H.R. 10 PLANS. Code section
401(a) permits employers to establish various types of retirement plans and
trusts for employees, and permits self-employed individuals to establish re-
tirement plans and trusts for themselves and their employees. These retirement
plans and trusts may permit the purchase of the Certificate by the plan
trustee to accumulate retirement savings under the plans. Section 403(a) per-
mits the establishment of similar plans funded with annuity contracts. Adverse
tax consequences to the plan, to the plan participant or to both may result if
the Certificate is assigned or transferred to any individual as a means to
provide benefit payments. Thus, before purchasing such a Certificate, a compe-
tent tax adviser should be consulted.
 
  DEFERRED COMPENSATION PLANS. Section 457 of the Code, while not actually
providing for a qualified plan as that term is normally used, provides for
certain deferred compensation plans with respect to service for state govern-
ments, local governments, political sub-divisions, agencies, instrumentalities
and certain affiliates of such entities and tax exempt organizations which en-
joy special treatment. The Certificates can be used with such plans. Under
such plans a participant may specify the form of investment in which his or
her participation will be made. All such investments, however, are owned by,
and are subject to, the claims of the general creditors of the sponsoring em-
ployer. Depending on the terms of the particular plan, the employer may be en-
titled to draw on deferred amounts for purposes unrelated to its section 457
plan obligations. In general, all amounts received under a section 457 plan
are taxable and are subject to federal income tax withholding as wages.
 
  POSSIBLE CHANGES IN TAXATION. In past years, legislation has been proposed
in the U.S. Congress that would have adversely modified the federal taxation
of certain annuities. For example, one such proposal would have changed the
tax treatment of non-qualified annuities that did not have "substantial life
contingencies" by taxing income as it is credited to the annuity.
 
                                      42
<PAGE>
 
Although as of the date of this Prospectus, Congress is not actively consider-
ing any legislation regarding the taxation of annuities, there is always the
possibility that the tax treatment of annuities could change by legislation or
other means (such as IRS regulations, revenue rulings, judicial decisions,
etc.). Moreover, it is also possible that any change could be retroactive
(that is, effective prior to the date of the change).
 
                        DISTRIBUTOR OF THE CERTIFICATES
 
  Wright Investors' Service Distributors, Inc., an affiliate of the Adviser,
is the principal underwriter of the Certificates. PFL pays Wright Investor's
Service Distributors, Inc. a service fee of .50% of the Annuity Purchase Value
per year. Wright Investors' Service Distributors, Inc. may enter into one or
more contracts with various broker-dealers for the distribution of the Certif-
icates.
 
                                 VOTING RIGHTS
 
  To the extent required by law, PFL will vote Portfolio shares held by the
Variable Account at regular and special shareholder meetings of the Portfolios
in accordance with instructions received from persons having voting interests
in the Portfolios. If, however, the 1940 Act or any regulation thereunder
should be amended or if the present interpretation thereof should be amended
or if the present interpretation thereof should change, and as a result PFL
determines that it is permitted to vote the Portfolio's shares in its own
right, it may elect to do so.
 
  Before the Annuity Commencement Date, the Certificate Owner holds the voting
interest in the selected Portfolios. The number of votes that the Certificate
Owner has the right to instruct will be calculated separately for each
Subaccount. The number of votes that the Certificate Owner has the right to
instruct for a particular Subaccount will be determined by dividing the Cer-
tificate Owner's Annuity Purchase Value in the Subaccount by the net asset
value per share of the corresponding Portfolio in which the Subaccount in-
vests. Fractional shares will be counted.
 
  After the Annuity Commencement Date, the person receiving Annuity Payments
has the voting interest, and the number of votes decreases as Annuity Payments
are made and as the reserves for the Certificate decrease. The person's number
of votes will be determined by dividing the reserve for the Certificate allo-
cated to the applicable Subaccount by the net asset value per share of the
corresponding Portfolio of the Trust. Fractional shares will be counted.
 
  The number of votes that the Certificate Owner, or person receiving income
payments has the right to instruct will be determined as of the date estab-
lished by the Trust for determining shareholders eligible to vote at the meet-
ing of the Trust. PFL will solicit voting instructions by sending, to the Cer-
tificate Owner, or to other persons entitled to vote written requests for in-
structions prior to that meeting in accordance with procedures established by
the Trust. Portfolio shares as to which no timely instructions are received
and shares held by PFL in which the Certificate Owner, or other persons enti-
tled to vote have no beneficial interest will be voted in proportion to the
voting instructions that are received with respect to all Certificates partic-
ipating in the same Subaccount.
 
                               LEGAL PROCEEDINGS
 
  There are no legal proceedings to which the Variable Account is a party or
to which the assets of the Account are subject. PFL is not involved in any
litigation that is of material importance in relation to its total assets or
that relates to the Variable Account.
 
                                      43
<PAGE>
 
                                  APPENDIX A
 
                     ------------------------------------
 
          Example of Excess Interest Adjustment ("EIA") Calculations
 
  The Excess Interest Adjustment ("EIA") is determined by application of the
following formula:
 
                           EIA = S x (G-C) x (M/12)
 
Where:
 
  S is the gross (i.e. before premium taxes, if any) amount being withdrawn or
transferred from the Guaranteed Period,
 
  G is the guaranteed interest rate for the Guaranteed Period;
 
  C is the current guaranteed interest rate then being offered for the next
longer option period than "M". If such an option is no longer offered, "C"
will be the U.S. Treasury rate for the next longer maturity (in whole years)
than "M" as of the 25th day of the previous calendar month, plus 2%;
 
  M is the number of months remaining in the Guaranteed Period, rounded up to
the next higher number of months.
 
  The Excess Interest Adjustment will not reduce a Guaranteed Period Amount's
value below the premiums paid or amount transferred into the Guaranteed Peri-
od, less any withdrawals and transfers from that Guaranteed Period, plus in-
terest at the 3% guaranteed effective annual rate.
 
EXAMPLES OF EXCESS INTEREST ADJUSTMENT
 
  Assume $10,000 is paid into a 3 year Guaranteed Period which guarantees a 5%
interest rate. This produces a gross (i.e. before premium taxes, if any) Annu-
ity Purchase Value of $10,542.78 after 1 year and 1 month and $11,115.02 after
2 years and 2 months.
 
  EXAMPLE 1: Complete withdrawal after 1 year and 1 month, assuming the cur-
rent interest rate on the 3 year option at that time is 3.5%.
 
              EIA = $10,542.78 x (.05 - .035) x (23/12) = $303.10
 
                                      44
<PAGE>
 
                            APPENDIX A - continued
 
                     ------------------------------------
 
  EXAMPLE 2: Complete withdrawal after 1 year and 1 month, assuming the cur-
rent interest rate on the 3 year option at that time is 6.5%.
 
             EIA = $10,542.78 x (.05 - .065) x (23/12) = -$303.10
 
  The Excess Interest Adjustment is reduced to -$217.38 because of the 3%
guaranteed interest rate floor.
 
  EXAMPLE 3: $11,115.02 gross withdrawal after 2 years and 2 months, assuming
the current interest rate on the 1 year option at that time is 3.0%.
 
              EIA = $11,115.02 x (.05 - .03) x (10/12) = $185.25
 
  EXAMPLE: 4: $11,115.02 gross withdrawal after 2 years and 2 months, assuming
the current interest rate on the 1 year option at that time is 7.0% .
 
              EIA = $11,115.02 x (.05 - .07) x (10/12) = -$185.25
 
  The Excess Interest Adjustment in this example is smaller than the 3% guar-
anteed interest rate floor would provide, so it is not adjusted.
 
                                      45
<PAGE>
 
                                   APPENDIX B
 
                     ------------------------------------
 
                      STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                          Page
     <S>                                                                  <C>
     The Certificate - General Provisions................................   2
       Participants and Policy Owners....................................   2
       Entire Certificate................................................   2
       Deferment of Payment and Transfers................................   2
       Misstatement of Age or Sex........................................   2
       Reallocation of Annuity Purchase Value After the Annuity
         Commencement Date...............................................   3
       Assignment........................................................   3
       Evidence of Survival..............................................   3
       Non-Participating.................................................   4
       Amendments........................................................   4
       Section 403(b) Representations....................................   4
       Statement Pursuant to Rule 6e-7:
         Texas Optional Retirement Program...............................   4
     Taxation of PFL.....................................................   4
     Investment Experience...............................................   5
     State Regulation of PFL.............................................   7
     Administration......................................................   7
     Records and Reports.................................................   7
     Distribution of the Certificates....................................   7
     Custody of Assets...................................................   8
     Historical Performance Data.........................................   8
       Subaccount Yields.................................................   8
       Total Returns.....................................................   9
       Other Performance Data............................................   9
     Legal Matters.......................................................  10
     Independent Auditors................................................  10
     Other Information...................................................  10
     Financial Statements................................................  10
</TABLE>
 
 
                                       46
<PAGE>
 
                   The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust
                               24 Federal Street
                               Boston, MA 02110


================================================================================

  Investment Adviser                        Custodian and Transfer Agent

    Wright Investors' Service, Inc.           Investors Bank & Trust Company
    1000 Lafayette Boulevard                  89 South Street
    Bridgeport, Connecticut 06604             Boston, Massachusetts 02111
 
  Administrator                             Auditors

    Eaton Vance Management                    Deloitte & Touche LLP
    24 Federal Street                         125 Summer Street
    Boston, Massachusetts 02110               Boston, Massachusetts 02110


                       T A B L E    O F    C O N T E N T S

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                                 Page                                     Page
<S>                              <C>   <C>                                <C>
SHAREHOLDER AND PORTFOLIO              OTHER INVESTMENT POLICIES..........  11
  EXPENSES......................... 2  MANAGEMENT OF THE TRUST............  14
FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS............... 3   The Investment Adviser............  14
THE TRUST.......................... 7   The Administrator.................  16
INVESTMENT OBJECTIVES                  NET ASSET VALUE....................  17
AND POLICIES....................... 8  DIVIDENDS, DISTRIGUTIONS AND TAXES.  18
 Wright Near Term                      PURCHASE AND 
  Bond Portfolio (WNTBP)........... 8   REDEMPTION OF SHARES..............  19
 Wright Total Return                   PERFORMANCE INFORMATION............  19
  Bond Portfolio (WTRBP)........... 8  ORGANIZATION AND
 Wright Selected Blue Chip              CAPITALIZATION OF THE TRUST.......  20
  Portfolio (WSBCP)................ 8  ADDITIONAL INFORMATION.............  20
 Wright International Blue Chip         Custodian and Transfer Agent......  20
  Portfolio (WIBCP)................ 9   Independent Auditors..............  20

- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
representation not contained in this Prospectus and, if given or made, such
information or representation must not be relied upon as having been authorized.
This Prospectus does not constitute an offering of any securities other than the
registered securities to which it relates or an offer to any person in any state
or jurisdiction of the United States or any country where such offer would be
unlawful.
<PAGE>
 
Prospectus
- ----------

                   THE WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST
                     24 Federal Street,  Boston, MA  02110

    The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust (the "Trust") is a diversified,
open-end management investment company that is designed to be the funding
vehicle for various insurance contracts to be offered by PFL Life Insurance
Company and other participating insurance companies. Shares of the Trust will be
offered exclusively to the separate accounts of such insurance companies. Four
managed investment portfolios of the Trust (the "Portfolios") and their
investment objectives are described below. Investments in the Portfolios are not
guaranteed or insured by the U.S. Government, the Federal Deposit Insurance
Corporation, the Federal Reserve Board or any other government agency. Shares of
the Portfolios are not obligations or deposits of, or guaranteed or endorsed by,
any bank or other insured depository institution. Shares of the Portfolios
involve investment risks, including fluctuations in value and the possible loss
of some or all of the principal investment.

    Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio (WNTBP) seeks high total return, to the
extent consistent with reasonable safety, by investing primarily in debt
securities directly issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government. The Portfolio
expects to maintain an average weighted portfolio maturity of five years or
less.

    Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio (WTRBP) seeks high total return,
consisting of current income and capital appreciation, by investing primarily in
obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government and its agencies or
instrumentalities and in high-grade corporate debt securities of any maturity.

    Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio (WSBCP) seeks long-term capital
appreciation and, as a secondary objective, reasonable current income by
investing primarily in equity securities of well-established U.S. companies that
meet the investment adviser's quality standards.

    Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio (WIBCP) seeks long-term capital
appreciation by investing primarily in equity securities of well-established,
non-U.S. companies that meet the investment adviser's quality standards.

    THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE COMMISSION OR
ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS
PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.

    This Prospectus sets forth the information about the Trust and the
Portfolios that a prospective investor should know before investing. Please read
the Prospectus and retain it for future reference. Additional information
contained in a Statement of Additional Information dated May 1, 1996 has been
filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and is available upon request
without charge from Wright Investors' Service Distributors, Inc., 1000 Lafayette
Boulevard, Bridgeport, Connecticut 06604 (Telephone: 800-888-9471). The
Statement of Additional Information is incorporated by reference into this
Prospectus.

                  The date of this Prospectus is May 1, 1996.

                                       1
<PAGE>
 
Shareholder and Portfolio Expenses

The following table of fees and expenses is provided to assist investors in
understanding the various costs and expenses which may be borne directly or
indirectly by an investment in each Portfolio of the Trust.  The percentages
shown below representing total operating expenses are based on actual expenses
for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1995.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                                                       Wright              Wright                Wright                Wright
                                                      Near Term            Selected           Total Return         International
                                                    Bond Portfolio     Blue Chip Portfolio    Bond Portfolio    Blue Chip Portfolio
                                                       (WNTBP)               (WSBCP)             (WTRBP)              (WIBCP)
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                 <C>                <C>                    <C>               <C>
Shareholder Transaction Expenses                        None                  None                 None                None

Annualized Fund Operating Expenses
(as a percentage of average daily net assets).
   Investment Adviser Fee (after fee reduction)(1)     0.00%                 0.00%                0.00%               0.00%
   Other Expenses (after expense reduction,
     including administration fee of .05%)(2)          1.39%                 1.60%                1.26%               2.28%
                                                       -----                 -----                -----               -----
   Total Operating Expenses (after reductions)(3)      1.39%                 1.60%                1.26%               2.28%
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>
(1)  After reduction by Investment Adviser. If no reductions were made,
     investment advisory fees would have been as follows: WNTBP - 0.45%; WSBCP -
     0.65%; WTRBP - 0.45%; and WIBCP - 0.80% of each Portfolio's average daily
     net assets.

(2)  After reduction by Administrator. If no reductions were made,
     administration fees would have been 0.05% of each Portfolio's average daily
     net assets. The Investment Adviser was allocated a portion of the expenses
     of each Portfolio. If such allocations were not made, Other Expenses net of
     administration fees would have amounted to the following percentage of
     average daily net assets: WNTBP - 10.01%; WSBCP - 2.02%; WTRBP - 7.88%; and
     WIBCP - 3.33%.

(3)  If no fee reductions or expense allocations were made, the Total Operating
     Expenses would have been the following percentage of average daily net
     assets: WNTBP - 10.51%; WSBCP - 2.72%; WTRBP - 8.38%; and WIBCP - 4.18%.
     These fee reductions will continue in effect to the extent necessary to
     keep the total operating expenses (without regard to custodian fee credits)
     of WNTB, WSBCP, WTRBP and WIBCP from exceeding 0.90%, 1.15%, 0.90% and
     1.85%, respectively. In addition, during the year ended December 31, 1995,
     custodian fees were reduced by credits resulting from cash balances
     maintained with Investors Bank & Trust Company. If these credits were
     reflected in the above table, the Total Operating Expenses shown above
     would have been: WNTBP - 0.90%; WSBCP -1.15%; WTRBP- 0.90%; and WIBCP -
     1.85%.

Example of Portfolio Expenses

The following is an illustration of the total transaction and operating expenses
that an investor in each Portfolio would bear over different periods of time,
assuming an investment of $1,000, a 5% annual return on the investment and
redemption at the end of each period.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                          Wright              Wright                Wright                Wright
                         Near Term            Selected           Total Return         International
                       Bond Portfolio     Blue Chip Portfolio    Bond Portfolio    Blue Chip Portfolio
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                    <C>                <C>                    <C>               <C>
    1 Year                 $ 14                 $ 16                 $ 13                $ 23
    3 Years                $ 44                 $ 50                 $ 40                $ 71
    5 Years                $ 76                 $ 87                 $ 69                $122
    10 Years               $167                 $190                 $152                $262
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

    The Example should not be considered a representation of past or future
expenses and actual expenses may be greater or less than those shown. Federal
regulations require the Example to assume a 5% annual return, but actual return
will vary.

                                       2
<PAGE>
 
Financial Highlights

The following information should be read in conjunction with the audited
financial statements included in the Statement of Additional Information, all of
which has been so included in reliance upon the report of Deloitte & Touche LLP,
independent certified public accountants, as experts in accounting and auditing,
which report is contained in the Portfolios' Statement of Additional
Information. Further information regarding the performance of a Portfolio is
contained in its annual report to shareholders which may be obtained without
charge by contacting Wright Investors' Service Distributors, Inc. at (800) 888-
9471.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

WRIGHT                                                   Year Ended December 31,              For the Period
TOTAL RETURN                                             -----------------------           from 12/7/93 (start of
BOND PORTFOLIO                                           1995               1994           business) to 12/31/93(2)
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                     <C>                 <C>            <C>
Net asset value, beginning of year                      $   8.840           $   9.930              $   10.000
                                                        ---------           ---------              ----------
Income from Investment Operations:
   Net investment income(1)                             $   0.469           $   0.398              $    0.019
   Net realized and unrealized gain (loss)
      on investments                                        0.990              (1.090)                 (0.070)
                                                        ---------           ---------              ----------
      Total income (loss) from investment operations    $   1.459           $  (0.692)             $   (0.051)
                                                        ---------           ---------              ----------
Less Distributions to Shareholders:
   From net investment income                           $  (0.469)          $  (0.398)             $   (0.019)
                                                        ---------           ---------              ----------
Net asset value, end of year                            $   9.830           $   8.840              $    9.930
                                                        =========           =========              ==========
Total Return(3)                                              16.9%               (7.1%)                  (0.5%)
Ratios/Supplemental Data:  
   Net assets, end of year (000 omitted)                $     538           $     520                     167
   Ratio of net expenses to average net assets               1.26%(5)            0.90%                   0.70%(4)
   Ratio of net investment income to average net assets      5.09%               4.49%                   2.50%(4)
   Portfolio Turnover Rate                                    186%(6)              23%                      0%
</TABLE>
(1)  During the two years ended December 31, 1995, the Investment Adviser and
     the Administrator reduced their fees, and the Investment Adviser was
     allocated a portion of the Portfolio's operating expenses. Had such actions
     not been undertaken, the net investment loss per share and the ratios would
     have been as follows:
<TABLE> 
<CAPTION> 
<S>                                                     <C>                 <C>                                                     
Net investment loss per share                           $  (0.187)          $  (0.143)                                              
                                                        =========           =========                                               
Ratios (As a percentage of average net assets):                                                                                     
  Expenses                                                   8.38%               7.00%                                              
                                                        =========           =========                                               
  Net investment loss                                       (2.03%)             (1.61%)                                             
                                                        =========           =========                                               

</TABLE> 
(2)  Calculations based on average shares outstanding methodology.
(3)  Total investment return is calculated assuming a purchase at the net asset
     value on the first day and a sale at the net asset value on the last day of
     each period reported.  Dividends and distributions, if any, are assumed to
     be invested at the net asset value on the payable date. The total
     investment return does not reflect expenses that apply to the separate
     account or related policies.  If these charges had been included, the total
     return would be reduced.
(4)  Annualized.
(5)  During the year ended December 31, 1995, custodian fees were reduced by
     credits resulting from cash balances the Trust maintained with the
     custodian. The computation of net expenses to average daily net assets
     reported above is computed without consideration of such credits, in
     accordance with reporting regulations in effect beginning in 1995. If these
     credits were considered, the ratio of expenses to average net assets would
     have been reduced to 0.90%.
(6)  The Portfolio Turnover Rate increased from the prior year due to the need
     to increase portfolio diversification.

                                       3
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

 
                                                                                               For the Period
WRIGHT                                                                     Year Ended       from January 6, 1994
NEAR TERM                                                                 December 31,     (start of business) to
BOND PORTFOLIO                                                                1995           December 31, 1994
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                       <C>              <C>
Net asset value, beginning of year.........................                $   9.330              $  10.000
                                                                           ---------              ---------
Income from Investment Operations:
  Net investment income(1).................................                $   0.448              $   0.324
  Net realized and unrealized gain ( loss)
    on investments.........................................                    0.550                 (0.670)
                                                                           ---------              ---------
    Total income (loss) from investment operations.........                $   0.998              $  (0.346)
                                                                           ---------              ---------
Less Distributions to Shareholders:
  From net investment income...............................                $  (0.448)             $  (0.324)
                                                                           ---------              ---------
Net asset value, end of year...............................                $   9.880              $   9.330
                                                                           =========              =========
Total Return(3)............................................                    10.9%                  (3.2%)
Ratios/Supplemental Data:
  Net assets, end of year (000 omitted)....................                $     327              $     451
  Ratio of net expenses to average net assets..............                    1.39%(4)               0.90%(2)
  Ratio of net investment income to average net assets.....                    4.61%                  3.43%(2)
  Portfolio Turnover Rate..................................                      94%                    52%
</TABLE>
(1)  During each of the periods presented, the Investment Adviser and
     Administrator reduced their fees, and the Investment Adviser was allocated
     a portion of the Portfolio's operating expenses.  Had such actions not been
     undertaken, the net investment loss per share and the ratios would have
     been as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
<S>                                                                       <C>              <C>
Net investment loss  per share..........................                   $  (0.438)             $  (0.095)   
                                                                           =========              =========    
Ratios (As a percentage of average net assets):                                                                
     Expenses...........................................                      10.51%                  5.34%(2) 
                                                                           =========              =========    
     Net investment loss................................                      (4.51%)                (1.01%)(2)
                                                                           =========              =========    
</TABLE>

(2)  Annualized.
(3)  Total investment return is calculated assuming a purchase at the net asset
     value on the first day and a sale at the net asset value on the last day of
     each period reported. Dividends and distributions, if any, are assumed to
     be invested at the net asset value on the payable date. The total
     investment return does not reflect expenses that apply to the separate
     account or related policies. If these charges had been included, the total
     return would be reduced.
(4)  During the year ended December 31, 1995, custodian fees were reduced by
     credits resulting from cash balances the Trust maintained with the
     custodian. The computation of net expenses to average daily net assets
     reported above is computed without consideration of such credits, in
     accordance with reporting regulations in effect beginning in 1995. If these
     credits were considered, the ratio of expenses to average net assets would
     have been reduced to 0.90%.

                                       4
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

 
                                                                                               For the Period
WRIGHT                                                                     Year Ended       from January 6, 1994
SELECTED BLUE                                                             December 31,     (start of business) to
CHIP PORTFOLIO                                                                1995           December 31, 1994
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                       <C>              <C>
Net asset value, beginning of year.........................                $   9.320             $   10.000
                                                                           ---------              ---------
Income from Investment Operations:
  Net investment income(1).................................                $   0.100             $    0.092
  Net realized and unrealized gain (loss) 
    on investments.........................................                    2.345                 (0.712)
                                                                           ---------               ---------
  Total income (loss) from investment operations...........                $   2.445             $   (0.620)
                                                                           ---------               ---------
Less Distributions to Shareholders:........................
  From net investment income...............................                $  (0.070)            $   (0.060)
  From net realized gain on investment transactions........                   (0.285)                    --
                                                                           ---------               ---------
    Total distributions declared to shareholders...........                $  (0.355)            $   (0.060)
                                                                           ---------               ---------
Net asset value, end of year...............................                $  11.410             $    9.320
                                                                           =========             ==========
Total Return(3)............................................                    26.3%                  (6.2%)
Ratios/Supplemental Data:
  Net assets, end of year (000 omitted)....................                $   2,239             $    1,452
  Ratio of net expenses to average net assets..............                    1.60%(4)               1.15%(2)
  Ratio of net investment income to average net assets.....                    0.96%                  1.16%(2)
  Portfolio Turnover Rate..................................                      64%                    74%
</TABLE>
(1)  During each of the periods presented, the Investment Adviser was allocated
     a portion of the Portfolio's operating expenses. Had such actions not been
     undertaken, the net investment loss per share and the ratios would have
     been as follows:
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
<S>                                                                        <C>         <C>
Net investment loss per share..............................                $  (0.017)            $  (0.078)
                                                                           =========             =========
Ratios (As a percentage of average net assets):
  Expenses.................................................                    2.72%                 3.30%(2)
                                                                           =========             =========
  Net investment loss......................................                   (0.16%)               (0.99%)(2)
                                                                           =========             =========
</TABLE>

(2)  Annualized.
(3)  Total investment return is calculated assuming a purchase at the net asset
     value on the first day and a sale at the net asset value on the last day of
     each period reported. Dividends and distributions, if any, are assumed to
     be invested at the net asset value on the record date. The total investment
     return does not reflect expenses that apply to the separate account or
     related policies. If these charges had been included, the total return
     would be reduced.
(4)  During the year ended December 31, 1995, custodian fees were reduced by
     credits resulting from cash balances the Trust maintained with the
     custodian. The computation of net expenses to average daily net assets
     reported above is computed without consideration of such credits, in
     accordance with reporting regulations in effect beginning in 1995. If these
     credits were considered, the ratio of expenses to average net assets would
     have been reduced to 1.15%.

                                       5
<PAGE>
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                                                                                               For the Period
WRIGHT                                                                     Year Ended       from January 6, 1994
INTERNATIONAL                                                             December 31,     (start of business) to
BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO                                                           1995           December 31, 1994
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                       <C>              <C>
Net asset value, beginning of  year........................                $   9.140             $  10.000
                                                                           ---------             ---------
Income from Investment Operations:.........................
  Net investment income(1).................................                $   0.003             $   0.031
  Net realized and unrealized gain (loss)
    on investments.........................................                    0.967                (0.886)
                                                                           ---------             ---------
    Total income (loss) from investment operations.........                $   0.970             $  (0.855)
                                                                           ---------             ---------
Less Distributions to Shareholders:........................
  From net investment income...............................                $  (0.005)            $  (0.005)
  In excess of net investment income(5)....................                   (0.013)                --
  Tax distribution from paid-in capital....................                   (0.032)                --
                                                                           ---------             ---------
    Total distributions declared  to shareholders..........                $  (0.050)            $  (0.005)
                                                                           ---------             ---------
Net asset value, end of year...............................                $  10.060             $   9.140
                                                                           =========             =========
Total Return(3)............................................                    10.6%                  (8.1%)
Ratios/Supplemental Data:
  Net assets, end of year (000 omitted)....................                $   1,365             $   1,229
  Ratio of net expenses to average net assets..............                   2.28%(4)               1.80%(2)
  Ratio of net investment income to average 
    net assets.............................................                   0.06%                  1.19%(2)
  Portfolio Turnover Rate..................................                     31%                     0%
</TABLE>

(1)  During each of the periods presented, the Investment Adviser and
     Administrator reduced their fees, and the Investment Adviser was allocated
     a portion of the Portfolio's operating expenses. Had such actions not been
     undertaken, the net investment loss per share and the ratios would have
     been as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
<S>                                                                        <C>             <C>
Net investment loss  per share...................                          $  (0.920)            $  (0.434)
                                                                           =========             =========
Ratios (As a percentage of average net assets):  
  Expenses.........................................                           4.18%                  4.65%(2)
                                                                           =========             =========
  Net investment loss..............................                          (1.85%)                (2.66%)(2)
                                                                           =========             =========
</TABLE>

(2)  Annualized.
(3)  Total investment return is calculated assuming a purchase at the net asset
     value on the first day and a sale at the net asset value on the last day of
     each period reported. Dividends and distributions, if any, are assumed to
     be invested at the net asset value on the record date. The total investment
     return does not reflect expenses that apply to the separate account or
     related policies. If these charges had been included, the total return
     would be reduced.
(4)  During the year ended December 31, 1995, custodian fees were reduced by
     credits resulting from cash balances the Trust maintained with the
     custodian. The computation of net expenses to average daily net assets
     reported above is computed without consideration of such credits, in
     accordance with reporting regulations in effect beginning in 1995. If these
     credits were considered, the ratio of expenses to average net assets would
     have been reduced to 1.85%.
(5)  The Portfolio has followed the Statement of Position (SOP) 93-2:
     Determination, Disclosure and Financial Statement Presentation of Income,
     Capital Gain, and Return of Capital Distribution by Investment Companies.
     The SOP requires that differences in the recognition or classification of
     income between the financial statements and tax earnings and profits that
     result in temporary over-distributions for financial statement purposes,
     are classified as distributions in excess of net investment income or
     accumulated net realized gains.

                                       6
<PAGE>
 
                                   THE TRUST


    The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust (the "Trust") is an open-end
management investment company. The Trust consists of six separate portfolios
(each a "Portfolio"), four of which are covered by this Prospectus, each of
which represents a separate pool of assets and has different investment
objectives and policies. Each Portfolio is a diversified Portfolio. Additional
portfolios may be established in the future.

    The Trust is designed to be the funding vehicle for variable insurance
contracts (the "Contracts") to be offered by PFL Life Insurance Company ("PFL")
and other participating insurance companies. Shares of each Portfolio will be
offered exclusively to the separate accounts (the "Accounts") of PFL and other
participating insurance companies. References to PFL also include such other
participating insurance companies. The terms and conditions of the Contracts and
any limitations upon the Portfolios in which the Accounts may invest are set
forth in a separate prospectus. The Trust reserves the right to limit in the
future the types of Accounts that may invest in any Portfolio.

    PFL is the record holder and the owner of each share of beneficial interest
in each Portfolio of the Trust. Within the limitations set forth in the
appropriate Contract, Contractholders may direct through PFL the allocation of
amounts available for investment under their Contracts among the Trust's
Portfolios. Instructions for any such allocation, or the purchase or redemption
of the shares of any Portfolio, must be made by PFL as the record holder of the
Trust's shares. The rights of PFL as the record holder and the owner of shares
of a Portfolio are different from the rights of a Contractholder. The term
"shareholder" in this Prospectus refers to PFL and not to the Contractholder.

    Wright Investors' Service, Inc. ("Wright") acts as investment adviser to
each Portfolio. Eaton Vance Management ("Eaton Vance") acts as administrator to
the Trust.
 
    None of the Portfolios alone constitutes a complete investment program.


                       --------------------------------


    The Prospectuses of the Portfolios are combined in this Prospectus. Each
Portfolio offers only its own shares, yet it is possible that a Portfolio might
become liable for a misstatement in the Prospectus of another Portfolio. The
Trustees have considered this in approving the use of a combined Prospectus.

                                       7
<PAGE>
 
                      INVESTMENT OBJECTIVES AND POLICIES


    The investment objectives and policies of each Portfolio are described
below. Such investment objectives and the policies are not fundamental policies
and may be changed by the Trustees without the approval of shareholders. If any
changes were made, a Portfolio might have investment objectives different from
the objectives which a Contractholder considered appropriate at the time of
selecting the Portfolio as the underlying investment for the Contract. There can
be no assurance that any of the Portfolios will be able to achieve its
investment objectives.

Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio

    The investment objective of Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio ("WNTBP") is
high total return, to the extent consistent with reasonable safety. WNTBP seeks
to achieve this objective by investing at least 80% of its net assets, under
normal market conditions, in securities issued by the U.S. Government or issued
by its agencies and instrumentalities and guaranteed by the U.S. Government and
in repurchase agreements with respect to such securities. It is expected that
WNTBP's portfolio will have an average weighted maturity of five years or less.
WNTBP is designed to appeal to an investor seeking a level of income that is
higher and less variable than that available from short-term U.S. Government
obligations and limited fluctuation of capital compared to investments in long-
term U.S. Government obligations.


Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio

    The investment objective of Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio ("WTRBP") is
high total return, consisting of current income and capital appreciation. WTRBP
seeks to achieve this objective by investing at least 80% of its net assets,
under normal market conditions, in obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S.
Government and its agencies or instrumentalities and in high-grade corporate
debt securities. The average weighted maturity of WTRBP's portfolio may vary
depending upon the investment adviser's judgment as to the then current phase of
the interest rate cycle. WTRBP invests in obligations of the U.S. Government,
its agencies and instrumentalities, certificates of deposit of federally insured
banks and corporate obligations rated, at the time of purchase, "A" or better by
Standard & Poor's Ratings Group ("S&P") or Moody's Investors Service, Inc.
("Moody's") or if not rated, determined to be of comparable quality by the
investment adviser. Such investments also meet Wright Quality Rating Standards.

Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio

    The investment objective of Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio ("WSBCP") is
long-term capital appreciation and, as a secondary objective, reasonable current
income. Under normal market conditions, WSBCP invests at least 80% of its net
assets in selected equity securities, including common stocks, preferred stocks
and convertible securities. Securities selected for WSBCP are drawn from an
investment list prepared by the investment adviser and known as The Approved
Wright Investment List (the "AWIL").

                                       8
<PAGE>
 
    Approved Wright Investment List. The investment adviser maintains a
proprietary database on approximately 3,000 U.S. companies. The investment
adviser reviews such companies to identify those which, on the basis of at least
five years of audited financial statements, meet the minimum standards of
prudence (e.g. the value of its assets and shareholders' equity exceeds certain
minimum standards and the company's operations have been profitable during the
last three years) and thus are suitable for consideration by fiduciary
investors. Companies which meet these requirements may be large or small, have
their securities traded on exchanges or in the over-the-counter market, and
include companies not currently paying dividends on their shares.

    These companies are then subjected to extensive analysis and evaluation in
order to identify those which meet the investment adviser's 32 fundamental
standards of investment quality. Only those companies which meet or exceed all
of these standards are eligible for selection by the Wright Investment Committee
for inclusion in the AWIL. See the Appendix to the Statement of Additional
Information for a more detailed description of the investment adviser's
standards for investment quality and the AWIL. All companies on the AWIL are, in
the opinion of the investment adviser, soundly financed "True Blue Chips" with
established records of earnings, profitability and equity growth and active,
liquid markets for their publicly held equity securities. The AWIL normally
includes approximately 350 companies.

    The equity securities in which WSBCP invests are limited to those companies
on the AWIL whose current operations reflect characteristics which have been
identified by the investment adviser as being likely to provide comparatively
superior total investment return over the intermediate term. WSBCP purchases
securities which meet WSBCP's investment criteria and increases the amount of
current investments in companies the market values of which are below their
target values. Portfolio securities are generally considered for sale if the
value of such securities exceeds 2 1/2 times their normal weighting in the
portfolio, or if such securities are no longer included in the AWIL or no longer
meet WSBCP's investment criteria.

Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio

    The investment objective of Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio
("WIBCP") is long-term capital appreciation. Under normal market conditions,
WIBCP invests at least 80% of its net assets in equity securities, including
common stocks, preferred stocks and convertible securities. Securities selected
for WIBCP are limited to those included on an investment list prepared by the
investment adviser and known as the International Approved Wright Investment
List (the "International AWIL").

    The International Approved Wright Investment List. The investment adviser
maintains a proprietary database on approximately 8,000 non-U.S. companies from
over 36 countries. The investment adviser reviews such companies to identify
those which, on the basis of at least five years of audited financial
statements, meet the minimum standards of prudence (e.g. the value of a
company's assets and shareholders' equity exceeds certain minimum standards and
the company's operations have been profitable during the last three years) and
thus are suitable for consideration by fiduciary investors. Companies which meet
these requirements may be large or small, have their securities traded on
exchanges or in the over-the-counter market, and include companies not currently
paying dividends.

                                       9
<PAGE>
 
    These companies are then subjected to extensive analysis and evaluation in
order to identify those which meet the investment adviser's 32 fundamental
standards of investment quality. Only those companies which meet or exceed all
of these standards are eligible for selection for inclusion in the International
AWIL. See the Appendix to the Statement of Additional Information for a more
detailed description of the investment adviser's standards for investment
quality and the International AWIL. All companies on the International AWIL are,
in the opinion of the investment adviser, soundly financed "True Blue Chips"
with established records of earnings, profitability and equity growth and
active, liquid markets for their publicly held equity securities.

    WIBCP intends to maintain investments in a minimum of three foreign
countries. WIBCP purchases securities which meet WIBCP's investment criteria and
increases the amount of current investments in companies the market values of
which are below their target values. Portfolio securities are generally
considered for sale if they are no longer included in the International AWIL or
no longer meet WIBCP's investment criteria. WIBCP may purchase equity securities
traded on foreign securities exchanges, or it may purchase American Depositary
Receipts (ADRs) traded in the United States. Purchases of shares of WIBCP are
suitable for investors wishing to diversify their portfolios by investing in 
non-U.S. companies or for investors who simply wish to participate in non-U.S.
investments. Although the net asset value of WIBCP's shares will be stated in
U.S. dollars, fluctuations in foreign currency exchange rates may affect the
value of an investment in WIBCP.

    WIBCP is intended to provide investors with the opportunity to invest in a
portfolio of securities of non-U.S. companies located throughout the world. In
making the allocation of assets among the various countries and geographic
regions, the investment adviser ordinarily considers such factors as prospects
for relative economic growth between foreign countries; expected levels of
inflation and interest rates; government policies influencing business
conditions; the range of individual investment opportunities available to
international investors; and other pertinent financial, tax, social, political
and national factors - all in relation to the prevailing prices of the
securities in each country or region.


    Foreign Investment Risk. All or a substantial portion of WIBCP's assets will
be invested in securities of foreign companies. Investing in securities of
foreign companies may involve certain considerations in addition to those
arising when investing in domestic securities. These considerations include the
possibility of currency exchange rate fluctuations and revaluation of
currencies, the existence of less publicly available information about issuers,
different accounting, auditing and financial reporting standards, less stringent
securities regulation, non-negotiable brokerage commissions, different tax
provisions, political or social instability, war or expropriation. Moreover,
foreign stock and bond markets generally are not as developed and efficient as
those in the United States and, therefore, the volume and liquidity in those
markets may be less, and the volatility of prices may be greater, than in U.S.
markets. Settlement of transactions on foreign markets may be delayed beyond
what is customary in U.S. markets. These considerations generally are of greater
concern in developing countries.

    Because investment in foreign issuers will usually involve currencies of
foreign countries, and because WIBCP may be exposed to currency fluctuations
independent of its securities exposure,

                                      10
<PAGE>
 
the value of the assets of the WIBCP as measured in U.S. dollars will be
affected by changes in foreign currency exchange rates.



                           OTHER INVESTMENT POLICIES


    The Trust has adopted on behalf of each Portfolio certain fundamental
investment restrictions which are enumerated in detail in the Statement of
Additional Information and which may be changed only by the vote of a majority
of the affected Portfolio's outstanding voting securities, as defined in the
Investment Company Act of 1940. Among other restrictions, each Portfolio may not
borrow money in excess of 1/3 of the current market value of such Portfolio's
net assets (excluding the amount borrowed), and only for certain temporary or
emergency purposes, invest more than 5% of such Portfolio's total assets taken
at current market value in the securities of any one issuer, purchase more than
10% of the voting securities of any one issuer or invest 25% or more of the
Portfolio's total assets in the securities of issuers in the same industry. No
Portfolio may invest more than 15% of its net assets in illiquid investments.
There is, however, no limitation in respect to investments in obligations issued
or guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its agencies or instrumentalities.

    Repurchase Agreements. Each Portfolio may enter into repurchase agreements
in order to earn income on temporarily uninvested cash. A repurchase agreement
is an agreement under which the seller of a security agrees to repurchase and
the relevant Portfolio agrees to resell, such security at a specified time and
price. A Portfolio may enter into repurchase agreements only with large, well-
capitalized banks or government securities dealers that meet specified credit
standards. In addition, such repurchase agreements will provide that the value
of the collateral underlying the repurchase agreement will always be at least
equal to the repurchase price, including any accrued interest earned under the
repurchase agreement. In the event of a default or bankruptcy by a seller under
a repurchase agreement, the Portfolio will seek to liquidate such collateral.
However, the exercise of the right to liquidate such collateral could involve
certain costs, delays and restrictions and is not ultimately assured. To the
extent that proceeds from any sale upon a default of the obligation to
repurchase are less than the repurchase price, the Portfolio could suffer a
loss.

    Forward Foreign Currency Exchange Contracts. WIBCP may enter into contracts
to purchase foreign currencies to protect against an anticipated rise in the
U.S. dollar price of securities it intends to purchase. WIBCP may enter into
contracts to sell foreign currencies to protect against the decline in value of
portfolio securities denominated or quoted in a foreign currency, or a decline
in the value of anticipated dividends from such securities, due to a decline in
the value of foreign currencies against the U.S. dollar. Contracts to sell
foreign currency could limit any potential gain which might be realized by WIBCP
if the value of the hedged currency increased. Forward contracts are subject to
the risk that the counterparty to such contract will default on its obligations.

    Each Portfolio's transactions in foreign currency exchange contracts may be
limited by the requirements of the Internal Revenue Code for qualification as a
regulated investment company.

                                      11
<PAGE>
 
    Lending Portfolio Securities. Each Portfolio may seek to increase its total
return by lending portfolio securities to broker-dealers or other institutional
borrowers. Under present regulatory policies of the Securities and Exchange
Commission, such loans are required to be continuously secured by collateral in
cash, cash-equivalents and U.S. Government securities held by the Portfolio's
custodian and maintained on a current basis at an amount at least equal to the
market value of the securities loaned, which will be marked to market daily.
During the existence of a loan, the Portfolio will continue to receive the
equivalent of the interest or dividends paid by the issuer on the securities
loaned and will also receive a fee, or all or a portion of the interest on
investment of the collateral, if any. However, the Portfolio may at the same
time pay a transaction fee to such borrowers and administrative expenses, such
as finders fees to third parties. As with other extensions of credit there are
risks of delay in recovery or even loss of rights in the securities loaned if
the borrower of the securities fails financially. However, the loans will be
made only to organizations deemed by the investment adviser to be of good
standing and when, in the judgment of the investment adviser, the consideration
which can be earned from securities loans of this type justifies the attendant
risk. Such loans are required to be secured continuously by collateral in cash,
cash equivalents and U.S. Government securities with a value at least equal to
the market value of the securities loaned. If the investment adviser decides to
make securities loans on behalf of a Portfolio, it is intended that the value of
the securities loaned would not exceed 30% of such Portfolio's total assets.


    Defensive Investments. During periods of unusual market conditions, when the
investment adviser believes that investing for temporary defensive purposes is
appropriate, all or a portion of the assets of any Portfolio may be held in cash
or invested in short-term obligations, including but not limited to short-term
obligations issued or guaranteed as to interest and principal by the U.S.
Government or any agency or instrumentality thereof (including repurchase
agreements collateralized by such securities); commercial paper which at the
date of investment is rated A-1 by S&P or P-1 by Moody's, or, if not rated, is
determined by the investment adviser to be of comparable quality; short-term
corporate obligations and other debt instruments which at the date of investment
are rated AA or better by S&P or Aa or better by Moody's or, if unrated, are
determined by the investment adviser to be of comparable quality; and
certificates of deposit, bankers' acceptances and time deposits of domestic and
foreign banks the debt obligations of which satisfy the foregoing rating
criteria. Each Portfolio may invest in instruments and obligations of banks that
have other relationships with the Trust, Wright or Eaton Vance. No preference
will be shown towards investing in banks which have such relationships.


    Forward Commitments and When-Issued Securities. Each Portfolio may purchase
when-issued securities and make contracts to purchase or sell securities for a
fixed price at a future date beyond customary settlement time. A Portfolio
entering into such a transaction is required to maintain in a segregated account
with such Portfolio's custodian until the settlement date cash or high-grade
liquid debt obligations in an amount sufficient to meet the purchase price.
Alternatively, the Portfolio may enter into offsetting contracts for the forward
sale of other securities that it owns. Securities purchased or sold on a when-
issued or forward commitment basis involve a risk of loss if the value of the
security to be purchased declines prior to the settlement date or if 

                                      12
<PAGE>
 
the value of the security to be sold increases prior to the settlement date.
Although a Portfolio would generally purchase securities on a when-issued or
forward commitment basis with the intention of acquiring securities for its
portfolio, the Portfolio may dispose of a when-issued security or forward
commitment prior to settlement if the investment adviser deems it appropriate to
do so.


    Mortgage-Related Securities. WTRBP may invest in mortgage-related
securities, including collateralized mortgage obligations ("CMOs") and other
derivative mortgage-related securities. These securities will either be issued
by the U.S. Government or one of its agencies or instrumentalities or, if
privately issued, supported by mortgage collateral that is insured, guaranteed
or otherwise backed by the U.S. Government or its agencies or instrumentalities.
The Portfolio does not invest in the residual classes of CMOs, stripped 
mortgage-related securities, leveraged floating rate instruments or indexed
securities.


    Mortgage-related securities represent participation interests in pools of
adjustable and fixed mortgage loans. Unlike conventional debt obligations,
mortgage-related securities provide monthly payments derived from the monthly
interest and principal payments (including any prepayments) made by the
individual borrowers on the pooled mortgage loans. The mortgage loans underlying
mortgage-related securities are generally subject to a greater rate of principal
prepayments in a declining interest rate environment and to a lesser rate of
principal prepayments in an increasing interest rate environment. Under certain
interest and prepayment rate scenarios, the Portfolio may fail to recover the
full amount of its investment in mortgage-related securities purchased at a
premium, notwithstanding any direct or indirect governmental or agency
guarantee. The Portfolio may realize a gain on mortgage-related securities
purchased at a discount. Since faster than expected prepayments must usually be
invested in lower yielding securities, mortgage-related securities are less
effective than conventional bonds in "locking in" a specified interest rate.
Conversely, in a rising interest rate environment, a declining prepayment rate
will extend the average life of many mortgage-related securities. Extending the
average life of a mortgage-related security increases the risk of depreciation
due to future increases in market interest rates.


    The Portfolio's investments in mortgage-related securities may include
conventional mortgage passthrough securities and certain classes of multiple
class CMOs. Senior CMO classes will typically have priority over residual CMO
classes as to the receipt of principal and/or interest payments on the
underlying mortgages. The CMO classes in which the Portfolio may invest include
sequential and parallel pay CMOs, including planned amortization class ("PAC")
and target amortization class ("TAC") securities.

    Different types of mortgage-related securities are subject to different
combinations of prepayment, extension, interest rate and/or other market risks.
Conventional mortgage passthrough securities and sequential pay CMOs are subject
to all of these risks, but are typically not leveraged. PACs, TACs and other
senior classes of sequential and parallel pay CMOs involve less exposure to
prepayment, extension and interest rate risk than other mortgage-related
securities, provided that prepayment rates remain within expected prepayment
ranges or "collars."

                                      13
<PAGE>
 
                            MANAGEMENT OF THE TRUST


    The Board of Trustees, in addition to reviewing the actions of the
investment adviser and administrator, decides upon general matters of policy for
each Portfolio. The investment adviser and administrator conduct and supervise
the daily operations of the Portfolios.


The Investment Adviser

    The Trust has engaged The Winthrop Corporation ("Winthrop") to act as the
Portfolio's investment adviser pursuant to an Investment Advisory Contract.
Pursuant to a service agreement effective February 1, 1996 between Winthrop and
its wholly-owned subsidiary, Wright Investors' Service, Inc. ("Wright"), Wright,
acting under the general supervision of the Trust's Trustees, furnishes each
Portfolio with investment advice and management services. Winthrop supervises
Wright's performance of this function and retains its contractual obligations
under its Investment Advisory Contract with each Portfolio. The address of both
Winthrop and Wright is 1000 Lafayette Boulevard, Bridgeport, Connecticut. The
Trustees of the Trust are responsible for the general oversight of the conduct
of the Portfolios' business.

    Wright is a leading independent international investment management and
advisory firm, which together with its parent, Winthrop, has more than 30 years'
experience. Its staff of over 150 people includes a highly respected team of 65
economists, investment experts and research analysts. Wright manages assets for
bank trust departments, corporations, unions, municipalities, eleemosynary
institutions, professional associations, institutional investors, fiduciary
organizations, family trusts and individuals. Wright operates one of the world's
largest and most complete databases of financial information on 13,000 domestic
and international corporations. The estate of John Winthrop Wright is the
controlling shareholder of Winthrop. At the end of 1995, Wright managed
approximately $4 billion of assets.

    An Investment Committee of senior officers, all of whom are experienced
analysts, exercises disciplined direction and control over all investment
selections, policies and procedures for each Portfolio of the Trust. The
Committee, following highly disciplined buy-and-sell rules, makes all decisions
for the selection, purchase and sale of all securities. The members of the
Committee are as follows:

    Peter M. Donovan, CFA, President and Chief Executive Officer of Wright. Mr.
Donovan received a BA Economics, Goddard College and joined Wright from Jones,
Kreeger & Co., Washington, DC in 1966. Mr. Donovan is the president of The
Wright Managed Income Trust, The Wright Managed Equity Trust, The Wright Managed
Blue Chip Series Trust, and The Wright EquiFund Equity Trust. He is also
director of EquiFund - Wright National Equity Fund, a Luxembourg SICAV. He is a
member of the New York Society of Security Analysts and the Hartford Society of
Financial Analysts.

    Judith R. Corchard, Chairman of the Investment Committee, Executive Vice
President-Investment Management of Wright. Ms. Corchard attended the University
of Connecticut and

                                      14
<PAGE>
 
joined Wright in 1960. She is a member of the New York Society of Security
Analysts and the Hartford Society of Financial Analysts.

    Jatin J. Mehta, CFA, Executive Counselor and Director of Education of
Wright. Mr. Mehta received a BS Civil Engineering, University of Bombay, India
and an MBA from the University of Bridgeport. Before joining Wright in 1969, Mr.
Mehta was an executive of the Industrial Credit Investment Corporation of India,
a World Bank agency in India for financial assistance to private industry. He is
a Trustee of The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust. He is a member of the
New York Society of Security Analysts and the Hartford Society of Financial
Analysts.

    Harivadan K. Kapadia, CFA, Senior Vice President - Investment Analysis and
Information of Wright. Mr. Kapadia received a BA (hon.) Economics and Statistics
and MA Economics, University of Baroda, India and an MBA from the University of
Bridgeport. Before joining Wright in 1969, Mr. Kapadia was Assistant Lecturer at
the College of Engineering and Technology in Surat, India and Lecturer, B.J. at
the College of Commerce & Economics, VVNagar, India. He has published the
textbooks: "Elements of Statistics," "Statistics," "Descriptive Economics," and
"Elements of Economics." He was appointed Adjunct Professor at the Graduate
School of Business, Fairfield University in 1981. He is a member of the New York
Society of Security Analysts and the Hartford Society of Financial Analysts.

    Michael F. Flament, CFA, Senior Vice President - Investment and Economic
Analysis of Wright. Mr. Flament received a BS Mathematics, Fairfield University;
MA Mathematics, University of Massachusetts and an MBA Finance, University of
Bridgeport. He is a member of the New York Society of Security Analysts and the
Hartford Society of Financial Analysts.

    James P. Fields, CFA, Vice President and Investment Officer of Wright. Mr.
Fields received a B.S. Accounting, Fairfield University and an MBA Finance from
Pace University. He joined Wright in 1982 and is also a member of the New York
Society of Security Analysts.

    Under the Portfolio's Investment Advisory Contract, each Portfolio is
required to pay Winthrop a monthly advisory fee calculated at the annual rates
(as a percentage of average daily net assets) set forth in the following table.
Effective February 1, 1996, Winthrop will cause the Portfolios to pay to Wright
the entire amount of the advisory fee payable by each Portfolio under the
Investment Advisory Contract with Winthrop:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                                                                               ANNUAL % ADVISORY FEE RATES
                                                                     -------------------------------------------------
                                                                           Under       $500 Million        Over
PORTFOLIOS                                                              $500 Million   to $1 Billion    $1 Billion
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                     <C>            <C>              <C>
Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio (WNTBP)                                    0.45%          0.40%          0.35%
Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio (WTRBP)                                 0.45%          0.40%          0.35%
Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio (WSBCP)                                0.65%          0.60%          0.55%
Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio (WIBCP)                           0.80%          0.75%          0.70%
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

                                      15
<PAGE>
 
    The following table sets forth the net assets of each Portfolio and the
advisory fee rate paid for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1995.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                                                                         Net Assets        Fee Rate Paid
                                                                            as of        for the Fiscal Year
PORTFOLIOS                                                                12/31/95        Ended 12/31/95
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                                     <C>              <C>
Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio (WNTBP)                                   $326,564            0.45%(1)
Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio (WTRBP)                                $537,682            0.45%(2)
Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio (WSBCP)                             $2,238,830            0.65%(3)
Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio (WIBCP)                        $1,364,871            0.80%(4)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

(1)  To enhance the net income of WNTBP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $29,915 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(2)  To enhance the net income of WTRBP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $29,886 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(3)  To enhance the net income of WSBCP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $7,494 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(4)  To enhance the net income of WIBCP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $12,813 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.


    Pursuant to the Investment Advisory Contract, Wright also furnishes office
space and all necessary office facilities, equipment and personnel for servicing
the investments of each Portfolio. Each Portfolio is responsible for the payment
of all expenses relating to its operations other than those expressly stated to
be payable by Wright under its Investment Advisory Contract.

    Wright places the security transactions for each Portfolio, which in some
cases may be effected in block transactions which include other accounts managed
by Wright. Wright provides similar services directly for bank trust departments.
Wright seeks to execute the portfolio security transactions on the most
favorable terms and in the most effective manner possible. Subject to the
foregoing, Wright may consider sales of shares of a Portfolio or of other
investment companies for which it acts as investment adviser as a factor in the
selection of broker-dealer firms to execute such transactions.

    Wright is also the Investment Adviser to the Funds in The Wright Managed
Equity Trust, The Wright Managed Income Trust and The Wright EquiFund Equity
Trust (the "Wright Funds").



The Administrator

    The Trust engages Eaton Vance as its administrator under an Administration
Agreement. Under the Administration Agreement, Eaton Vance is responsible for
managing the legal and business affairs of each Portfolio, subject to the
supervision of the Trustees. Eaton Vance's services include recordkeeping,
preparation and filing of documents required to comply with federal and state
secur-

                                      16
<PAGE>
 
ities laws, supervising the activities of the custodian and transfer agent,
providing assistance in connection with the Trustees' and shareholders' meetings
and other administrative services necessary to conduct each Portfolio's
business. Eaton Vance will not provide any investment management or advisory
services to the Portfolios. For its services under the Administration Agreement,
Eaton Vance receives monthly administration fees from each Portfolio at the
annual rates (as a percentage of average daily net assets of such Portfolio) as
follows:

                     ANNUAL % -- ADMINISTRATION FEE RATES

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
        Under          $100 Million to     $250 Million to        Over
     $100 Million       $250 Million        $500 Million       $500 Million
     ------------      -------------        ------------       ------------
     <S>               <C>                  <C>                <C>
        0.05%              0.04%               0.03%              0.02%
</TABLE>

     For the fiscal year ended December 31, 1995, Eaton Vance made a reduction
of its full administration fee for each Portfolio.

     Eaton Vance, its affiliates and its predecessor companies have been
primarily engaged in managing assets of individuals and institutional clients
since 1924 and managing, administering and marketing mutual funds since 1931.
Total assets under management are over $16 billion. Eaton Vance is a wholly-
owned subsidiary of Eaton Vance Corp. ("EVC"), a publicly held holding company.


Other Expenses

    The Trust will be responsible for all of its expenses not assumed by Wright
under its Investment Advisory Contract or by Eaton Vance under its
Administration Agreement, including, without limitation, the fees and expenses
of its custodian and transfer agent, including those incurred for determining
each Portfolio's net asset value and keeping each Portfolio's books; the cost of
share certificates; membership dues in investment company organizations;
brokerage commissions and fees; fees and expenses of registering its shares;
expenses of reports to shareholders, proxy statements, and other expenses of
shareholders' meetings; insurance premiums; printing and mailing expenses;
interest, taxes and corporate fees; legal and accounting expenses; expenses of
Trustees not affiliated with Eaton Vance or Wright; and investment advisory and
administration fees. The Trust will also bear expenses incurred in connection
with litigation in which the Trust is a party and the legal obligation the Trust
may have to indemnify its officers and Trustees with respect thereto.


                                NET ASSET VALUE


     The net asset value per share of each Portfolio is determined at the close
of regular trading on the New York Stock Exchange (the "Exchange") (normally
4:00 P.M., New York time) on each day that the Exchange is open for trading. The
determination of net asset value per share is made by 

                                      17
<PAGE>
 
subtracting from the value of the assets of a Portfolio the amount of its
liabilities, and dividing the remainder by the number of outstanding shares of a
Portfolio. The New York Stock Exchange is closed on the following holidays: New
Year's Day, Presidents' Day, Good Friday, Memorial Day, Independence Day, Labor
Day, Thanksgiving Day and Christmas Day.


    The assets of the Portfolios are valued on the basis of their market values
or, in the absence of a market value with respect to any portfolio securities,
at the value determined by or under the direction of the Trustees, including the
employment of an independent pricing services.



                      DIVIDENDS, DISTRIBUTIONS AND TAXES


    Each Portfolio is treated as a separate entity for federal income tax
purposes under the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"). Each
Portfolio has qualified and elected or intends to qualify and elect to be
treated as a "regulated investment company" for federal income tax purposes
under the Code and intends to continue to qualify as such. In order to so
qualify, each Portfolio must meet certain requirements with respect to the
sources of its income, the diversification of its assets, and the distribution
of its income to shareholders. By so qualifying, a Portfolio will not be subject
to federal income taxes to the extent that its net investment income and net
realized capital gains are distributed to shareholders in accordance with
applicable timing requirements.


    It is the intention of each Portfolio to distribute substantially all its
net investment income. Dividends from investment income of WSBCP and WIBCP are
expected to be declared annually. Dividends from investment income of WNTBP and
WTRBP will be declared daily and paid monthly. However, the Trustees may decide
to declare dividends at other intervals. Dividends will be distributed in the
form of additional full and fractional shares of the Portfolio and not in cash,
but shareholders may redeem such shares for cash, as described below.


    All net realized long- or short-term capital gains of each Portfolio after
reduction by capital losses, including any available capital loss carryforwards,
if any, will be declared and distributed at least annually either during or
after the close of the Portfolio's taxable year and will be reinvested in
additional full and fractional shares of the Portfolio. A Portfolio may be
subject to foreign withholding or other foreign taxes, with respect to income
(possibly including, in some cases, capital gains) derived from securities of
foreign issuers. U.S. income tax treaties with certain countries may eliminate
or reduce the rates of these taxes. The Trust intends to provide the
documentation necessary to achieve the lower treaty rate of withholding whenever
applicable or to seek a refund of amounts withheld in excess of the treaty rate.


    For a discussion of the tax treatment of Contractholders with respect to
their Contracts, including the tax treatment of investment earnings of and
withdrawals from the segregated accounts underlying such Contracts, reference
should be made to the prospectus for the Contracts accompanying this Prospectus.

                                      18
<PAGE>
 
                       PURCHASE AND REDEMPTION OF SHARES

    The shares of each Portfolio are not offered to the public but may be
purchased only by PFL or another participating insurance company for its
Accounts allocable to Contracts. Within the limitations set forth in the
appropriate Contract, Contractholders may direct PFL to purchase or redeem
shares of any Portfolio. Instructions for any such purchase or redemption of the
shares of any Portfolio must be made by PFL and Contractholders should not
direct instructions or inquiries to the Trust. The terms and conditions of the
Contracts and any limitations upon the Portfolios in which the Accounts may
invest are set forth in a separate prospectus.

    Subject to the foregoing, each Portfolio sells its shares to PFL or another
participating insurance company without a sales charge at the net asset value
per share of such Portfolio next determined after the purchase order is
received. Each Portfolio reserves the right to reject any order for the purchase
of its shares or to limit or suspend, without notice, the offering of its
shares.

    Shares of the Portfolios may be redeemed on any day on which the Trust is
open for business. Each Portfolio redeems its shares at the net asset value per
share of such Portfolio next determined after the redemption request is received
from PFL or another participating insurance company. Proceeds of any redemption
are delivered to PFL or another participating insurance company within seven
days after receipt of the redemption request. The right to redeem shares of a
Portfolio and to receive payment therefor may be suspended at times (a) when the
securities markets are closed, other than customary weekend and holiday
closings, (b) when trading is restricted for any reason, (c) when an emergency
exists as a result of which disposal by such Portfolio of securities owned by it
is not reasonably practicable or it is not reasonably practicable for such
Portfolio fairly to determine the value of its net assets, or (d) when the
Securities and Exchange Commission by order permits a suspension of the right of
redemption or a postponement of the date of payment or redemption.

    Although the Portfolios normally intend to redeem shares in cash, each
Portfolio reserves the right to redeem securities in kind if deemed advisable by
the Trustees. The value of any portfolio securities distributed upon redemption
will be determined in the manner as described under "Net Asset Value." However,
a Portfolio will redeem shares in cash to the extent that the amount of a
Portfolio's shares to be redeemed for the benefit of any Contractholder within a
90-day period does not exceed the lesser of $250,000 or 1% of the aggregate net
asset value of the Portfolio at the beginning of such period. If portfolio
securities are distributed in lieu of cash, the shareholder will normally incur
transaction costs upon the disposition of any such securities.


                            PERFORMANCE INFORMATION

    From time to time, the Trust may advertise the yield and/or total return of
the Portfolios and may compare the performance of the Portfolios with that of
other mutual funds with similar investment objectives as listed in rankings
prepared by Lipper Analytical Services, Inc., or similar independent services
monitoring mutual fund performance, and with appropriate securities or other
relevant indices. The yield of each Portfolio is computed by dividing its net
investment income per

                                      19
<PAGE>
 
share earned during a recent 30-day period by the maximum offering price (i.e.,
net asset value) per share on the last day of the period and annualizing the
resulting figure. The total return of a Portfolio refers to the average annual
compounded rate of return over the stated period that would equate an initial
investment in that Portfolio at the beginning of the period to its ending
redeemable value, assuming reinvestment of all dividend and distributions and
deduction of all recurring charges. The methods used to calculate total return
and yield are described further in the Statement of Additional Information.

    The performance of each Portfolio will vary from time to time in response to
fluctuations in market conditions, interest rates, the composition of the
Portfolio's investments and expenses. Consequently, a Portfolio's performance
figures should not be considered representative of the performance of the
Portfolio for any future period. If the expenses of a Portfolio are reduced by
Wright or Eaton Vance, the Portfolio's performance would be higher.


                 ORGANIZATION AND CAPITALIZATION OF THE TRUST

    The Trust was established in April 1993 as a business trust under
Massachusetts law. The Trust's shares of beneficial interest have no par value.
Shares of the Trust may be issued in series or Portfolios. The Trust currently
has six Portfolios. Each Portfolio's shares may be issued in an unlimited number
by the Trustees. Each share of a Portfolio represents an equal proportionate
beneficial interest in that Portfolio and, when issued and outstanding, the
shares are fully paid and non-assessable by the Trust. Shareholders are entitled
to one vote for each full share held. Fractional shares may be voted in
proportion to the amount of the net asset value of a Portfolio which they
represent. Voting rights are not cumulative, which means that the holders of
more than 50% of the shares voting for the election of Trustees can elect 100%
of the Trustees. Shares have no preemptive or conversion rights and are freely
transferable. Upon liquidation of a Portfolio, shareholders are entitled to
share pro rata in the net assets of such Portfolio.

    As permitted by Massachusetts law, there will normally be no meetings of
shareholders for the purpose of electing Trustees unless and until such time as
less than a majority of the Trustees holding office have been elected by
shareholders. In such an event, the Trustees then in office will call a
shareholders' meeting for the election of Trustees. Except for the foregoing
circumstances and unless removed by action of the shareholders in accordance
with the Trust's by-laws, the Trustees will continue to hold office and may
appoint successor Trustees.

    The Trust's by-laws provide that no person shall serve as a Trustee if
shareholders holding two-thirds of the outstanding shares have removed him from
that office either by a written declaration filed with the Trust's custodian or
by votes cast at a meeting called for that purpose. The by-laws further provide
that under certain circumstances the shareholders may call a meeting to remove a
Trustee and that the Trust is required to provide assistance in communicating
with shareholders about such a meeting.

    The rights, if any, of Contractholders to vote the shares of a Portfolio are
governed by the relevant Contract. For information on such voting rights, see
the prospectus describing the Contracts.

                                      20
<PAGE>
 
                            ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

Custodian and Transfer Agent

     Investors Bank & Trust Company, located at 89 South Street, Boston,
Massachusetts 02111, acts as the Trust's custodian and transfer agent.

Independent Auditors

     Deloitte & Touche LLP, located at 125 Summer Street, Boston, Massachusetts
02110, serves as the Trust's independent auditors.




                                      20
<PAGE>
 
                      STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION
 
                        THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY
 
                                Issued through
 
                      PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
 
                                  Offered by
 
                          PFL Life Insurance Company
 
           4333 Edgewood Road, N.E. . Cedar Rapids, Iowa 52499-0001
 
This Statement of Additional information expands upon subjects discussed in
the current Prospectus for the PFL Wright Variable Annuity offered by PFL Life
Insurance Company. You may obtain a copy of the Prospectus dated May 1, 1996
by calling 1-800-525-6205, or by writing to the Administrative and Service Of-
fice, Financial Markets Division - Variable Annuity Dept., 4333 Edgewood Road
N.E., Cedar Rapids, IA 52499-0001. Defined terms used in the current Prospec-
tus for the Certificate are incorporated in this Statement of Additional In-
formation.
 
THIS STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION IS NOT A PROSPECTUS AND SHOULD BE
READ ONLY IN CONJUNCTION WITH THE PROSPECTUSES FOR THE CERTIFICATES AND PORT-
FOLIOS.
 
                              Dated: May 1, 1996
 
 
                               TABLE OF CONTENTS
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                            Page
<S>                         <C>
The Certificate - General
 Provisions................   2
 Participants and Policy
  Owners...................   2
 Entire Certificate........   2
 Deferment of Payment and
  Transfers................   2
 Misstatement of Age or
  Sex......................   2
 Reallocation of Annuity
  Purchase Value After the
  Annuity Commencement
  Date.....................   3
 Assignment................   3
 Evidence of Survival......   3
 Non-Participating.........   4
 Amendments................   4
 Section 403(b)
  Representations..........   4
 Statement Pursuant to Rule
  6e-7:
  Texas Optional Retirement
  Program..................   4
Taxation of PFL............   4
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                           Page
<S>                        <C>
Investment Experience....    5
State Regulation of PFL..    7
Administration...........    7
Records and Reports......    7
Distribution of the
 Certificates............    7
Custody of Assets........    8
Historical Performance
 Data....................    8
 Subaccount Yields.......    8
 Total Returns...........    9
 Other Performance Data..    9
Legal Matters............   10
Independent Auditors.....   10
Other Information........   10
Financial Statements.....   10
</TABLE>
 
  (Numbers in parenthesis indicate corresponding sections of the Prospectus).
 
 
In order to supplement the description in the Prospectus, the following pro-
vides additional information about PFL and the Certificate which may be of in-
terest.
 
                                       1
<PAGE>
 
                     THE CERTIFICATE -- GENERAL PROVISIONS
 
PARTICIPANTS AND POLICY OWNERS
 
  The Certificate will be legally owned by and belong to either (a) the bank
trust or agency account to which it is issued for the benefit of the Partici-
pant, or (b) the Policy Owner in the case of an individual annuity policy. The
Certificate will be issued only after the completion of an application, ac-
ceptance thereof by PFL, and delivery of the initial premium payment to PFL.
While the Annuitant is living, the Certificate Owner may: (1) assign the Cer-
tificate; (2) withdraw the Cash Value; (3) amend or modify the Certificate
with PFL's consent; (4) receive annuity payments or name a payee to receive
the payments; and (5) exercise, receive and enjoy every other right and bene-
fit contained in the Certificate. The exercise of these rights may be subject
to the consent of any assignee or irrevocable Beneficiary.
 
ENTIRE CONTRACT
 
  The Group Contract (if applicable), the Certificate, and any endorsements
thereon, the Group Contract application and the Certificate enrollment form
constitute the entire contract between PFL and the Certificate Owner. For an
Individual Policy, the Individual Policy, any endorsements thereon, and the
application constitute the entire contract between PFL and the Policy Owner.
All statements in an application and enrollment form are representations and
not warranties.
 
DEFERMENT OF PAYMENT AND TRANSFERS
 
  Payment of any amount due from the Variable Account in respect of a with-
drawal, the Death Benefit or the death of the Participant or Policy Owner gen-
erally will occur within seven business days from the date the Written Notice
(and any other required documentation or information) is received by PFL, ex-
cept that PFL may defer such payment from the Variable Account if: (1) the New
York Stock Exchange is closed for other than usual weekends or holidays, or
trading on the Exchange is otherwise restricted; or (2) an emergency exists as
defined by the SEC, or the SEC requires that trading be restricted; or (3) the
SEC permits a delay for the protection of investors. In addition, transfers of
amounts from the Subaccounts may be deferred under these circumstances. PFL
may, when permitted by law, defer paying any partial or total withdrawal pro-
ceeds for up to six months from the date of the partial or total withdrawal
from the Fixed Account.
 
MISSTATEMENT OF AGE OR SEX
 
  If the age or sex of the Annuitant has been misstated, PFL will change the
annuity benefit payable to that which the premium payments would have pur-
chased for the correct age or sex. The dollar amount of any underpayment made
by PFL shall be paid in full with the next payment due such person or the Ben-
eficiary. The dollar amount of any overpayment made by PFL due to
 
                                       2
<PAGE>
 
any misstatement shall be deducted from payments subsequently accruing to such
person or Beneficiary. Any underpayment or overpayment will include interest
at 5% per year, from the date of the wrong payment to the date of the adjust-
ment. The age of the Annuitant may be established at any time by the submis-
sion of proof satisfactory to PFL.
 
REALLOCATION OF ANNUITY PURCHASE VALUE AFTER THE ANNUITY COMMENCEMENT DATE
 
  After the Annuity Commencement Date, the Certificate Owner may reallocate
the value of a designated number of Annuity Units of a Subaccount of the Vari-
able Account then credited to a Certificate into an equal value of Annuity
Units of one or more other Subaccounts of the Variable Account. The minimum
amount which may be reallocated is the lesser of (1) $10 of monthly income or
(2) the entire monthly income of the Annuity Units in the Subaccount from
which the transfer is being made. If the monthly income of the Annuity Units
remaining in an Account or Subaccount after a reallocation is less than $10,
PFL reserves the right to include the value of those Annuity Units as part of
the transfer. The reallocation request must be in writing to PFL's Administra-
tive and Service Office. The reallocation will be based on the relative value
of the Annuity Units of the Subaccount(s) at the end of the Business Day dur-
ing which the transfer request is received. There is no charge assessed in
connection with such reallocation. After the Annuity Commencement Date, no
reallocations may be made from the Fixed Account to the Variable Account. PFL
reserves the right to limit the number of times a reallocation of Annuity Pur-
chase Value may be made, to one in any given Certificate Year.
 
ASSIGNMENT
 
  During the lifetime of the Annuitant, the Certificate Owner may assign any
rights or benefits provided by the Certificate. An assignment will not be
binding on PFL until a copy has been filed at its Administrative and Service
Office. The rights and benefits of the Certificate Owner, and of the Benefi-
ciary, are subject to the rights of the assignee. PFL assumes no responsibil-
ity for the validity or effect of any assignment. Any claim made under an as-
signment shall be subject to proof of interest and the extent of the assign-
ment. An assignment may have tax consequences.
 
  Unless the Certificate Owner so directs by filing written notice with PFL,
no Beneficiary may assign any payments under the Certificate before they are
due. To the extent permitted by law, no payments will be subject to the claims
of any Certificate Owner's, Participant's or Beneficiary's creditors.
 
EVIDENCE OF SURVIVAL
 
  PFL reserves the right to require satisfactory evidence that a person is
alive if PFL's obligation to make a payment is based on that person being
alive. No payment will be made until PFL receives such evidence.
 
                                       3
<PAGE>
 
NON-PARTICIPATING
 
  The Certificate does not participate or share in the profits or surplus
earnings of PFL. No dividends are payable on the Certificate.
 
AMENDMENTS
 
  No change in the Certificate is valid unless made in writing by PFL and ap-
proved by one of PFL's officers. No registered representative has authority to
change or waive any provision of the Certificate.
 
  PFL reserves the right to amend the Certificates to meet the requirements of
the Internal Revenue Code, regulations or published rulings. Such a change can
be refused by giving PFL Written Notice, but a refusal may result in adverse
tax consequences.
 
SECTION 403(b) REPRESENTATIONS
 
  PFL represents that it is relying on a no action letter dated November 28,
1988, to the American Council of Life Insurance (Ref. No. IP-6-88), regarding
Sections 22(e), 27(c)(1), and 27(d) of the Investment Company Act of 1940, in
connection with redeemability restrictions on Section 403(b) Policies, and
that paragraphs numbered (1) through (4) of that letter will be complied with.
 
STATEMENT PURSUANT TO RULE 6e-7: TEXAS OPTIONAL RETIREMENT PROGRAM
 
  PFL and the Variable Account rely on 17 C.F.R. 270.6e-7, and represent that
the provisions of that Rule have been or will be complied with.
 
                                TAXATION OF PFL
 
  PFL at present is taxed as a life insurance company under part I of
Subchapter L of the Code. The Variable Account is treated as part of PFL and,
accordingly, will not be taxed separately as a "regulated investment company"
under Subchapter M of the Code. PFL does not expect to incur any federal in-
come tax liability with respect to investment income and net capital gains
arising from the activities of the Variable Account retained as part of the
reserves under the Certificate. Based on this expectation, it is anticipated
that no charges will be made against the Variable Account for federal income
taxes. If, in future years, any federal income taxes or economic burdens at-
tributable to the application of tax laws are incurred by PFL with respect to
the Variable Account, PFL may make a charge to the Variable Account.
 
 
                                       4
<PAGE>
 
                             INVESTMENT EXPERIENCE
 
  An "Investment Experience Factor" is used to determine the value of Accumu-
lation Units and Annuity Units, and to determine annuity payment rates.
 
ACCUMULATION UNITS
 
  Upon allocation to the selected Subaccount, premium payments are converted
into Accumulation Units of the Subaccount. The number of Accumulation Units to
be credited is determined by dividing the dollar amount allocated to each
Subaccount by the value of an Accumulation Unit for that Subaccount as next
determined after the premium payment is received at the Administrative and
Service Office or, in the case of the initial premium payment, when the Cer-
tificate application is completed, whichever is later. The value of an Accumu-
lation Unit was arbitrarily established at $1.00 at the inception of each
Subaccount. Thereafter, the value of an Accumulation Unit is determined as of
the close of trading on each day the New York Stock Exchange and PFL's Admin-
istrative and Service Office are open for business.
 
  An index (the "Investment Experience Factor") which measures the investment
performance of a Subaccount during a Valuation Period is used to determine the
value of an Accumulation Unit for the next subsequent Valuation Period. The
Investment Experience Factor may be greater or less than or equal to one;
therefore, the value of an Accumulation Unit may increase, decrease or remain
the same from one Valuation Period to the next. The Participant or Policy
Owner bears this investment risk. The Net Investment Performance of a
Subaccount and deduction of certain charges affects the Accumulation Unit Val-
ue.
 
  The Investment Experience Factor for any Subaccount for any Valuation Period
is determined by dividing (a) by (b) and subtracting (c) from the result,
where:
 
  (a) is the net result of:
 
    (1) the net asset value per share of the shares held in the Subaccount
        determined at the end of the current Valuation Period, plus
 
    (2) The per share amount of any dividend or capital gain distribution
        made with respect to the shares held in the Subaccount if the ex-
        dividend date occurs during the current Valuation Period, plus or
        minus
 
    (3) a per share charge or credit for any taxes determined by PFL to
        have resulted from the investment operations of the Subaccount and
        for which it has created a reserve;
 
  (b) is the net asset value per share of the shares held in the Subaccount
      determined as of the end of the immediately preceding Valuation
      Period; and
 
  (c) is the charge for mortality and expense risk during the Valuation
      Period equal on an annual basis to 1.00% of the daily net asset value
      of the Subaccount.
 
                                       5
<PAGE>
 
ANNUITY UNIT VALUE AND ANNUITY PAYMENT RATES
 
  The amount of Variable Annuity Payments will vary with Annuity Unit Values.
Annuity Unit Values rise if the net investment performance of the Subaccount
exceeds the assumed interest rate of 5% annually. Conversely, Annuity Unit
Values fall if the net investment performance of the Subaccount is less than
the assumed rate. The value of a Variable Annuity Unit in each Subaccount was
established at $1.00 on the date operations began for that Subaccount. The
value of a Variable Annuity Unit on any subsequent Business Day is equal to
(a) multiplied by (b) multiplied by (c), where:
 
  (a) is the variable Annuity Unit Value on the immediately preceding
      Business Day;
 
  (b) is the net investment factor of the valuation period; and
 
  (c) is the investment result adjustment factor for the valuation period.
 
  The investment result adjustment factor for the valuation period is the
product of discount factors of .99986634 per day to recognize the 5% effective
annual assumed investment return. The valuation period is the period from the
close of the immediately preceding Business Day to the close of the current
Business Day.
 
  The net investment factor for the Certificate used to calculate the value of
a variable Annuity Unit in each Subaccount for the valuation period is deter-
mined by dividing (i) by (ii) and subtracting (iii) from the result, where:
 
  (i) is the result of:
 
    (1) the net asset value of a Trust share held in the Variable Account
        for that Subaccount determined at the end of the current valuation
        period; plus
 
    (2) the per share amount of any dividend or capital gain distributions
        made by the Trust for shares held in the Variable Account for that
        Subaccount if the ex-dividend date occurs during the valuation
        period; plus or minus
 
    (3) a per share charge or credit for any taxes reserved for by PFL,
        determined by PFL to have resulted from the investment operations
        of that Subaccount.
 
  (ii) is the net asset value of a Trust share held in the Variable Account
       for that Subaccount determined as of the end of the immediately
       preceding valuation period.
 
  (iii) is a factor representing the mortality and expense risk fee and
        administrative charge. This factor is equal, on an annual basis, to
        1.00% of the daily net asset value of a Trust share held in the
        Variable Account for that Subaccount.
 
The dollar amount of subsequent Variable Annuity Payments will depend upon
changes in applicable Annuity Unit Values.
 
                                       6
<PAGE>
 
  The Annuity Payment rates vary according to the Annuity Payment Option
elected and the sex and adjusted age of the Annuitant at the Annuity Commence-
ment Date. The Certificate also contains a table for determining the adjusted
age of the Annuitant.
 
                            STATE REGULATION OF PFL
 
  PFL is subject to the laws of Iowa governing insurance companies and to reg-
ulation by the Iowa Division of Insurance. An annual statement in a prescribed
form is filed with the Division of Insurance each year covering the operation
of PFL for the preceding year and its financial condition as of the end of
such year. Regulation by the Division of Insurance includes periodic examina-
tion to determine PFL's contract liabilities and reserves so that the Division
may determine that the items are correct. PFL's books and accounts are subject
to review by the Division of Insurance at all times; and a full examination of
its operations is conducted periodically by the National Association of Insur-
ance Commissioners. In addition, PFL is subject to regulation under the insur-
ance laws of other jurisdictions in which it may operate.
 
                                ADMINISTRATION
 
  PFL performs the administrative services for the Contracts. These services
include issuance of the Certificates, maintenance of records concerning the
Certificates, and certain valuation services.
 
                              RECORDS AND REPORTS
 
  All records and accounts relating to the Variable Account will be maintained
by PFL. As presently required by the Investment Company Act of 1940 and regu-
lations promulgated thereunder, PFL will mail to the Certificate Owner at
least annually, reports containing such information as may be required under
that Act or by any other applicable law or regulation. The Certificate Owner
will also receive confirmation of each financial transaction and any other re-
ports required by law or regulation.
 
                       DISTRIBUTION OF THE CERTIFICATES
 
  The Certificates are offered through brokers licensed under the federal se-
curities laws and state insurance laws. The offering of the Certificates is
continuous and PFL does not anticipate discontinuing the offering of the Cer-
tificates. However, PFL reserves the right to discontinue the offering of the
Certificates.
 
                                       7
<PAGE>
 
  Wright Investors' Services Distributors, Inc., an affiliate of the Adviser,
will be the principal underwriter of the Certificates. The amount paid to
Wright Investors' Services Distributors, Inc. for this service was $0, $7,818
and $19,055 for 1993, 1994 and 1995 respectively.
 
                               CUSTODY OF ASSETS
 
  The assets of each of the Subaccounts of the Variable Account are held by
PFL. The assets of each of the Subaccounts of the Variable Account are segre-
gated and held separate and apart from the assets of the other Subaccounts and
from PFL's Fixed Account assets. PFL maintains records of all purchases and
redemptions of shares of the Trust held by each of the Subaccounts. Additional
protection for the assets of the Variable Account is afforded by PFL's fidel-
ity bond, presently in the amount of $5,000,000, covering the acts of officers
and employees of PFL.
 
                          HISTORICAL PERFORMANCE DATA
 
SUBACCOUNT YIELDS
 
  PFL may from time to time advertise or disclose the current annualized yield
of one or more of the Subaccounts of the Variable Account for 30-day periods.
The annualized yield of a Subaccount refers to income generated by the
Subaccount over a specific 30-day period. Because the yield is annualized, the
yield generated by a Subaccount during the 30-day period is assumed to be gen-
erated each 30-day period over a 12-month period. The yield is computed by:
(i) dividing the net investment income of the Subaccount less Subaccount ex-
penses for the period, by (ii) the maximum offering price per unit on the last
day of the period times the daily average number of units outstanding for the
period, (iii) compounding that yield for a 6-month period, and (iv) multiply-
ing that result by 2. Expenses attributable to the Subaccount include (i) the
Administrative Charge and (ii) the Mortality and Expense Risk Charge. The 30-
day yield is calculated according to the following formula:
 
      Yield = 2 x ( ( ((NI - ES) / (U X UV)) + 1) to the sixth power - 1)
 
Where:
 
   NI    = Net investment income of the Subaccount for the 30-day period
           attributable to the Subaccount's unit.
   ES    = Expenses of the Subaccount for the 30-day period.
   U     = The average number of units outstanding.
   UV    = The unit value at the close (highest) of the last day in the 30-day
           period.
 
  Because of the charges and deductions imposed by the Variable Account, the
yield for a Subaccount of the Variable Account will be lower than the yield
for its corresponding Portfolio. The yield calculations do not reflect the ef-
fect of any premium taxes that may be applicable to a particular Certificate.
 
                                       8
<PAGE>
 
  The yield on amounts held in the Subaccounts of the Variable Account nor-
mally will fluctuate over time. Therefore, the disclosed yield for any given
past period is not an indication or representation of future yields or rates
of return. A Subaccount's actual yield is affected by the types and quality of
its investments and its operating expenses.
 
TOTAL RETURNS
 
  PFL may from time to time also advertise or disclose total returns for one
or more of the Subaccounts of the Variable Account for various periods of
time. One of the periods of time will include the period measured from the
date the Subaccount commenced operations. When a Subaccount has been in opera-
tion for 1, 5 and 10 years, respectively, the total return for these periods
will be provided. Total returns for other periods of time may from time to
time also be disclosed. Total returns represent the average annual compounded
rates of return that would equate an initial investment of $1,000 to the re-
demption value of that investment as of the last day of each of the periods.
The ending date for each period for which total return quotations are provided
will be for the most recent month end practicable, considering the type and
media of the communication, and will be stated in the communication.
 
  Total returns will be calculated using Subaccount Unit Values which PFL cal-
culates on each Business Day based on the performance of the Subaccount's un-
derlying Portfolio, and the deductions for the Mortality and Expense Risk
Charge. The total return will then be calculated according to the following
formula:
 
                          P(1+T) to the N power = ERV
 
Where:
 
   T     = The average annual total return net of Subaccount recurring charges.
   ERV   = The ending redeemable value of the hypothetical account at the end
           of the period.
   P     = A hypothetical initial payment of $1,000.
   N     = The number of years in the period.
 
OTHER PERFORMANCE DATA
 
  PFL may from time to time also disclose average annual total returns in a
non-standard format in conjunction with the standard format described above.
 
  PFL may from time to time also disclose cumulative total returns in conjunc-
tion with the standard format described above. The cumulative returns will be
calculated using the following formula.
 
                              CTR = (ERV / P) - 1
 
                                       9
<PAGE>
 
Where:
 
   CTR  =  The cumulative total return net of Subaccount recurring charges for
           the period.
   ERV  =  The ending redeemable value of the hypothetical investment at the
           end of the period.
   P    =  A hypothetical initial payment of $1,000.
 
  All non-standard performance data will only be advertised if the standard
performance data for the same period, as well as for the required period, is
also disclosed.
 
                                 LEGAL MATTERS
 
  Legal advice relating to certain matters under the federal securities laws
applicable to the issue and sale of the Certificates has been provided to PFL
by Sutherland, Asbill & Brennan, of Washington, D.C.
 
                             INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
 
  The Financial Statements of PFL at December 31, 1995 and 1994 and for each
of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1995, and the Financial
Statements of PFL Wright Variable Annuity Account at December 31, 1995 and for
each of the two years in the period then ended, included in this Statement of
Additional Information have been audited by Ernst & Young, LLP, Independent
Auditors, Des Moines, Iowa.
 
                               OTHER INFORMATION
 
  A Registration Statement has been filed with the Securities and Exchange
Commission, under the Securities Act of 1933 as amended, with respect to the
Certificates discussed in this Statement of Additional Information. Not all of
the information set forth in the Registration Statement, amendments, and ex-
hibits thereto has been included in the Prospectus or this Statement of Addi-
tional Information. Statements contained in the Prospectus and this Statement
of Additional Information concerning the content of the Certificates and other
legal instruments are intended to be summaries. For a complete statement of
the terms of these documents, reference should be made to the instruments
filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission.
 
                             FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
 
  The values of the interests of Participants or Policy Owners in the Variable
Account will be affected solely by the investment results of the selected
Subaccount(s). Financial Statements of PFL Wright Variable Annuity Account are
contained herein. The Financial Statements of PFL, which are included in this
Statement of Additional Information, should be considered only as bearing on
the ability of PFL to meet its obligations under the Certificates. They should
not be considered as bearing on the investment performance of the assets held
in the Variable Account.
 
                                      10
<PAGE>
 
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                        REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
 
The Board of Directors and Contract Owners of
The PFL Wright Variable Annuity Account,
PFL Life Insurance Company:
 
  We have audited the accompanying balance sheet of The PFL Wright Variable
Annuity Account (comprising, respectively, the Wright Near Term Bond, Wright
Total Return Bond, Wright Selected Blue Chip and Wright International Blue
Chip subaccounts) as of December 31, 1995, and the related statements of oper-
ations and changes in contract owners' equity for the periods indicated there-
in. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Variable Ac-
count's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these fi-
nancial statements based on our audits.
 
  We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing stan-
dards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of mate-
rial misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence sup-
porting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our proce-
dures included confirmation of mutual fund shares owned as of December 31,
1995 by correspondence with the mutual funds' transfer agent. An audit also
includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates
made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement pre-
sentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opin-
ion.
 
  In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly,
in all material respects, the financial position of each of the respective
subaccounts constituting The PFL Wright Variable Annuity Account at December
31, 1995 and the results of their operations and changes in their contract
owners' equity for the periods indicated therein in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles.
 
                                                            Ernst & Young LLP
 
Des Moines, Iowa
February 6, 1996
 
                                      11
<PAGE>
 
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                                 BALANCE SHEET
                               December 31, 1995
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                Wright     Wright      Wright      Wright
                                              Near Term     Total     Selected  International
                                                 Bond    Return Bond Blue Chip    Blue Chip
                                     TOTAL    Subaccount Subaccount  Subaccount  Subaccount
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>
ASSETS

Cash.............................. $       20       10          10       --          --

Investments in mutual funds, 
 at current market value:
 Wright Managed Blue Chip
  Series Trust
 Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio
  33,060.442 shares @ $9.88
  (cost $319,194).................    326,637  326,637       --          --          --
 Wright Total Return Bond
  Portfolio 54,676.087 shares
   @ $9.83 (cost $509,573)........
  $509,573).......................    537,466     --       537,466       --          --
 Wright Selected Blue Chip
  Portfolio 196,275.675 shares @
  $11.41 (cost $1,978,790)........  2,239,505     --         --      2,239,505       --
 Wright International Blue Chip
  Portfolio 135,714.947 shares
  @ $10.06 (cost $1,318,175)......  1,365,292     --         --          --       1,365,292
                                   ----------  -------     -------   ---------    ---------
 Total investments in mutual
  funds...........................  4,468,900  326,637     537,466   2,239,505    1,365,292
                                   ----------  -------     -------   ---------    ---------
 Total Assets..................... $4,468,920  326,647     537,476   2,239,505    1,365,292
                                   ==========  =======     =======   =========    =========
LIABILITIES AND CONTRACT
 OWNERS' EQUITY
Liabilities:
 Contract terminations
  payable......................... $      279     --         --            236           43
                                   ----------  -------     -------   ---------    ---------
 Total Liabilities......                  279     --         --            236           43
Contract Owners' Equity:
 Deferred annuity contracts
  terminable by owners
  (Notes 2 and 5).................  4,468,641  326,647     537,476   2,239,269    1,365,249
                                   ----------  -------     -------   ---------    ---------
                                   $4,468,920  326,647     537,476   2,239,505    1,365,292
                                   ==========  =======     =======   =========    =========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying Notes to Financial Statements.
 
                                       12
<PAGE>
 
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                            STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS
                          Year Ended December 31, 1995
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                           Wright     Wright      Wright      Wright
                                         Near Term     Total     Selected  International
                                            Bond    Return Bond Blue Chip    Blue Chip
                               TOTAL     Subaccount Subaccount  Subaccount  Subaccount
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                          <C>         <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>         
NET INVESTMENT INCOME
 (LOSS)
Income:
 Dividends................   $  113,111    15,926      22,811     67,617        6,757
Expenses (Note 4):
 Administration Fee.......        1,500       118         238        692          452
 Mortality and expense
  risk charge.............       36,045     3,473       4,947     15,479       12,146
                             ----------   -------     -------    -------      -------
 Net investment income
  (loss)..................       75,566    12,335      17,626     51,446       (5,841)
                             ----------   -------     -------    -------      -------
NET REALIZED AND UNREALIZED CAPITAL GAIN FROM
 INVESTMENTS
Net realized capital gain
 from sales of
 investments:
 Proceeds from sales......    1,414,553   302,860     240,590    424,039      447,064
 Cost of investments
  sold....................    1,377,773   301,616     233,846    400,982      441,329
                             ----------   -------     -------    -------      -------
Net realized capital gain
 from sales of
 investments..............       36,780     1,244       6,744     23,057        5,735
                             ----------   -------     -------    -------      -------
Net change in unrealized
 appreciation/depreciation
 of investments:
 Beginning of the year....     (141,333)  (11,500)    (17,153)   (44,839)     (67,841)
 End of the year..........      343,168     7,443      27,893    260,715       47,117
                             ----------   -------     -------    -------      -------
 Net change in unrealized
  appreciation/depreciation
  of investments..........      484,501    18,943      45,046    305,554      114,958
                             ----------   -------     -------    -------      -------
 Net realized and
  unrealized capital gain
  from investments........      521,281    20,187      51,790    328,611      120,693
                             ----------   -------     -------    -------      -------
INCREASE FROM OPERATIONS..   $  596,847    32,522      69,416    380,057      114,852
                             ==========   =======     =======    =======      =======
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying Notes to Financial Statements.
 
                                       13
<PAGE>
 
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN CONTRACT OWNERS' EQUITY
            Years Ended December 31, 1995 and 1994, Except as Noted
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                 Wright
                                                                Near Term
                                                                  Bond
                                            TOTAL              Subaccount
                                        1995       1994       1995    1994/1/
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                  <C>         <C>        <C>       <C>
OPERATIONS
 Net investment income (loss)....... $   75,566     19,280    12,335    10,388
 Net realized capital gain (loss)...     36,780    (44,146)    1,244   (12,468)
 Net change in unrealized
  appreciation/depreciation of
  investments.......................    484,501   (140,506)   18,943   (11,500)
                                     ----------  ---------  --------  --------
 Increase (decrease) from
  operations........................    596,847   (165,372)   32,522   (13,580)
                                     ----------  ---------  --------  --------
CONTRACT TRANSACTIONS
 Net contract purchase payments.....  1,071,758  3,722,425    77,059   775,759
 Transfer payments from (to) other
  subaccounts or general account....   (114,120)   (13,566) (135,719) (310,263)
 Contract terminations, withdrawals,
  and other deductions..............   (736,613)   (59,907)  (99,131)    --
                                     ----------  ---------  --------  --------
 Increase (decrease) from contract
  transactions......................    221,025  3,648,952  (157,791)  465,496
                                     ----------  ---------  --------  --------
 Net increase (decrease) in contract
  owners' equity....................    817,872  3,483,580  (125,269)  451,916
CONTRACT OWNERS' EQUITY
 Beginning of the period............  3,650,769    167,189   451,916     --
                                     ----------  ---------  --------  --------
 End of the period.................. $4,468,641  3,650,769   326,647   451,916
                                     ==========  =========  ========  ========
</TABLE>
 
/1/Period from January 6, 1994 (commencement of operations) to December 31,
1994
 
See accompanying Notes to Financial Statements.
 
                                       14
<PAGE>
 
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN CONTRACT OWNERS' EQUITY
      Years Ended December 31, 1995 and 1994, Except as Noted (continued)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
       Wright                     Wright                        Wright
        Total                    Selected                    International
     Return Bond                 Blue Chip                     Blue Chip
     Subaccount                 Subaccount                    Subaccount
   1995        1994          1995          1994/1/         1995          1994/1/
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>          <C>           <C>            <C>            <C>            <C>
   17,626      14,282         51,446            859         (5,841)        (6,249)
    6,744     (23,120)        23,057         (4,908)         5,735         (3,650)
   45,046     (16,326)       305,554        (44,839)       114,958        (67,841)
 --------    --------      ---------      ---------      ---------      ---------
   69,416     (25,164)       380,057        (48,888)       114,852        (77,740)
 --------    --------      ---------      ---------      ---------      ---------
  166,975     609,386        513,090      1,297,693        314,634      1,039,587
 (173,228)   (212,796)       237,738        225,791        (42,911)       283,702
  (45,543)    (18,759)      (342,677)       (23,535)      (249,262)       (17,613)
 --------    --------      ---------      ---------      ---------      ---------
  (51,796)    377,831        408,151      1,499,949         22,461      1,305,676
 --------    --------      ---------      ---------      ---------      ---------
   17,620     352,667        788,208      1,451,061        137,313      1,227,936
  519,856     167,189      1,451,061         --          1,227,936         --
 --------    --------      ---------      ---------      ---------      ---------
  537,476     519,856      2,239,269      1,451,061      1,365,249      1,227,936
 ========    ========      =========      =========      =========      =========
</TABLE>
 
                                       15
<PAGE>
 
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
                               December 31, 1995
 
1. ORGANIZATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
Organization -- The PFL Wright Variable Annuity Account ("Variable Account")
is a segregated investment account of PFL Life Insurance Company ("PFL Life"),
an indirect, wholly-owned subsidiary of AEGON USA, Inc. ("AUSA"), a holding
company. AUSA is an indirect, wholly-owned subsidiary of AEGON nv, a holding
company organized under the laws of The Netherlands.
 
The Wright Near Term Bond, Wright Selected Blue Chip and Wright International
Blue Chip subaccounts, commenced operations on January 6, 1994.
 
The Variable Account is registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission
as a Unit Investment Trust pursuant to provisions of the Investment Company
Act of 1940.
 
Investments -- Net purchase payments received by the Variable Account are in-
vested in the portfolios of the Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust as se-
lected by the contract owner. Investments are stated at the closing net asset
values per share on December 31, 1995.
 
Realized capital gains and losses from sale of shares in the mutual funds are
determined on the first-in, first-out basis. Investment transactions are ac-
counted for on the trade date (date the order to buy or sell is executed) and
dividend income is recorded on the ex-dividend date. Unrealized gains or
losses from investments in the mutual funds are credited or charged to con-
tract owners' equity.
 
Dividend Income -- Dividends received from the mutual funds investments are
reinvested to purchase additional mutual fund shares.
 
2. CONTRACT OWNERS' EQUITY
 
A summary of deferred annuity contracts terminable by owners at December 31,
1995 follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                    Accumulation
                                      Accumulation      Unit         Total
Subaccount                             Units Owned     Value     Contract Value
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                   <C>           <C>          <C>
Wright Near Term Bond................   312,204.941  $1.046259     $  326,647
Wright Total Return Bond.............   509,157.449   1.055619        537,476
Wright Selected Blue Chip............ 1,934,519.692   1.157532      2,239,269
Wright International Blue Chip....... 1,380,932.622   0.988643      1,365,249
                                                                   ----------
                                                                   $4,468,641
                                                                   ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                      16
<PAGE>
 
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
 
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                 NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                               December 31, 1995
 
  A summary of changes in contract owners' account units follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                 Wright     Wright      Wright       Wright
                               Near Term     Total     Selected   International
                                  Bond    Return Bond Blue Chip     Blue Chip
                               Subaccount Subaccount  Subaccount   Subaccount
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                            <C>        <C>         <C>         <C>
Units outstanding at 1/1/94..      --       168,578       --           --
Units purchased..............    796,040    646,394   1,355,142     1,087,357
Units redeemed and trans-
 ferred......................   (321,803)  (245,094)    211,939       273,003
                                --------   --------   ---------     ---------
Units outstanding at
 12/31/94....................    474,237    569,878   1,567,081     1,360,360
Units purchased..............     75,750    160,589     465,414       324,834
Units redeemed and trans-
 ferred......................   (237,782)  (221,310)    (97,975)     (304,261)
                                --------   --------   ---------     ---------
Units outstanding at
 12/31/95....................    312,205    509,157   1,934,520     1,380,933
                                ========   ========   =========     =========
</TABLE>
 
3. TAXES
 
  Operations of the Variable Account form a part of PFL Life, which is taxed
as a life insurance company under Subchapter L of the Internal Revenue Code of
1986, as amended (the "Code"). The operations of the Variable Account are ac-
counted for separately from other operations of PFL Life for purposes of fed-
eral income taxation. The Variable Account is not separately taxable as a reg-
ulated investment company under Subchapter M of the Code and is not otherwise
taxable as an entity separate from PFL Life. Under existing federal income tax
laws, the income of the Variable Account, to the extent applied to increase
reserves under the variable annuity contracts, is not taxable to PFL Life.
 
4. ADMINISTRATIVE, MORTALITY AND EXPENSE RISK CHARGE
 
  Administrative charges include an annual charge of $30 per contract which
will commence on the first policy anniversary of each contract owner's ac-
count. Charges for administrative fees to the variable annuity contracts are
an expense of the Variable Account.
 
  PFL Life deducts a daily charge equal to an annual rate of 1.00% of the
value of the contract owner's individual account as a charge for assuming cer-
tain mortality and expense risks.
 
                                      17
<PAGE>
 
THE PFL WRIGHT VARIABLE ANNUITY ACCOUNT
 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 
                  NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- (CONTINUED)
                               December 31, 1995
 
5. NET ASSETS
 
  At December 31, 1995 contract owners' equity was comprised of:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                      Wright     Wright      Wright      Wright
                                    Near Term     Total     Selected  International
                                       Bond    Return Bond Blue Chip    Blue Chip
                           Total    Subaccount Subaccount  Subaccount  Subaccount
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                      <C>        <C>        <C>         <C>        <C>
Unit transactions,
 accumulated net
 investment income and
 realized capital
 gains.................. $4,125,473  319,204     509,583   1,978,554    1,318,132
Adjustment for
 appreciation to market
 value..................    343,168    7,443      27,893     260,715       47,117
                         ----------  -------     -------   ---------    ---------
Total Contract Owners'
 Equity................. $4,468,641  326,647     537,476   2,239,269    1,365,249
                         ==========  =======     =======   =========    =========
</TABLE>
 
6. PURCHASES AND SALES OF INVESTMENT SECURITIES
 
  The aggregate cost of purchases and proceeds from sales of investments were
as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       Years Ended December 31 or Commencement
                                             of Operations to December 31
                                       ----------------------------------------
                                               1995                1994
                                       -------------------- -------------------
                                       Purchases    Sales   Purchases   Sales
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                    <C>        <C>       <C>       <C>
Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust
 Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio...... $  157,665   302,860   987,147   511,535
 Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio...    206,065   240,590   812,481   420,240
 Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio..    882,068   424,039 1,588,476    85,864
 Wright International Blue Chip Port-
  folio...............................    462,087   447,064 1,413,534   112,467
                                       ---------- --------- --------- ---------
                                       $1,707,885 1,414,553 4,801,638 1,130,106
                                       ========== ========= ========= =========
</TABLE>
 
                                       18
<PAGE>
 
                [LETTERHEAD OF ERNST & YOUNG LLP APPEARS HERE]
 
                        REPORT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
 
The Board of DirectorsPFL Life Insurance Company
 
  We have audited the accompanying statutory-basis balance sheets of PFL Life
Insurance Company as of December 31, 1995 and 1994, and the related statutory-
basis statements of operations, changes in capital and surplus and cash flows
for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 1995. Our audits
also included the statutory-basis financial statement schedules required by
Regulation S-X, Article 7. These financial statements are the responsibility
of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on
these financial statements and schedules based on our audits.
 
  We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing stan-
dards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of mate-
rial misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence sup-
porting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also
includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates
made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement pre-
sentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opin-
ion.
 
  The Company presents its financial statements in conformity with the ac-
counting practices prescribed or permitted by the Insurance Division, Depart-
ment of Commerce, of the State of Iowa. The variances between such practices
and generally accepted accounting principles are described in Note 1. The ef-
fects of these variances have not been determined but we believe they are ma-
terial.
 
  In our opinion, because of the materiality of the effects of the variances
between generally accepted accounting principles and the accounting practices
referred to in the preceding paragraph, the financial statements referred to
above are not intended to and do not present fairly, in conformity with gener-
ally accepted accounting principles, the financial position of PFL Life Insur-
ance Company at December 31, 1995 and 1994, or the results of its operations
or its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31,
1995.
 
  In addition, in our opinion, the financial statements referred to above
present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of PFL Life
Insurance Company at December 31, 1995 and 1994, and the results of its opera-
tions and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended De-
cember 31, 1995 in conformity with accounting practices prescribed or permit-
ted by the Insurance Division, Department of Commerce, of the State of Iowa.
Also, in our opinion, the related statutory-basis financial statement sched-
ules, when considered in relation to the basic statutory-basis financial
statements taken as a whole, present fairly in all material respects informa-
tion set forth therein.
 
                                                             ERNST & YOUNG, LLP
 
Des Moines, IowaFebruary 23, 1996
 
                                      19
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
                       BALANCE SHEETS -- STATUTORY BASIS
                (Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                December 31
                                                           ---------------------
                                                              1995       1994
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                        <C>        <C>
ADMITTED ASSETS
Cash and invested assets:
 Cash and short-term investments.........................  $   79,852 $   34,062
 Bonds...................................................   4,613,334  4,094,407
 Stocks:
  Preferred...............................................      9,336     12,667
  Common (cost: 1995 -- $19,061; 1994 -- $15,812).........     24,866     16,754
  Affiliated entities (cost: 1995 -- $14,661; 1994 --
   $13,155)..............................................       6,794     26,530
 Mortgage loans on real estate...........................     680,414    527,410
 Real estate, at cost less accumulated depreciation
  ($12,493 in 1995; $12,318 in 1994):
  Home office properties..................................     20,403     21,226
  Properties acquired in satisfaction of debt.............      2,648     10,381
  Investment properties...................................     40,453     45,859
 Policy loans............................................      52,675     51,798
 Other invested assets...................................       5,586      4,593
                                                           ---------- ----------
 Total cash and invested assets..........................   5,536,361  4,845,687
Premiums deferred and uncollected........................      17,026     18,386
Accrued investment income................................      68,065     61,969
Receivable from affiliates...............................      79,913     31,843
Federal income taxes recoverable.........................       9,776     10,274
Other assets.............................................      40,774     29,441
Separate account assets..................................   1,418,157  1,120,391
                                                           ---------- ----------
 Total admitted assets...................................  $7,170,072 $6,117,991
                                                           ========== ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                       20
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
                       BALANCE SHEETS -- STATUTORY BASIS
                (Dollars in thousands, except per share amounts)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                               December 31
                                                          ---------------------
                                                             1995       1994
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                       <C>        <C>
LIABILITIES AND CAPITAL AND SURPLUS
Liabilities:
 Aggregate reserves for policies and contracts:
  Life..................................................  $  596,039 $  545,870
  Annuity...............................................   4,220,274  3,693,388
  Accident and health...................................     114,884     99,240
 Policy and contract claim reserves:
  Life..................................................       6,225      7,493
  Accident and health...................................      70,517     66,407
 Other policyholders' funds.............................     105,371     87,574
 Remittances and items not allocated....................     123,710     35,415
 Asset valuation reserve................................      43,921     37,975
 Interest maintenance reserve...........................      26,376     22,826
 Other liabilities......................................      67,070     73,071
 Separate account liabilities...........................   1,418,157  1,120,391
                                                          ---------- ----------
 Total liabilities......................................   6,792,544  5,789,650
Commitments and contingencies
Capital and surplus:
  Common stock, $10 par value, 500 shares authorized, 266
   issued and outstanding...............................       2,660      2,660
  Paid-in surplus.......................................     154,129    114,129
  Unassigned surplus....................................     220,739    211,552
                                                          ---------- ----------
  Total capital and surplus.............................     377,528    328,341
                                                          ---------- ----------
  Total liabilities and capital and surplus.............  $7,170,072 $6,117,991
                                                          ========== ==========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes.
 
                                       21
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
                  STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS -- STATUTORY BASIS
                             (Dollars in Thousands)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 Year ended December 31
                                            ----------------------------------
                                               1995        1994        1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                         <C>         <C>         <C>
Revenues:
 Premiums and other considerations, net of
  reinsurance:
  Life..................................... $  114,704  $  148,954  $   98,670
  Annuity..................................    921,452   1,067,406     740,787
  Accident and health......................    232,738     230,889     266,789
 Net investment income....................     392,685     343,880     322,393
 Amortization of interest maintenance
  reserve.................................       4,341       2,871       2,674
 Commissions and expense allowances on
  reinsurance ceded.......................      77,071      94,635      62,584
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
                                             1,742,991   1,888,635   1,493,897
Benefits and expenses:
 Benefits paid or provided for:
  Life and accident and health benefits....    146,346     141,632     162,308
  Surrender benefits.......................    498,626     392,064     217,998
  Other benefits...........................     88,607      73,306      50,195
  Increase in aggregate reserves for
   policies and contracts:
   Life....................................     50,071      82,062      26,703
   Annuity.................................    528,330     569,341     250,241
   Accident and health.....................     17,694      22,144      19,216
   Other...................................     16,017      11,223       4,352
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
                                             1,345,691   1,291,772     731,013
 Insurance expenses:
  Commissions..............................    200,706     215,635     198,251
  General insurance expenses...............     57,623      52,166      53,367
  Taxes, licenses and fees.................     15,700      15,368      10,781
  Transfer to separate account.............     42,981     243,806     414,819
  Other expenses...........................        760       1,014         814
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
                                               317,770     527,989     678,032
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
                                             1,663,461   1,819,761   1,409,045
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
Gain from operations before federal income
 taxes and net realized capital losses on
 investments..............................      79,530      68,874      84,852
Federal income tax expense................      33,335      23,858      31,667
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
Gain from operations before net realized
 capital losses on investments............      46,195      45,016      53,185
Net realized capital losses on investments
 (net of related federal income taxes and
 transfer to interest maintenance
 reserve).................................     (18,096)     (3,624)       (451)
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
Net income................................  $   28,099  $   41,392  $   52,734
                                            ==========  ==========  ==========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes.
 
                                       22
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
        STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN CAPITAL AND SURPLUS -- STATUTORY BASIS
                             (Dollars in Thousands)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                              Additional               Total
                                       Common  Paid-in   Unassigned Capital and
                                       Stock   Capital    Surplus     Surplus
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                    <C>    <C>        <C>        <C>
Balance at January 1, 1993............ $2,660  $ 99,129   $213,665   $315,454
 Net income for 1993..................   --       --        52,734     52,734
 Net unrealized capital gains.........   --       --         1,719      1,719
 Increase in non-admitted assets......   --       --            (5)        (5)
 Increase in asset valuation reserve..   --       --       (10,773)   (10,773)
 Dividend to stockholder..............   --       --       (46,000)   (46,000)
 Surplus effect of sale of division...   --       --          (862)      (862)
 Cancellation of coinsurance
  agreement...........................   --       --          (288)      (288)
 Decrease in liability for reinsurance
  in unauthorized companies...........   --       --         2,340      2,340
 Prior period adjustment..............   --       --           452        452
                                       ------  --------   --------   --------
Balance at December 31, 1993..........  2,660    99,129    212,982    314,771
 Capital contribution.................   --      15,000      --        15,000
 Net income for 1994..................   --       --        41,392     41,392
 Net unrealized capital losses........   --       --       (25,350)   (25,350)
 Increase in non-admitted assets......   --       --          (248)      (248)
 Decrease in asset valuation reserve..   --       --         6,040      6,040
 Dividend to stockholder..............   --       --       (20,900)   (20,900)
 Surplus effect of ceding commissions
  associated with the sale of a
  division............................   --       --           184        184
 Amendment of reinsurance agreement...   --       --           391        391
 Decrease in liability for reinsurance
  in unauthorized companies...........   --       --           505        505
 Prior period adjustment..............   --       --        (3,444)    (3,444)
                                       ------  --------   --------   --------
Balance at December 31, 1994..........  2,660   114,129    211,552    328,341
 Capital contribution.................   --      40,000      --        40,000
 Net income for 1995..................   --       --        28,099     28,099
 Net unrealized capital losses........   --       --        (7,574)    (7,574)
 Decrease in non-admitted assets......   --       --            50         50
 Increase in asset valuation reserve..   --       --        (5,946)    (5,946)
 Surplus effect of ceding commissions
  associated with the sale of a
  division............................   --       --            35         35
 Cancellation of reinsurance
  agreement...........................   --       --           585        585
 Amendment of reinsurance agreement...   --       --           419        419
 Dividend of subsidiary to
  stockholder.........................   --       --        (3,250)    (3,250)
 Change in reserve valuation
  methodology.........................   --       --          (501)      (501)
 Increase in liability for reinsurance
  in unauthorized companies...........   --       --        (2,730)    (2,730)
                                       ------  --------   --------   --------
Balance at December 31, 1995.......... $2,660  $154,129   $220,739   $377,528
                                       ======  ========   ========   ========
</TABLE>
 
See accompanying notes.
 
                                       23
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
                  STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS -- STATUTORY BASIS
                             (Dollars in thousands)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 Year Ended December 31
                                            ----------------------------------
                                               1995        1994        1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                         <C>         <C>         <C>
SOURCES OF CASH
Premiums and other considerations, net of
 reinsurance..............................  $1,348,559  $1,547,797  $1,169,096
Net investment income.....................     398,051     339,856     326,480
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
                                            $1,746,610  $1,887,653  $1,495,576
Life and accident and health claims.......    (140,798)   (137,602)   (159,968)
Surrender benefits and other fund
 withdrawals..............................    (498,626)   (392,064)   (217,998)
Other benefits to policyholders...........     (88,519)    (73,237)    (50,180)
Commissions, other expenses and other
 taxes....................................    (273,397)   (288,151)   (264,124)
Net transfers to separate accounts........     (42,981)   (243,806)   (414,819)
Dividends to policyholders................        (940)     (1,155)     (1,200)
Federal income taxes, excluding tax on
 capital gains and IRS settlements........     (32,905)    (39,864)    (32,548)
Increase in policy loans..................        (877)     (3,202)       (677)
Increase in remittances and items not
 allocated................................      88,295      16,177       3,982
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
Net cash provided by operations...........  $  755,862  $  724,749  $  358,044
Proceeds from investments sold, matured or
 repaid:
 Bonds and preferred stocks...............   1,757,229   1,430,339   1,532,807
 Common stocks............................      20,338      12,941      11,121
 Mortgage loans on real estate............      36,550      43,495      47,460
 Real estate..............................      23,203       9,536       8,286
 Other proceeds...........................         381         189       1,407
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
Total cash from investments...............  $1,837,701  $1,496,500  $1,601,081
Capital contribution......................      40,000      15,000      --
Cash received as the result of coinsurance
 cancellations............................      --          --             114
Dividend from subsidiary..................      --          10,000      --
Cash received from ceding commissions
 associated with the sale of a division...          55         284      --
Other sources.............................      10,135      24,855       8,475
                                            ----------  ----------  ----------
Total sources of cash.....................  $2,643,753  $2,271,388  $1,967,714
</TABLE>
 
                                       24
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
            STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                             (Dollars in thousands)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                   Year Ended December 31
                                              --------------------------------
                                                 1995       1994       1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                           <C>        <C>        <C>
APPLICATIONS OF CASH
Cost of investments acquired:
 Bonds and preferred stocks.................  $2,294,195 $2,043,615 $1,846,839
 Common stocks..............................      23,284     11,228     18,832
 Mortgage loans on real estate..............     192,292    160,068     94,557
 Real estate................................      10,188     14,801      8,587
 Other invested assets......................       2,670        664        347
                                              ---------- ---------- ----------
Total investments acquired..................  $2,522,629 $2,230,376 $1,969,162
Dividends to stockholder....................      --         20,900     46,000
Cash transferred as the result of sale of
 division...................................      --         --          8,773
Issuance/(repayment) of intercompany notes
 and receivables, net.......................      48,070        365     31,478
Other applications, net.....................      27,264      3,820     15,026
                                              ---------- ---------- ----------
Total applications of cash..................  $2,597,963 $2,255,461 $2,070,439
                                              ---------- ---------- ----------
Net change in cash and short-term
 investments................................      45,790     15,927   (102,725)
Cash and short-term investments at beginning
 of year....................................      34,062     18,135    120,860
                                              ---------- ---------- ----------
Cash and short-term investments at end of
 year.......................................  $   79,852 $   34,062 $   18,135
                                              ========== ========== ==========
</TABLE>
 
 
See accompanying notes.
 
                                       25
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
               NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
1. ORGANIZATION AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES
 
Organization
 
  PFL Life Insurance Company ("the Company") is a stock life insurance company
and is a wholly-owned subsidiary of First AUSA Life Insurance Company ("First
AUSA"), which, in turn, is a wholly-owned subsidiary of AEGON USA, Inc.
("AEGON"). AEGON is a wholly-owned subsidiary of AEGON nv, a holding company
organized under the laws of The Netherlands. Effective June 1, 1995, the Com-
pany declared a dividend to transfer the common stock of its wholly-owned sub-
sidiary, Equity National Life Insurance Company ("Equity National"), to its
stockholder, First AUSA. Equity National was then merged with Life Investors
Insurance Company of America, a subsidiary of First AUSA. The financial state-
ments presented herein are prepared on the statutory accounting principles ba-
sis for the Company only; as such, the accounts of the Company's subsidiary,
Equity National, are not consolidated with those of the Company.
 
  In connection with the sale of certain affiliated companies, the Company has
assumed various blocks of business from these former affiliates through merg-
ers. In addition, the Company has canceled or entered into several coinsurance
and reinsurance agreements with affiliates and non-affiliates. The following
is a description of those transactions:
 
  .   Effective December 31, 1995, the Company canceled a coinsurance
      agreement with its parent, First AUSA. As a result of the
      cancellation, the Company transferred $825 of assets and $1,712 of
      liabilities. The difference between the assets and the liabilities,
      net of a tax effect of $302 was credited directly to surplus.
 
  .   On January 1, 1994, the Company entered into a three-year agreement
      with a non-affiliate reinsurer to reduce the reinsurance ceded by 2
      1/2% each year (primarily group health business). As a result, the
      Company transferred $3,881 in assets and $4,080 in liabilities during
      1994. The difference between the assets and liabilities of $199, plus
      a tax credit of $192, was credited directly to unassigned surplus.
      During 1995, the Company transferred $4,303 in assets and liabilities
      of $4,467. The difference between the assets and liabilities of $164,
      plus a tax credit of $255, was credited directly to unassigned
      surplus.
 
  .   During 1993, the Company sold the Oakbrook Division (primarily group
      health business). The initial transfer of risk occurred through an
      indemnity reinsurance agreement. The policies will then be assumed by
      the reinsurer by novation as state
 
                                      26
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995



     regulatory and policyholder approvals are received. In addition, the
     Company will receive from the third party administrator a ceding
     commission of one percent of the premiums collected between January 1,
     1994 and December 31, 1996. As a result of the sale, in 1993, the
     Company transferred $12,094 in assets including $8,773 in cash and
     short-term investments and $10,570 in liabilities to the assuming
     company. The difference between the assets and liabilities transferred,
     net of a tax effect of $662, was charged directly to unassigned surplus.
     The income statement for 1993 includes revenues of $53,558 and net
     income of $2,839 earned by the division prior to its sale. During 1994,
     the Company received $284 for ceding commissions; the commissions net of
     the related tax effect of $100 was credited directly to unassigned
     surplus. During 1995, the Company received $55 for ceding commissions;
     the commissions net of the related tax effect of $20 was credited
     directly to unassigned surplus.
 
  .  During 1993, the Company canceled several coinsurance agreements with
     affiliated and non-affiliated companies. As a result of the
     cancellations with affiliates, the Company received $1,006 in assets,
     and $1,051 in liabilities. As a result of the cancellations with non-
     affiliates, the Company received $6,736 in assets, including $114 in
     cash and short-term investments, and $7,131 in liabilities. The
     difference between the assets and liabilities, net of a tax effect of
     $152, was charged directly to surplus.
 
Nature of Business
 
  The Company sells individual non-participating whole life, endowment and
term contracts, as well as a broad line of single fixed and flexible premium
annuity products. In addition, the Company offers group life, universal life,
and individual and specialty health coverages. The Company is licensed in 49
states and the District of Columbia. Sales of the Company's products are pri-
marily through an independent insurance agency of the Company's Insurance Cen-
ter, the Company's agents, and financial institutions.
 
Basis of Presentation
 
  The preparation of financial statements of insurance companies requires man-
agement to make estimates and assumptions that affect amounts reported in the
financial statements and accompanying notes. Actual results could differ from
those estimates.
 
  Significant estimates and assumptions are utilized in the calculation of ag-
gregate policy reserves, policy and contract claim reserves, guaranty fund as-
sessment accruals and valuation
 
                                      27
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995



allowances on investments. It is reasonably possible that actual experience
could differ from the estimates and assumptions utilized which could have a
material impact on the financial statements.
 
  The accompanying financial statements have been prepared on the basis of ac-
counting practices prescribed or permitted by the Insurance Division, Depart-
ment of Commerce, of the State of Iowa, which practices differ in some re-
spects from generally accepted accounting principles. The more significant of
these differences are as follows: (a) bonds are generally carried at amortized
cost rather than segregating the portfolio into held-to-maturity (carried at
amortized cost), available-for-sale (carried at fair value), and trading (car-
ried at fair value) classifications; (b) acquisition costs of acquiring new
business are charged to current operations as incurred rather than deferred
and amortized over the life of the policies; (c) policy reserves on tradi-
tional life products are based on statutory mortality rates and interest which
may differ from reserves based on reasonable assumptions of expected mortali-
ty, interest, and withdrawals which include a provision for possible unfavor-
able deviation from such assumptions; (d) policy reserves on certain invest-
ment products use discounting methodologies utilizing statutory interest rates
rather than full account values; (e) reinsurance amounts are netted against
the corresponding receivable or payable rather than shown as gross amounts on
the balance sheet; (f) deferred income taxes are not provided for the differ-
ence between the financial statement and income tax bases of assets and lia-
bilities; (g) net realized gains or losses attributed to changes in the level
of interest rates in the market are deferred and amortized over the remaining
life of the bond or mortgage loan, rather than recognized as gains or losses
in the statement of operations when the sale is completed; (h) declines in the
estimated realizable value of investments are provided for through the estab-
lishment of a formula-determined statutory investment reserve (carried as a
liability) changes to which are charged directly to surplus, rather than
through recognition in the statement of operations for declines in value, when
such declines are judged to be other than temporary; (i) certain assets desig-
nated as "non-admitted assets" have been charged to surplus rather than being
reported as assets; (j) revenues for universal life and investment products
consist of premiums received rather than policy charges for the cost of insur-
ance, policy administration charges, amortization of policy initiation fees
and surrender charges assessed; (k) pension expense is recorded as amounts are
paid; (l) adjustments to federal income taxes of prior years are charged or
credited directly to unassigned surplus, rather than reported as a component
of expense in the statement of operations; (m) gains or losses on dispositions
of business are charged or credited directly to unassigned surplus rather than
being reported in the statement of operations; (n) a liability is established
for "unauthorized reinsurers" and changes in this liability are charged or
credited directly to unassigned surplus; and (o) the financial statements of
subsidiaries are not consolidated with those of the Company. The effects of
these variances have not been determined by the Company.
 
                                      28
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995


 
  The National Association of Insurance Commissioners (NAIC) currently is in
the process of recodifying statutory accounting practices, the result of which
is expected to constitute the only source of "prescribed" statutory accounting
practices. Accordingly, that project, which is expected to be completed in
1996, will likely change, to some extent, prescribed statutory accounting
practices and may result in changes to the accounting practices that the Com-
pany uses to prepare its statutory-basis financial statements.
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
  For purposes of the statements of cash flows, the Company considers all
highly liquid investments with remaining maturity of one year or less when
purchased to be cash equivalents.
 
Investments
 
  Investments in bonds (except those to which the Securities Valuation Office
of the NAIC has ascribed a value), mortgage loans on real estate and short-
term investments are reported at cost adjusted for amortization of premiums
and accrual of discounts. Amortization is computed using methods which result
in a level yield over the expected life of the security. The Company reviews
its prepayment assumptions on mortgage and other asset backed securities at
regular intervals and adjusts amortization rates prospectively when such as-
sumptions are changed due to experience and/or expected future patterns. In-
vestments in preferred stocks in good standing are reported at cost. Invest-
ments in preferred stocks not in good standing are reported at the lower of
cost or market. Common stocks of unaffiliated companies, which may include
shares of mutual funds (money market and other), are carried at market. Common
stock of the Company's insurance subsidiary is recorded at the equity in net
assets. Real estate is reported at cost less allowances for depreciation. De-
preciation is computed principally by the straight-line method. Policy loans
are reported at unpaid principal. Other invested assets consist principally of
investments in various joint ventures and are recorded at equity in underlying
net assets. Other "admitted assets" are valued, principally at cost, as re-
quired or permitted by Iowa Insurance Laws.
 
  Realized capital gains and losses are determined on the basis of specific
identification and are recorded net of related federal income taxes. The Asset
Valuation Reserve (AVR) is established by the Company to provide for antici-
pated losses in the event of default by issuers of certain invested assets.
These amounts are determined using a formula prescribed by the NAIC and are
reported as a liability. The formula for the AVR provides for a corresponding
adjustment for realized gains and losses, net of amounts attributed to changes
in the general level of interest rates.
 
                                      29
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995



Under a formula prescribed by the NAIC, the Company defers, in the Interest
Maintenance Reserve (IMR), the portion of realized gains and losses on sales
of fixed income investments, principally bonds and mortgage loans, attribut-
able to changes in the general level of interest rates and amortizes those de-
ferrals over the remaining period to maturity of the security.
 
  Interest income is recognized on an accrual basis. The Company does not ac-
crue income on bonds in default, mortgage loans on real estate in default
and/or foreclosure or which are delinquent more than twelve months, or real
estate where rent is in arrears for more than three months. Further, income is
not accrued when collection is uncertain. At December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993,
the Company excluded investment income due and accrued of $2,272, $4,622 and
$1,876, respectively, with respect to such practices.
 
  The Company entered into an interest-rate cap agreement on Five Year Con-
stant Maturities Treasury futures to hedge the exposure of increasing interest
rates. The cash flows from the interest rate cap will help offset losses that
might occur from disintermediation resulting from a rise in interest rates.
The Company paid a one-time premium to receive the difference between the ref-
erence rate and the strike rate after a two-year delay. The cost is included
in interest expense ratably during the life of the agreement. Income received
as a result of the cap agreement will be recognized in investment income as
earned. Unamortized cost of the agreements is included in other assets.
 
Aggregate Policy Reserves
 
  Life, annuity and accident and health benefit reserves are developed by ac-
tuarial methods and are determined based on published tables using statutorily
specified interest rates and valuation methods that will provide, in the ag-
gregate, reserves that are greater than or equal to the minimum required by
law.
 
  The aggregate policy reserves for life insurance policies are based princi-
pally upon the 1941, 1958, and 1980 Commissioners' Standard Ordinary Mortality
and American Experience Mortality Tables. The reserves are calculated using
interest rates ranging from 2.00 to 6.00 percent and are computed principally
on the Net Level Valuation and the Commissioners' Reserve Valuation Methods.
Reserves for universal life policies are based on account balances adjusted
for the Commissioners' Reserve Valuation Method.
 
                                      30
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995


 
  Deferred annuity reserves are calculated according to the Commissioners' An-
nuity Reserve Valuation Method including excess interest reserves to cover
situations where the future interest guarantees plus the decrease in surrender
charges are in excess of the maximum valuation rates of interest. Reserves for
immediate annuities and supplementary contracts with and without life contin-
gencies are equal to the present value of future payments assuming interest
rates ranging from 2.50 to 11.25 percent and mortality rates, where appropri-
ate, from a variety of tables.
 
  Accident and health policy reserves are equal to the greater of the gross
unearned premiums or any required midterminal reserves plus net unearned pre-
miums and the present value of amounts not yet due on both reported and unre-
ported claims.
 
Policy and Contract Claim Reserves
 
  Claim reserves represent the estimated accrued liability for claims reported
to the Company and claims incurred but not yet reported through the statement
date. These reserves are estimated using either individual case-basis valua-
tions or statistical analysis techniques. These estimates are subject to the
effects of trends in claim severity and frequency. The estimates are continu-
ally reviewed and adjusted as necessary as experience develops or new informa-
tion becomes available.
 
Separate Account
 
  Assets held in trust for purchases of variable annuity contracts and the
Company's corresponding obligation to the contract owners are shown separately
in the balance sheets. The assets in the separate account are valued at mar-
ket. Income and gains and losses with respect to the assets in the separate
account accrue to the benefit of the policyholders. The Company received vari-
able contract premiums of $133,386, $308,305 and $439,586 in 1995, 1994 and
1993, respectively. All variable account contracts are subject to discretion-
ary withdrawal by the policyholder at the market value of the underlying as-
sets less the current surrender charge.
 
Reclassifications
 
  Certain reclassifications have been made to the 1994 and 1993 financial
statements to conform to the 1995 presentation.
 
                                      31
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995


 
2. FAIR VALUES OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS
 
  Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 107, "Disclosures about Fair
Value of Financial Instruments", requires disclosure of fair value information
about financial instruments, whether or not recognized in the statutory-basis
balance sheet, for which it is practicable to estimate that value. SFAS No.
119, "Disclosures about Derivative Financial Instruments and Fair Value of Fi-
nancial Instruments" requires additional disclosure about derivatives. In
cases where quoted market prices are not available, fair values are based on
estimates using present value or other valuation techniques. Those techniques
are significantly affected by the assumptions used, including the discount
rate and estimates of future cash flows. In that regard, the derived fair
value estimates cannot be substantiated by comparisons to independent markets
and, in many cases, could not be realized in immediate settlement of the in-
strument. Statement of Financial Accounting Standards No. 107 and No. 119 ex-
clude certain financial instruments and all nonfinancial instruments from
their disclosure requirements and allow companies to forego the disclosures
when those estimates can only be made at excessive cost. Accordingly, the ag-
gregate fair value amounts presented do not represent the underlying value of
the Company.
 
  The following methods and assumptions were used by the Company in estimating
its fair value disclosures for financial instruments:
 
  Cash and cash equivalents, short-term investments: The carrying amounts
  reported in the balance sheet for these instruments approximate their fair
  values.
 
  Investment securities: Fair values for fixed maturity securities
  (including redeemable preferred stocks) are based on quoted market prices,
  where available. For fixed maturity securities not actively traded, fair
  values are estimated using values obtained from independent pricing
  services or, in the case of private placements, are estimated by
  discounting expected future cash flows using a current market rate
  applicable to the yield, credit quality, and maturity of the investments.
  The fair values for equity securities other than insurance subsidiaries
  are based on quoted market prices and are recognized in the balance sheet.
  Fair value for the Company's insurance subsidiary is the statutory net
  book value of that subsidiary.
 
  Mortgage loans and policy loans: The fair values for mortgage loans are
  estimated utilizing discounted cash flow analyses, using interest rates
  reflective of current market conditions and the risk characteristics of
  the loans. The fair value of policy loans are assumed to equal their
  carrying value.
 
                                      32
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995


 
  Investment contracts: Fair values for the Company's liabilities under
  investment-type insurance contracts are estimated using discounted cash
  flow calculations, based on interest rates currently being offered for
  similar contracts with maturities consistent with those remaining for the
  contracts being valued.
 
  Interest rate cap: Estimated fair value of the interest rate cap is based
  upon the latest quoted market price.
 
  Fair values for the Company's insurance contracts other than investment con-
tracts are not required to be disclosed. However, the fair values of liabili-
ties under all insurance contracts are taken into consideration in the
Company's overall management of interest rate risk, which minimizes exposure
to changing interest rates through the matching of investment maturities with
amounts due under insurance contracts.
 
  The following sets forth a comparison of the fair values and carrying values
of the Company's financial instruments subject to the provisions of Statement
of Financial Accounting Standards No. 107 and No. 119:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 December 31
                                 -------------------------------------------
                                         1995                  1994
                                 --------------------- ---------------------
                                  Carrying              Carrying
                                   Value    Fair Value   Value    Fair Value
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                              <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
ADMITTED ASSETS
Bonds                            $4,613,334 $4,824,635 $4,094,407 $3,952,849
Preferred stocks                      9,336     12,275     12,667     12,905
Common stocks                        24,866     24,866     16,754     16,754
Affiliated common and preferred
  stock                               6,794      6,794     26,530     26,530
Mortgage loans on real estate       680,414    714,399    527,410    499,350
Policy loans                         52,675     52,675     51,798     51,798
Cash and short-term investments      79,852     79,852     34,062     34,062
Interest rate cap                     7,971      7,250     --         --
Separate account assets           1,418,157  1,418,157  1,120,391  1,120,391
LIABILITIES
Investment contract liabilities   4,323,188  4,310,505  3,779,199  3,468,226
Separate account annuities        1,417,842  1,417,842  1,119,002  1,119,002
</TABLE>
 
                                      33
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995


 
3. INVESTMENTS
 
  The carrying value and estimated fair value of investments in debt securi-
ties were as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 Gross      Gross    Estimated
                                     Carrying  Unrealized Unrealized    Fair
                                      Value      Gains      Losses     Value
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                 <C>        <C>        <C>        <C>
DECEMBER 31, 1995
Bonds:
 United States Government and
  agencies......................... $  117,054  $  5,808   $    135  $  122,727
 State, municipal and other
  government.......................     46,236     3,109          2      49,343
 Public utilities..................    156,342     9,578      1,092     164,828
 Industrial and miscellaneous......  1,781,149   112,074      7,146   1,886,077
 Mortgage-backed securities........  2,512,553    93,420      4,313   2,601,660
                                    ----------  --------   --------  ----------
                                     4,613,334   223,989     12,688   4,824,635
 Preferred stocks..................      9,336     3,348        409      12,275
                                    ----------  --------   --------  ----------
                                    $4,622,670  $227,337   $ 13,097  $4,836,910
                                    ==========  ========   ========  ==========
DECEMBER 31, 1994
Bonds:
 United States Government and
  agencies......................... $  104,798  $    395   $  1,958  $  103,235
 State, municipal and other
  government.......................     51,650       390      2,739      49,301
 Public utilities..................    164,975     1,860      5,710     161,125
 Industrial and miscellaneous......  1,891,899    27,082     69,137   1,849,844
 Mortgage-backed securities........  1,881,085     9,074    100,815   1,789,344
                                    ----------  --------   --------  ----------
                                     4,094,407    38,801    180,359   3,952,849
 Preferred stocks..................     12,667       778        540      12,905
                                    ----------  --------   --------  ----------
                                    $4,107,074  $ 39,579   $180,899  $3,965,754
                                    ==========  ========   ========  ==========
</TABLE>
 
  The carrying value and estimated fair value of bonds at December 31, 1995,
by contractual maturity, are shown below. Expected maturities may differ from
contractual maturities because borrowers may have the right to call or prepay
obligations with or without call or prepayment penalties.
 
                                      34
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                       Estimated
                                                             Carrying     Fair
                                                              Value      Value
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                         <C>        <C>
 Due in one year or less..................................  $  104,697 $  105,157
 Due after one year through five years....................     858,586    889,832
 Due after five years through ten years...................     934,627    995,403
 Due after ten years......................................     202,871    232,583
                                                            ---------- ----------
                                                             2,100,781  2,222,975
  Mortgage and other asset-backed securities..............   2,512,553  2,601,660
                                                            ---------- ----------
                                                            $4,613,334 $4,824,635
                                                            ========== ==========
</TABLE>
 
  A detail of net investment income is presented below:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       Year ended December 31
                                                     --------------------------
                                                       1995     1994     1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                  <C>      <C>      <C>
 Interest on bonds and notes........................ $342,182 $294,145 $286,013
 Dividends on equity investments....................    1,822   12,091    3,990
 Interest on mortgage loans.........................   52,702   42,385   37,587
 Rental income on real estate.......................   10,443    9,360    8,753
 Interest on policy loans...........................    3,112    3,182    2,943
 Other investment income............................    1,803      282      555
                                                     -------- -------- --------
 Gross investment income............................  412,064  361,445  339,841
 Investment expenses................................   19,379   17,565   17,448
                                                     -------- -------- --------
 Net investment income.............................. $392,685 $343,880 $322,393
                                                     ======== ======== ========
</TABLE>
 
  Proceeds from sales and maturities of debt securities and related gross re-
alized gains and losses were as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                  Year ended December 31
                                             ----------------------------------
                                                1995        1994        1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                          <C>         <C>         <C>
 Proceeds................................... $1,757,229  $1,430,339  $1,532,807
                                             ==========  ==========  ==========
 Gross realized gains....................... $   19,721  $   15,411  $   42,020
 Gross realized losses......................     34,399      33,044       9,071
                                             ----------  ----------  ----------
 Net realized gains (losses)................ $  (14,678) $  (17,633) $   32,949
                                             ==========  ==========  ==========
</TABLE>
 
  At December 31, 1995, investments with an aggregate carrying value of
$5,404,474 were on deposit with regulatory authorities or were restrictively
held in bank custodial accounts for the benefit of such regulatory authorities
as required by statute.
 
                                      35
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
  Realized investment gains (losses) and changes in unrealized gains (losses)
for investments are summarized below:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            Realized Year ended December 31
                                            -----------------------------------
                                               1995        1994        1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                         <C>         <C>          <C>
Debt securities...........................  $  (14,678) $   (17,633) $  32,949
Short-term investments....................          24         (309)       679
Equity securities.........................         504        1,322       (348)
Mortgage loans on real estate.............      (1,053)      (2,186)       199
Real estate...............................      (1,908)      (2,858)       (41)
Other invested assets.....................        (970)          14         33
                                            ----------  -----------  ---------
                                               (18,081)     (21,650)    33,471
Tax effect................................       7,878        7,236    (12,519)
Transfer to interest maintenance reserve..      (7,891)      10,790    (21,403)
                                            ----------  -----------  ---------
Net realized losses.......................  $  (18,096) $    (3,624) $    (451)
                                            ==========  ===========  =========
<CAPTION>
                                                  Change in Unrealized
                                                 Year ended December 31
                                            -----------------------------------
                                               1995        1994        1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                         <C>         <C>          <C>
Debt securities...........................  $  355,560  $  (322,346) $  28,210
Equity securities.........................     (16,379)     (23,202)     3,449
                                            ----------  -----------  ---------
Change in unrealized appreciation
 (depreciation)...........................  $  339,181  $  (345,548) $  31,659
                                            ==========  ===========  =========
</TABLE>
 
  Gross unrealized gains and gross unrealized losses on equity securities were
as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                             December 31
                                                       ------------------------
                                                        1995     1994    1993
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                    <C>      <C>     <C>
Unrealized gains...................................... $ 6,833  $20,244 $42,045
Unrealized losses.....................................   8,895    5,927   4,526
                                                       -------  ------- -------
Net unrealized gains (losses)......................... $(2,062) $14,317 $37,519
                                                       =======  ======= =======
</TABLE>
 
  During 1995, the Company issued mortgage loans with interest rates ranging
from 7.41% to 9.86%. The maximum percentage of any one mortgage loan to the
value of the underlying real estate at origination was 85%. Mortgage loans
with a carrying value of $12,782 were non-income producing for the previous
twelve months. Accrued interest of $1,957 related to these mortgage
 
                                      36
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
loans was excluded from investment income. The Company requires all mortgage
loans to carry fire insurance equal to the value of the underlying property.
 
  During 1995, 1994 and 1993, mortgage loans of $1,644, $799 and $101, respec-
tively, were foreclosed and transferred to real estate. At December 31, 1995
and 1994, the Company held a mortgage loan loss reserve in the asset valuation
reserve of $6,168 and $5,204, respectively. At December 31, 1995, the mortgage
loan portfolio is diversified by geographic region and specific collateral
property type as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 GEOGRAPHIC DISTRIBUTION
- --------------------------------
 <S>                       <C>
 South Atlantic..........  26.2%
 Mountain................  12.4
 W. South Central........  14.3
 Pacific.................  16.7
 E. North Central........  13.0
 E. South Central........   5.3
 W. North Central........   5.5
 Middle Atlantic.........   3.1
 New England.............   3.5
</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
PROPERTY TYPE DISTRIBUTION
- ---------------------------------
<S>                         <C>
Retail....................  31.2%
Apartment.................  20.4
Office....................  29.1
Industrial................   3.8
Hotel/Motel...............   1.4
Other.....................  14.1
</TABLE>
 
  At December 31, 1995, the Company had the following investments (excluding
U.S. Government guaranteed or insured issues) which individually represented
more than ten percent of capital and surplus and the asset valuation reserve:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
      Description of Security or Issuer                           Carrying Value
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
      <S>                                                         <C>
      Bonds:
       Standard Credit Card Trust...............................     $84,607
       G E Capital..............................................      48,290
       Green Tree Financial Corporation.........................      44,128
</TABLE>
 
4. REINSURANCE
 
  The Company reinsures portions of risk on certain insurance policies which
exceed its established limits, thereby providing a greater diversification of
risk and minimizing exposure on larger risks. The Company remains contingently
liable with respect to any insurance ceded, and this would become an actual
liability in the event that the assuming insurance company became unable to
meet its obligation under the reinsurance treaty.
 
                                      37
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
  Reinsurance assumption and cession treaties are transacted primarily with
affiliates. Premiums earned reflect the following reinsurance assumed and
ceded amounts:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                1995        1994        1993
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                          <C>         <C>         <C>
Direct premiums............................. $1,591,531  $1,857,446  $1,472,409
Reinsurance assumed.........................      2,356       1,832       3,040
Reinsurance ceded...........................   (324,993)   (412,029)   (369,203)
                                             ----------  ----------  ----------
Net premiums earned......................... $1,268,894  $1,447,249  $1,106,246
                                             ==========  ==========  ==========
</TABLE>
 
  The Company received reinsurance recoveries in the amount of $167,287,
$148,414 and $97,409 during 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively. At December 31,
1995 and 1994, estimated amounts recoverable from reinsurers that have been
deducted from policy and contract claim reserves totaled $65,503 and $62,882,
respectively. The aggregate reserves for policies and contracts were reduced
for reserve credits for reinsurance ceded at December 31, 1995 and 1994 of
$2,920,034 and $2,977,954, respectively.
 
  At December 31, 1995, amounts recoverable from unauthorized reinsurers of
$70,516 (1994-- $43,055) and reserve credits for reinsurance ceded of $48,992
(1994 -- $59,131) were associated with a single reinsurer and its affiliates.
The Company holds collateral under these reinsurance agreements in the form of
trust agreements totaling $110,714 at December 31, 1995 that can be drawn on
for amounts that remain unpaid for more than 120 days.
 
5. INCOME TAXES
 
  For federal income tax purposes, the Company joins in a consolidated tax re-
turn filing with certain affiliated companies. Under the terms of a tax-shar-
ing agreement between the Company and its affiliates, the Company computes
federal income tax expense as if it were filing a separate income tax return,
except that tax credits and net operating loss carryforwards are determined on
the basis of the consolidated group. Additionally, the alternative minimum tax
is computed for the consolidated group and the resulting tax, if any, is allo-
cated back to the separate companies on the basis of the separate companies'
alternative minimum taxable income.
 
                                      38
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
  Federal income tax expense differs from the amount computed by applying the
statutory federal income tax rate to gain from operations before taxes and re-
alized capital gains (losses) for the following reasons:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                      Year ended December 31
                                                      -------------------------
                                                       1995     1994     1993
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                   <C>      <C>      <C>
 Computed tax at federal statutory rate (35%)........ $27,835  $24,106  $29,698
 Tax reserve adjustment..............................   2,405    1,150    1,433
 Excess tax depreciation.............................    (365)    (406)    (248)
 Deferred acquisition costs--tax basis...............   4,581    7,378    5,200
 Prior year over accrual.............................    (306)    (644)    (330)
 Dividend received deduction.........................     (56)  (3,513)  (1,202)
 Charitable contribution.............................   --      (3,935)   --
 Other items -- net..................................    (759)    (278)  (2,884)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
 Federal income tax expense.......................... $33,335  $23,858  $31,667
                                                      =======  =======  =======
</TABLE>
 
  Prior to 1984, as provided for under the Life Insurance Company Tax Act of
1959, a portion of statutory income was not subject to current taxation but
was accumulated for income tax purposes in a memorandum account referred to as
the policyholders' surplus account. No federal income taxes have been provided
for in the financial statements on income deferred in the policyholders' sur-
plus account ($20,387 at December 31, 1995). To the extent dividends are paid
from the amount accumulated in the policyholders' surplus account, net earn-
ings would be reduced by the amount of tax required to be paid. Should the en-
tire amount in the policyholders' surplus account become taxable, the tax
thereon computed at current rates would amount to approximately $7,135.
 
  The Company's federal income tax returns have been examined and closing
agreements have been executed with the Internal Revenue Service through 1986.
During 1993, there was a $452 prior period adjustment to the tax accrual. An
examination is underway for years 1987 through 1992.
 
6. POLICY AND CONTRACT ATTRIBUTES
 
  Participating life insurance policies are issued by the Company which enti-
tle policyholders to a share in the earnings of the participating policies,
provided that a dividend distribution, which is determined annually based on
mortality and persistency experience of the participating policies, is autho-
rized by the Company. Participating insurance constituted approximately 1.2%
of ordinary life insurance in force at December 31, 1995 and 1994.
 
                                      39
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
  A portion of the Company's policy reserves and other policyholders' funds
(including separate account liabilities) relate to liabilities established on
a variety of the Company's products that are not subject to significant mor-
tality or morbidity risk; however, there may be certain restrictions placed
upon the amount of funds that can be withdrawn without penalty. The amount of
reserves on these products, by withdrawal characteristics are summarized as
follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       December 31
                                          -------------------------------------
                                                 1995               1994
                                          ------------------ ------------------
                                                     Percent            Percent
                                                       of                 of
                                            Amount    Total    Amount    Total
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                       <C>        <C>     <C>        <C>
Subject to discretionary withdrawal with
 market value adjustment................. $      699   -- %  $   29,625   -- %
Subject to discretionary withdrawal at
 book value less surrender charge........    733,796     8%     521,631     7%
Subject to discretionary withdrawal at
 market value............................  1,390,156    16%   1,090,032    14%
Subject to discretionary withdrawal at
 book value (minimal or no charges or
 adjustments)............................  6,395,719    74%   6,116,461    78%
Not subject to discretionary withdrawal
 provision...............................    139,330     2%     109,542     1%
                                          ----------   ---   ----------   ---
                                           8,659,700   100%   7,867,291   100%
Less reinsurance ceded...................  2,866,160          2,931,320
                                          ----------         ----------
Total policy reserves on annuities and
 deposit fund liabilities................ $5,793,540         $4,935,971
                                          ==========         ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                      40
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
  Reserves on the Company's traditional life products are computed using mean
reserving methodologies. These methodologies result in the establishment of
assets for the amount of the net valuation premiums that are anticipated to be
received between the policy's paid-through date to the policy's next anniver-
sary date. At December 31, 1995 and 1994, these assets (which are reported as
premiums deferred and uncollected) and the amounts of the related gross premi-
ums and loadings, are as follows:
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                       Gross   Loading    Net
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                   <C>      <C>      <C>
DECEMBER 31, 1995
Life and annuity:
 Ordinary direct first year business................. $ 3,151  $ 2,223  $   928
 Ordinary direct renewal business....................  24,250    7,792   16,458
 Group life direct business..........................   1,537      779      758
 Reinsurance ceded...................................  (1,362)    (141)  (1,221)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
                                                       27,576   10,653   16,923
Accident and health:
 Direct..............................................   1,296    --       1,296
 Reinsurance ceded...................................  (1,193)   --      (1,193)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
 Total accident and health...........................     103    --         103
                                                      -------  -------  -------
                                                      $27,679  $10,653  $17,026
                                                      =======  =======  =======
DECEMBER 31, 1994
Life and annuity:
 Ordinary direct first year business................. $ 3,940  $ 2,865  $ 1,075
 Ordinary direct renewal business....................  26,155    8,979   17,176
 Group life direct business..........................   1,386      522      864
 Reinsurance ceded...................................    (943)     (67)    (876)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
                                                       30,538   12,299   18,239
Accident and health:
 Direct..............................................   2,186    --       2,186
 Reinsurance ceded...................................  (2,039)   --      (2,039)
                                                      -------  -------  -------
 Total accident and health...........................     147    --         147
                                                      -------  -------  -------
                                                      $30,685  $12,299  $18,386
                                                      =======  =======  =======
</TABLE>
 
  At December 31, 1995 and 1994, the Company had insurance in force aggregat-
ing $87,010 and $92,680, respectively, in which the gross premiums are less
than the net premiums required
 
                                      41
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
by the standard valuation standards established by the Insurance Division, De-
partment of Commerce, of the State of Iowa. The Company established policy re-
serves of $1,417 and $1,616 to cover these deficiencies at December 31, 1995
and 1994, respectively.
 
  In 1994, the NAIC enacted a guideline to clarify reserving methodologies for
contracts that require immediate payment of claims upon proof of death of the
insured. Companies were allowed to grade the effects of the change in reserv-
ing methodologies over five years. A direct charge to surplus of $501 was made
for the year ended December 31, 1995, related to the change in reserve method-
ology.
 
7. DIVIDEND RESTRICTIONS
 
  Generally, an insurance company's ability to pay dividends is limited to the
amount that their net assets, as determined in accordance with statutory ac-
counting practices, exceed minimum statutory capital requirements. However,
payment of such amounts as dividends may be subject to approval by regulatory
authorities.
 
  The Company paid dividends to its parent of $0, $20,900 and $46,000 in 1995,
1994 and 1993, respectively.
 
8. RETIREMENT AND COMPENSATION PLANS
 
  The Company's employees participate in a qualified benefit pension plan
sponsored by AEGON. The Company has no legal obligation for the plan. The Com-
pany recognizes pension expense equal to its allocation from AEGON. The pen-
sion expense is allocated among the participating companies based on the FASB
No. 87 expense as a percent of salaries. The benefits are based on years of
service and the employee's compensation during the highest five consecutive
years of employment. Pension expense aggregated $942, $966 and $782 for the
years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively. The plan is sub-
ject to the reporting and disclosure requirements of the Employee Retirement
and Income Security Act of 1974.
 
  The Company's employees also participate in a contributory defined contribu-
tion plan sponsored by AEGON which is qualified under Section 401(k) of the
Internal Revenue Service Code. Employees of the Company who customarily work
at least 1,000 hours during each calendar year and meet the other eligibility
requirements, are participants of the plan. Participants may
 
                                      42
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
elect to contribute up to fifteen percent of their salary to the plan. The
Company will match an amount up to three percent of the participant's salary.
Participants may direct all of their contributions and plan balances to be in-
vested in a variety of investment options. The plan is subject to the report-
ing and disclosure requirements of the Employee Retirement and Income Security
Act of 1974. Expense related to this plan was $465, $411 and $386 for the
years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, respectively.
 
  AEGON sponsors supplemental retirement plans to provide the Company's senior
management with benefits in excess of normal pension benefits. The plans are
noncontributory and benefits are based on years of service and the employee's
compensation level. The plans are unfunded and nonqualified under the Internal
Revenue Service Code. In addition, AEGON has established incentive deferred
compensation plans for certain key employees of the Company. AEGON also spon-
sors an employee stock option plan for individuals employed at least three
years and a stock purchase plan for its producers, with the participating af-
filiated companies establishing their own eligibility criteria, producer con-
tribution limits and company matching formula. These plans have been accrued
or funded as deemed appropriate by management of AEGON and the Company.
 
  In addition to pension benefits, the Company participates in plans sponsored
by AEGON that provide postretirement medical, dental and life insurance bene-
fits to employees meeting certain eligibility requirements. Portions of the
medical and dental plans are contributory. The expenses of the postretirement
plans calculated on the pay-as-you-go basis are charged to affiliates in ac-
cordance with an intercompany cost sharing arrangement. The Company expensed
$164, $169 and $0 for the years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, re-
spectively.
 
9. RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS
 
  The Company receives data processing, investment advisory and management,
marketing and administration services from certain affiliates. During 1995,
1994 and 1993, the Company paid $14,214, $11,820 and $11,689, respectively,
for these services, which approximates their costs to the affiliates.
 
  Payable to affiliates and intercompany borrowings bear interest at the thir-
ty-day commercial paper rate of 5.64% at December 31, 1995. During 1995, 1994
and 1993, the Company paid net interest of $794, $363 and $283, respectively,
to affiliates.
 
                                      43
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
  During 1995 and 1994, the Company received capital contributions of $40,000
and $15,000, respectively, in cash from its parent and during 1994 received a
dividend of $10,000 from its subsidiary, Equity National, which was included
in net investment income.
 
  During 1995, the Company sold real estate with a book value of approximately
$13,270 to an affiliated entity in exchange for a short-term note receivable.
No gain was recognized on this sale. This note bears interest at 5.65% and ma-
tures on March 28, 1996.
 
  During the year ended December 31, 1995, the Company restructured demand
notes and accrued interest of $13,250 and $745, respectively, related to an
affiliate. The Company received 9,750 shares of preferred stock from the af-
filiate for satisfaction of debt. The Company realized a loss of $8,695 re-
lated to this transaction. At December 31, 1995, the preferred stock related
to this affiliate was deemed to have no value and an unrealized loss of $4,555
was recognized.
 
10. COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES
 
  The Company is a party to legal proceedings incidental to its business. Al-
though such litigation sometimes includes substantial demands for compensatory
and punitive damages, in addition to contract liability, it is management's
opinion, after consultation with counsel and a review of available facts, that
damages arising from such demands will not be material to the Company's finan-
cial position.
 
  The Company is subject to insurance guaranty laws in the states in which it
writes business. These laws provide for assessments against insurance compa-
nies for the benefit of policyholders and claimants in the event of insolvency
of other insurance companies. Assessments are charged to operations when re-
ceived by the Company except where right of offset against other taxes paid is
allowed by law; amounts available for future offsets are recorded as an asset
on the Company's balance sheet. Potential future obligations for unknown in-
solvencies are not determinable by the Company. The future obligation has been
based on the most recent information available from the National Organization
of Life and Health Insurance Guaranty Associations (NOLHGA). The Company has
established a reserve of $21,747 and $18,344 and an offsetting premium tax
benefit of $9,457 and $10,556 at December 31, 1995 and 1994, respectively, for
its estimated share of future guaranty fund assessments related to several ma-
jor insurer insolvencies. During 1994, $3,444 was charged to surplus as prior
period adjustments to provide for this net reserve plus certain assessments
paid that related to several major insurer insolvencies prior to 1992. The
guaranty fund expense was $5,859, $4,054 and $0 for December 31, 1995, 1994
and 1993, respectively.
 
                                      44
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS -- STATUTORY BASIS (CONTINUED)
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
11. SUBSEQUENT EVENT
 
  Effective January 10, 1996, the Company announced it had signed a Memorandum
of Understanding with United Insurance Companies, Inc. to sell its North Rich-
land Hills, Texas health administrative operations known as The Insurance Cen-
ter. The transaction, which is subject to approval by the Board of Directors
of both companies, will result in the transfer of all employees and office fa-
cilities to United Insurance Companies, Inc. All inforce business will con-
tinue to be shared by United Insurance Companies, Inc. and the Company and its
affiliates through the existing coinsurance agreements. After a short transi-
tion period, all new business produced by United Group Association, an inde-
pendent insurance agency, will be written by the insurance subsidiaries of
United Insurance Companies, Inc. and will not be shared with the Company and
its affiliates through coinsurance arrangements. The transaction is expected
to be completed on or about April 1, 1996.
 
                                      45
<PAGE>
 
                          PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
      SUMMARY OF INVESTMENTS -- OTHER THAN INVESTMENTS IN RELATED PARTIES
                            (Dollars in thousands)
 
                               December 31, 1995
 
                                  SCHEDULE I
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              Amount at Which
                                                   Market       Shown in the
Type of Investment                    Cost /(1)/   Value     Balance Sheet /(2)/
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                   <C>        <C>        <C>
FIXED MATURITIES
Bonds:
 United States Government and
  government agencies and
  authorities.......................  $1,616,094 $1,674,088      $1,613,124
 States, municipalities and
  political subdivisions............       3,975      4,576           3,975
 Foreign governments................      43,053     45,128          42,261
 Public utilities...................     158,821    165,107         156,619
 All other corporate bonds..........   2,809,545  2,935,736       2,797,355
Redeemable preferred stock..........       9,336     12,275           9,336
                                      ---------- ----------      ----------
Total fixed maturities..............   4,640,824  4,836,910       4,622,670
EQUITY SECURITIES
Common stocks:
 Banks, trust and insurance.........       5,114      6,221           6,221
 Industrial, miscellaneous and all
  other.............................      13,947     18,645          18,645
                                      ---------- ----------      ----------
Total equity securities.............      19,061     24,866          24,866
Mortgage loans on real estate.......     680,414                    680,414
Real estate.........................      60,856                     60,856
Real estate acquired in satisfaction
 of debt............................       2,648                      2,648
Policy loans........................      52,675                     52,675
Other long-term investments.........       5,586                      5,586
Cash and short-term investments.....      79,852                     79,852
                                      ----------                 ----------
Total investments...................  $5,541,916                 $5,529,567
                                      ==========                 ==========
</TABLE>
 
/1/ Original cost of equity securities and, as to fixed maturities, original
    cost reduced by repayments and adjusted for amortization of premiums or
    accrual of discounts.
 
/2/ Amount differs from cost as certain bonds have been adjusted to reflect
    other than temporary decline in value charged to surplus, as prescribed by
    the NAIC.
 
                                      46
<PAGE>
 
 
 
 
                       This page intentionally left blank
 
                                       47
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
                      SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION
                             (Dollars in thousands)
 
                                  SCHEDULE III
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                            Future Policy            Policy and
                                            Benefits and   Unearned   Contract
                                              Expenses     Premiums  Liabilities
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                         <C>           <C>        <C>
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995
Individual life............................  $  594,274   $    --    $    6,066
Individual health..........................      24,225        7,768     11,863
Group life and health......................      67,994       16,662     58,813
Annuity....................................   4,220,274       --         --
                                             ----------   ---------- ----------
                                             $4,906,767   $   24,430 $   76,742
                                             ==========   ========== ==========
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1994
Individual life............................  $  544,087   $    --    $    7,298
Individual health..........................      16,649        6,487      8,643
Group life and health......................      60,207       17,680     57,959
Annuity....................................   3,693,388       --         --
                                             ----------   ---------- ----------
                                             $4,314,331   $   24,167 $   73,900
                                             ==========   ========== ==========
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1993
Individual life............................  $  402,985   $    --    $    8,424
Individual health..........................      11,714        4,623      6,494
Group life and health......................     108,355       17,783     55,265
Annuity....................................   3,124,527       --         --
                                             ----------   ---------- ----------
                                             $3,647,581   $   22,406 $   70,183
                                             ==========   ========== ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                       48
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
                      SUPPLEMENTARY INSURANCE INFORMATION
                             (Dollars in thousands)
 
                            SCHEDULE III (continued)
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                  Net            Benefits, Claims           Other
 Premium       Investment           Losses and            Operating         Premiums
 Revenue         Income         Settlement Expenses        Expenses         Written
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>            <C>              <C>                       <C>              <C>
$  111,918     $   49,929           $   97,065            $   37,933       $    --
    47,692          4,091               25,793                26,033           47,690
   187,832         11,665              106,065               139,640          184,545
   921,452        327,000            1,116,768               114,164          921,448
- ----------     ----------           ----------            ----------       ----------
$1,268,894     $  392,685           $1,345,691            $  317,770       $1,153,683
==========     ==========           ==========            ==========       ==========
$  146,328     $   43,025           $  124,736            $   42,309       $    --
    38,811          3,983               22,323                22,707           38,797
   194,704         10,531              108,400               143,645          192,034
 1,067,406        286,341            1,036,313               319,328        1,067,404
- ----------     ----------           ----------            ----------       ----------
$1,447,249     $  343,880           $1,291,772            $  527,989       $1,298,235
==========     ==========           ==========            ==========       ==========
$   95,716     $   36,471           $   71,638            $   56,462       $    --
    28,388          1,024               16,663                15,987           28,434
   241,356         13,465              135,764               148,254          239,575
   740,786        271,433              506,949               457,328          740,900
- ----------     ----------           ----------            ----------       ----------
$1,106,246     $  322,393           $  731,014            $  678,031       $1,008,909
==========     ==========           ==========            ==========       ==========
</TABLE>
 
                                       49
<PAGE>
 
                           PFL LIFE INSURANCE COMPANY
 
                                  REINSURANCE
                             (Dollars in Thousands)
 
                                  SCHEDULE IV
 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                 Assumed             Percentage
                                      Ceded to    From               of Amount
                             Gross      Other     Other      Net      Assumed
                             Amount   Companies Companies   Amount     to Net
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                        <C>        <C>       <C>       <C>        <C>
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
 1995
Life insurance in force..  $4,594,434 $468,811  $ 22,936  $4,148,559     .6%
                           ========== ========  ========  ==========    ====
Premiums:
 Individual life.........  $  113,934 $  3,841  $  1,825  $  111,918    1.6%
 Individual health.......      60,309   12,617     --         47,692     --
 Group life and health...     408,097  220,265     --        187,832     --
 Annuity.................   1,009,191   88,270       531     921,452    .05%
                           ---------- --------  --------  ----------    ----
                           $1,591,531 $324,993  $  2,356  $1,268,894     .2%
                           ========== ========  ========  ==========    ====
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
 1994
Life insurance in force..  $4,713,817 $468,811  $112,054  $4,357,060    2.6%
                           ========== ========  ========  ==========    ====
Premiums:
 Individual life.........  $  148,702 $  3,639  $  1,265  $  146,328     .9%
 Individual health.......      50,303   11,492     --         38,811     --
 Group life and health...     412,200  217,496     --        194,704     --
 Annuity.................   1,246,241  179,402       567   1,067,406    .05%
                           ---------- --------  --------  ----------    ----
                           $1,857,446 $412,029  $  1,832  $1,447,249     .1%
                           ========== ========  ========  ==========    ====
YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31,
 1993
Life insurance in force..  $4,773,533 $387,843  $192,203  $4,577,893    4.2%
                           ========== ========  ========  ==========    ====
Premiums:
 Individual life.........  $   95,982 $  2,640  $  2,373  $   95,715    2.5%
 Individual health.......      37,709    9,321     --         28,388     --
 Group life and health...     401,906  160,550     --        241,356     --
 Annuity.................     936,812  196,692       667     740,787     .1%
                           ---------- --------  --------  ----------    ----
                           $1,472,409 $369,203  $  3,040  $1,106,246     .3%
                           ========== ========  ========  ==========    ====
</TABLE>
 
                                       50
<PAGE>
 
                      Statement of Additional Information

                   The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust

     This Statement of Additional Information is not a prospectus and should be
read in conjunction with the Prospectus dated May 1, 1996, as supplemented from
time to time, which is incorporated herein by reference, for Wright Near Term
Bond Portfolio, Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio, Wright Selected Blue Chip
Portfolio, and Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio, each a series of The
Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust (the "Trust"). The Prospectus may be
obtained from Wright Investors' Service Distributors, Inc., 1000 Lafayette
Boulevard, Bridgeport, Connecticut 06604 (Telephone: 800-888-9471). Unless
otherwise defined herein, capitalized terms have the meanings given to them in
the Prospectus.


- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
                               Table of Contents
                                                                          PAGE

GENERAL INFORMATION....................................................     2
ADDITIONAL DESCRIPTION OF INVESTMENTS..................................     2
INVESTMENT RESTRICTIONS................................................     7
PERFORMANCE INFORMATION................................................     9
  Total Return.........................................................     9
  Yield................................................................    10
PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS.................................................    11
MANAGEMENT OF THE TRUST................................................    13
  Officers and Trustees................................................    13
  The Investment Adviser...............................................    15
  The Administrator....................................................    16
  Custodian............................................................    18
  Independent Certified Public Accountants.............................    18
  Legal Matters........................................................    18
NET ASSET VALUE........................................................    19
TAXES..................................................................    20
  Federal Income Taxes.................................................    20
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS...................................................    22
APPENDIX...............................................................    44
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
 

No person has been authorized to give any information or to make any
representation not contained in this Statement of Additional Information or in
the Prospectus and, if given or made, such information or representation must
not be relied upon as having been authorized.  This Statement of Additional
Information does not constitute an offering of any securities other than the
registered securities to which it relates or an offer to any person in any state
or other jurisdiction of the United States or any country where such offer would
be unlawful.

     The date of this Statement of Additional Information is May 1, 1996.

                                       1
<PAGE>
 
                              GENERAL INFORMATION

     The Trust did not have the initial capitalization required by Section 14(a)
of the Investment Company Act of 1940 (the "1940 Act") in reliance upon Rule 
14a-2 under the 1940 Act and PFL Life acting as a "promoter" of the Trust.

     The Trust's Declaration of Trust may be amended with the affirmative vote
of a majority of the outstanding shares of the Trust or, if only the interests
of a particular Portfolio are affected, a majority of such Portfolio's
outstanding shares. The Trustees are authorized to make amendments to the
Declaration of Trust that do not have a material adverse effect on the interests
of shareholders. The Trust may be terminated (i) upon the sale of the Trust's
assets to another investment company, if approved by the holders of two-thirds
of the outstanding shares of the Trust, except that if the Trustees recommend
such sale of assets, the approval by the vote of a majority of the Trust's
outstanding shares will be sufficient, or (ii) upon liquidation and distribution
of the assets of the Trust, if approved by a majority of its Trustees or by the
vote of a majority of the Trust's outstanding shares. If not so terminated, the
Trust may continue indefinitely.

     The Trust's Declaration of Trust further provides that the Trustees will
not be liable for errors of judgment or mistakes of fact or law; however,
nothing in the Declaration of Trust protects a Trustee against any liability to
which he would otherwise be subject by reason of willful misfeasance, bad faith,
gross negligence, or reckless disregard of the duties involved in the conduct of
his office.

     The Trust is an organization of the type commonly known as a "Massachusetts
business trust." Under Massachusetts law, shareholders of such a trust may,
under certain circumstances, be held personally liable as partners for the
obligations of the trust. The Trust's Declaration of Trust contains an express
disclaimer of shareholder liability in connection with the Trust property or the
acts, obligations or affairs of the Trust. The Declaration of Trust also
provides for indemnification out of the Trust property of any shareholder held
personally liable for the claims and liabilities to which a shareholder may
become subject by reason of being or having been a shareholder. Thus, the risk
of a shareholder incurring financial loss on account of shareholder liability is
limited to circumstances in which the Trust itself would be unable to meet its
obligations. The Trust has been advised by counsel that the risk of any
shareholder incurring any liability for the obligations of a Trust is extremely
remote.

                     ADDITIONAL DESCRIPTION OF INVESTMENTS

     The investment objectives and policies of each of the Portfolios are
described in the Prospectus. The following is a description of certain of the
Trust's investment policies and the portfolio securities in which certain
Portfolios may invest.

     U.S. Government, Agency and Instrumentality Obligations -- U.S. Government
obligations are issued by the Treasury and include bills, certificates of
indebtedness, notes, and bonds. Agencies and instrumentalities of the U.S.
Government are established under the authority of an act of Congress and
include, but are not limited to, the Government National Mortgage Association

                                       2
<PAGE>
 
("GNMA"), the Tennessee Valley Authority, the Bank for Cooperatives, the Farmers
Home Administration, Federal Home Loan Banks, Federal Intermediate Credit Banks,
Federal Land Banks, and the Federal National Mortgage Association. Except for
U.S. Government obligations, the securities issued or guaranteed by U.S.
agencies and instrumentalities may or may not be backed by the full faith and
credit of the United States. If the obligation is not backed by the full faith
and credit of the United States, the Portfolio must look principally to the
agency or instrumentality issuing or guaranteeing the obligation for its
repayment and may not be able to assert a claim against the United States itself
in the event that the agency or instrumentality does not meet its obligations.
The U.S. Government does not guarantee the yield or value of any Portfolio's
investments or shares.


     Mortgage-Related Securities -- GNMA Certificates are mortgage-backed
securities representing part ownership of a pool of mortgage loans. These 
loans -issued by lenders such as mortgage bankers, commercial banks and savings
and loan associations - are either insured by the Federal Housing Administration
or guaranteed by the Veterans Administration. A "pool" or group of such
mortgages is assembled and, after being approved by GNMA, is offered to
investors through securities dealers. Once such pool is approved by GNMA, the
timely payment of interest and principal on the Certificates representing
interests in such pool is guaranteed by the full faith and credit of the U.S.
Government. As mortgage-backed securities, GNMA Certificates differ from bonds
in that the principal is paid back by the borrower over the term of the loan
rather than returned in a lump sum at maturity. GNMA Certificates are called
"pass-through" securities because a pro-rata share of both regular interest and
principal payments, as well as unscheduled early prepayments, on the underlying
mortgage pool is passed through monthly to the holder of the Certificate. As
indicated below, since the unscheduled prepayment rate of the underlying
mortgage pool covered by a "pass-through" security cannot be predicted with
accuracy, the average life of a particular issue of GNMA Certificates cannot be
accurately predicted.

     The Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corporation ("FHLMC"), a corporate
instrumentality of the U.S. Government created by Congress for the purpose of
increasing the availability of mortgage credit for residential housing, issues
participation certificates ("PCs") representing undivided interests in FHLMC's
mortgage portfolio. While FHLMC guarantees the timely payment of interest and
ultimate collection of the principal of its PCs, its PCs are not backed by the
full faith and credit of the U.S. Government. FHLMC PCs differ from GNMA
Certificates in that the mortgages underlying the PCs are mostly "conventional"
mortgages rather than mortgages insured or guaranteed by a federal agency or
instrumentality. However, in several other respects, such as the monthly pass-
through of interest and principal (including unscheduled prepayments) and the
unpredictability of future unscheduled prepayments on the underlying mortgage
pools, FHLMC PCs are similar to GNMA Certificates.

     The Federal National Mortgage Association ("FNMA"), a federally chartered
corporation owned entirely by private stockholders, purchases both conventional
and federally insured or guaranteed residential mortgages from various entities,
including savings and loan associations, savings banks, credit unions and
mortgage bankers, and packages pools of such mortgages in the form of pass-
through securities generally called FNMA Mortgage-Backed Certificates, which are
guaranteed as to timely payment of principal and interest by FNMA but are not
backed by the full faith and

                                       3
<PAGE>
 
credit of the U.S. Government. Like GNMA Certificates and FHLMC PCs, these pass-
through securities are subject to the unpredictability of unscheduled
prepayments on the underlying mortgage pools.

     The mortgage-related securities in which the Portfolios may invest include
GNMA, FHLMC and FNMA securities representing interests in pools of 30 year, 15
year, adjustable rate, variable rate, graduated rate and other types of
mortgages. While it is not possible to accurately predict the life of a
particular issue of a mortgage-backed "pass-through" security held by a
Portfolio, the actual life of any such security is likely to be substantially
less than the original average maturity of the mortgage pool underlying the
security. This is because unscheduled early prepayments of principal on the
security owned by the Portfolio will result from the prepayment, refinancing or
foreclosure of the underlying mortgage loans in the mortgage pool. The
prepayment assumptions for pools of 30 and 15-year mortgages are generally
considered to be 12 years and seven years, respectively, but may be considerably
shorter during periods of declining interest rates. Mortgagors may speed up the
rate at which they prepay their mortgages when interest rates decline
sufficiently to encourage refinancing. A Portfolio, when the monthly payments
(which may include unscheduled prepayments) on such a security are passed
through to it, may be able to reinvest such payments only at a lower rate of
interest. Because of the regular scheduled payments of principal and the early
unscheduled prepayments of principal, the mortgage-backed "pass-through"
security is less effective than other types of obligations as a means of
"locking-in" attractive long-term interest rates. As a result, this type of
security may have less potential for capital appreciation during periods of
declining interest rates than other U.S. Government securities of comparable
maturities, although many issues of mortgage-backed "pass-through" securities
may have a comparable risk of decline in market value during periods of rising
interest rates. If such a security has been purchased by a Portfolio at a
premium above its par value, both a scheduled payment of principal and an
unscheduled prepayment of principal, which would be made at par, will accelerate
the realization of a loss equal to that portion of the premium applicable to the
payment or prepayment and will reduce the Portfolio's total return. If such a
security has been purchased by a Portfolio at a discount from its par value,
both a scheduled payment of principal and an unscheduled prepayment of principal
will increase current and total returns and will accelerate the recognition of
income.

     Collateralized Mortgage Obligations ("CMOs") are debt securities issued by
FHLMC and by financial institutions and other mortgage lenders which are
generally fully collateralized by a pool of mortgages held under an indenture.
CMOs are issued with a number of classes or series which have different
maturities and are retired in sequence and are the general obligations of the
issuers thereof. CMOs are designed to be retired as the underlying mortgage
loans in the mortgage pool are repaid. In the event of sufficient early
prepayments on such mortgages, the class or series of CMO first to mature
generally will be retired prior to its maturity. Thus the early retirement of a
particular class or series of a CMO held by a Portfolio would affect the
Portfolio's current and total returns in the manner indicated above. Currently,
the investment adviser will consider privately issued CMOs or other mortgage-
backed securities as possible investments for a Portfolio only when the mortgage
collateral is insured, guaranteed or otherwise backed by the U.S. Government or
one or more of its agencies or instrumentalities (e.g., insured by the Federal
Housing Administration or Farmers Home Administration or guaranteed by the
Administrator of Veterans Affairs or consisting in whole or in part of U.S.
Government securities).

                                       4
<PAGE>
 
     Corporate Obligations -- As described in the Prospectus, each Portfolio may
invest, subject to certain limitations, in corporate debt obligations. Such
obligations must be rated in the two highest rating categories by a nationally
recognized statistical rating organization for money market instruments in any
portfolio, "A" by Moody's and S&P, in the case of WTRBP, and "AA" by Moody's or
"Aa" by S&P, in the case of WNTBP, WIBCP and WSBCP.


     Foreign Securities -- WIBCP may invest in foreign securities. Investing in
securities issued by companies whose principal business activities are outside
the United States may involve significant risks not associated with domestic
investments. For example, there is generally less publicly available information
about foreign companies, particularly those not subject to the disclosure and
reporting requirements of the U.S. securities laws. Foreign issuers are
generally not bound by uniform accounting, auditing and financial reporting
requirements comparable to those applicable to domestic issuers. Investments in
foreign securities also involve the risk of possible adverse changes in exchange
control regulations, expropriation or confiscatory taxation, limitation on
removal of funds or other assets of WIBCP, political or financial instability or
diplomatic and other developments which could affect such investments. Further,
economies of particular countries or areas of the world may differ favorably or
unfavorably from the economy of the U.S.

     It is anticipated that in most cases, the best available market for foreign
securities will be on exchanges or in over-the-counter markets located outside
the U.S. Foreign stock markets, while growing in volume and sophistication, are
generally not as developed as those in the U.S. Securities of some foreign
issuers (particularly those located in developing countries) may be less liquid
and more volatile than securities of comparable U.S. companies. In addition,
foreign brokerage commissions are generally higher than commissions on
securities traded in the U.S. and may be non-negotiable. In general, there is
less overall governmental supervision and regulation of securities exchanges,
brokers and listed companies than in the U.S.


     Foreign Currency Exchange Transactions -- WIBCP may engage in foreign
currency exchange transactions. Investments in securities of foreign companies
whose principal business activities are located outside of the United States
will frequently involve currencies of foreign countries. In addition, assets of
WIBCP may temporarily be held in bank deposits in foreign currencies during the
completion of investment programs. Therefore, the value of WIBCP's assets, as
measured in U.S. dollars, may be affected favorably or unfavorably by changes in
foreign currency exchange rates and exchange control regulations. Although WIBCP
values its assets daily in U.S. dollars, it does not intend to convert its
holdings of foreign currencies into U.S. dollars on a daily basis. WIBCP may
conduct its foreign currency exchange transactions on a spot (i.e., cash) basis
at the spot rate prevailing in the foreign currency exchange market. WIBCP will
convert currency on a spot basis from time to time and will incur costs in
connection with such currency conversion. Although foreign exchange dealers do
not charge a fee for conversion, they do realize a profit based on the
difference (the "spread") between the prices at which they are buying and
selling various currencies. Thus, a dealer may offer to sell a foreign currency
to WIBCP at one rate, while offering a lesser rate of exchange should WIBCP
desire to resell that currency to the dealer. WIBCP does not intend to speculate
in foreign currency exchange rates.

                                       5
<PAGE>
 
     As an alternative to spot transactions, WIBCP may enter into contracts to
purchase or sell foreign currencies at a future date ("forward contracts") or
purchase currency call or put options. A forward contract involves an obligation
to purchase or sell a specific currency at a future date and price fixed by
agreement between the parties at the time of entering into the contract. These
contracts are traded in the interbank market conducted directly between currency
traders (usually large commercial banks) and their customers. Although a forward
contract generally involves no deposit requirement and no commissions are
charged at any stage for trades, WIBCP will use segregated accounts for forward
purchase transactions. WIBCP intends to enter into such contracts only on net
terms. The purchase of a put or call option is an alternative to the purchase or
sale of forward contracts and will be used if the option premiums are less then
those in the forward contract market.

     WIBCP may enter into forward contracts or purchase currency options only
under two circumstances. First, when WIBCP enters into a contract for the
purchase or sale of a security dominated in a foreign currency, it may desire to
"lock in" the U.S. dollar price of the security. This is accomplished by
entering into a forward contract for the purchase or sale, for a fixed amount of
U.S. dollars, of the amount of foreign currency involved in the underlying
security transaction ("transaction hedging"). Such forward contract transactions
will enable WIBCP to protect itself against a possible loss resulting from an
adverse change in the relationship between the U.S. dollar and the subject
foreign currency during the period between the date the security is purchased or
sold and the date of payment for the security.

     Second, when the investment adviser believes that the currency of a
particular foreign country may suffer a substantial decline against the U.S.
dollar, WIBCP may enter into a forward contract to sell, for a fixed amount of
U.S. dollars, the amount of foreign currency approximating the value of some or
all of the securities denominated in such foreign currency. The precise matching
of the forward contract amounts and the value of the securities involved will
not generally be possible. The future value of such securities in foreign
currencies will change as a consequence of fluctuations in the market value of
those securities between the date the forward contract is entered into and the
date it matures. The projection of currency exchange rates and the
implementation of a short-term hedging strategy are highly uncertain.

     WIBCP's custodian will place cash or liquid, high-grade debt securities in
a segregated account. The amount of such segregated assets will be at least
equal to the value of WIBCP's total assets committed to the consummation of
forward contracts involving the purchase of forward currency. If the value of
the securities placed in the segregated account declines, additional cash or
securities will be placed in the account on a daily basis so that the value of
the amount will equal the amount of WIBCP's commitments with respect to such
contracts.

     At the maturity of a forward contract, WIBCP may elect to sell the
portfolio security and make delivery of the foreign currency. Alternatively,
WIBCP may retain the security and terminate its contractual obligation to
deliver the foreign currency by purchasing an identical offsetting contract from
the same currency trader.

     It is impossible to forecast with precision the market value of portfolio
securities at the expiration of a forward contract. Accordingly, it may be
necessary for WIBCP to purchase additional

                                       6
<PAGE>
 
foreign currency on the spot market (and bear the expense of such purchase) if
WIBCP intends to sell the security and the market value of the security is less
than the amount of foreign currency that WIBCP is obligated to deliver.
Conversely, it may be necessary to sell on the spot market some of the foreign
currency received upon the sale of the portfolio security if its market value
exceeds the amount of foreign currency that WIBCP is obligated to deliver.

     If WIBCP retains the portfolio security and engages in an offsetting
transaction, WIBCP will incur a gain or a loss (as described below) to the
extent that there has been a change in forward contract prices. If WIBCP engages
in an offsetting transaction, it may subsequently enter into a new forward
contract to sell the foreign currency. Should forward contract prices decline
during the period between the date WIBCP enters into a forward contract for the
sale of the foreign currency and the date it enters into an offsetting contract
for the purchase of the foreign currency, WIBCP will realize a gain to the
extent that the price of the currency it has agreed to sell exceeds the price of
the currency it has agreed to purchase. Should forward contract prices increase,
WIBCP will suffer a loss to the extent that the price of the currency it has
agreed to purchase exceeds the price of the currency it has agreed to sell.

     WIBCP will not speculate in forward contracts and will limit its dealings
in such contracts to the transactions described above. Of course, WIBCP is not
required to enter into such transactions with respect to portfolio securities
quoted or denominated in a foreign currency and will not do so unless deemed
appropriate by its investment adviser. This method of protecting the value of
WIBCP's securities against a decline in the value of a currency does not
eliminate fluctuations in the underlying prices of the securities. It simply
establishes a rate of exchange which WIBCP can achieve at some future time.
Additionally, although such contracts tend to minimize the risk of loss due to a
decline in the value of the hedged currency, they also tend to limit any
potential gain which might be realized if the value of such currency increases.


     Lending Portfolio Securities -- Cash equivalents include certificates of
deposit, commercial paper and other short-term money market instruments. A
Portfolio would have the right to call a loan and obtain the securities loaned
at any time on up to five business days' notice. A Portfolio would not have the
right to vote any securities having voting rights during the existence of a
loan, but would call the loan in anticipation of an important vote to be taken
among holders of the securities or the giving or withholding of their consent on
a material matter affecting the investment.


     Borrowings -- Each Portfolio may borrow money in an amount equal to 1/3 of
its net assets for temporary or emergency purposes or for the clearance of
transactions. A Portfolio will not purchase additional securities while such
borrowings exceed 5% of such Portfolio's total assets.


                            INVESTMENT RESTRICTIONS


     The following investment restrictions have been adopted by the Trust on
behalf of each Portfolio and may be changed only by the vote of a majority of a
Portfolio's outstanding voting securities, as defined in the 1940 Act.
Accordingly, each Portfolio may not:

                                       7
<PAGE>
 
(1)  Borrow money in excess of 1/3 of the current market value of the net assets
     of such Portfolio (excluding the amount borrowed) and then only if such
     borrowing is incurred as a temporary measure for extraordinary or emergency
     purposes or to facilitate the orderly sale of portfolio securities to
     accommodate redemption requests; or issue any securities other than its
     shares of beneficial interest except as appropriate to evidence
     indebtedness which such Portfolio is permitted to incur;

(2)  Pledge, mortgage or hypothecate its assets, except to secure permitted
     borrowings.  For purposes of this restriction, collateral arrangements with
     respect to options, futures contracts and options on futures contracts
     shall not be deemed to be a mortgage, pledge or hypothecation);

(3)  Invest more than 5% of its total assets taken at current market value in
     the securities of any one issuer or purchase more than 10% of the voting
     securities of any one issuer;

(4)  Purchase or retain securities of any issuer if 5% of the issuer's
     securities are owned by those officers and Trustees of the Trust or its
     investment adviser who own individually more than 1/2 of 1% of the 
     issuer's securities;

(5)  Purchase securities on margin or make short sales, except that such
     Portfolio may make sales against the box;

(6)  Buy or sell real estate, commodities, or commodity contracts unless
     acquired as a result of ownership of securities; except that the Portfolio
     may purchase and sell futures contracts on securities, indices, currency
     and other financial instruments and options on futures contracts;

(7)  Purchase any securities which would cause more than 25% of the market value
     of such Portfolio's total assets at the time of such purchase to be
     invested in the securities of issuers having their principal business
     activities in the same industry, provided that there is no limitation in
     respect to investments in obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S.
     Government or its agencies or instrumentalities;

(8)  Underwrite securities issued by other persons except insofar as the Trust
     may technically be deemed an underwriter under the Securities Act of 1933
     in selling a portfolio security;

(9)  Make loans, except (i) through the loan of a portfolio security, (ii) by
     entering into repurchase agreements and (iii) to the extent that the
     purchase of debt instruments for the Portfolio in accordance with the
     Portfolio's investment objective and policies may be deemed to be loans;

(10) Purchase from or sell to any of its Trustees and officers, its
     administrator, investment adviser, or principal underwriter, if any, or the
     officers and directors of said administrator, investment adviser or
     principal underwriter, portfolio securities; or

(11) Issue senior securities, except as permitted under (1).

                                       8
<PAGE>
 
     In addition to the foregoing fundamental investment restrictions, each
Portfolio has adopted the following nonfundamental policies which reflect the
intentions of the Trustees under current circumstances. Unlike the fundamental
investment restrictions, these policies may be changed at any time by the
Trustees without shareholder approval. Each Portfolio will not: purchase oil,
gas or other mineral leases or purchase partnership interests in oil, gas or
other mineral exploration or development programs; purchase warrants of any
issuer if, as a result, more than 2% of the value of its total assets would be
invested in warrants which are not listed on the New York or American Stock
Exchanges and more than 5% of the value of its total assets would be invested in
warrants, such warrants in each case to be valued at the lesser of cost or
market, but assigning no value to warrants acquired by such Portfolio in units
or attached to securities; or enter into repurchase agreements maturing in more
than seven days or invest in illiquid or restricted securities if, as a result,
more than 15% of the Portfolio's net assets would be invested in such repurchase
agreements and securities.

     If a percentage restriction contained in the Portfolio's investment
restrictions or policies is adhered to at the time of investment, a later
increase or decrease in the percentage resulting from a change in the value of
portfolio securities or the Portfolio's net assets will not be considered a
violation of such restrictions.


                            PERFORMANCE INFORMATION


     Each Portfolio may from time to time report its yield and total return in
advertisements, reports to shareholders and other sales material. Total return
and yield will be computed as described below.


Total Return

     The average annual total return of each Portfolio is determined for a
particular period by calculating the actual dollar amount of investment return
on a $1,000 investment in the Portfolio made at the maximum public offering
price (i.e. net asset value) at the beginning of the period, and then
calculating the annual compounded rate of return which would produce that
amount. Total return for a period of one year is equal to the actual return of
the Portfolio during that period. This calculation assumes that all dividends
and distributions are reinvested at net asset value on the reinvestment dates
during the period. The formula can be expressed as follows:

                                    [(Ending  Value )1/nth power]
                                    [(--------------)           ]
   Average Annual Total Return  =   [(Starting Value)    -  1   ]  x  100


          where Starting Value equals $1,000 and n = number of years.


     In addition, each Portfolio may provide total return information for other
designated periods, such as for the most recent six months or most recent 12
months. This total return information is computed as described above except that
no annualization is made.

                                       9
<PAGE>
 
     The average annual total return of each Portfolio for the one-year period
ended December 31, 1995 and from inception to December 31, 1995 are shown in the
table below:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                             One Year     Inception To  Inception
                                          Ended 12/31/95    12/31/95       Date
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                       <C>               <C>         <C>

Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio                10.88%         3.47%       1/6/94
Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio            26.25%         8.89%       1/6/94
Wright Total Return Portfolio                  16.87%         3.79%      12/7/93
Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio       10.60%         0.33%       1/6/94

- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

1  During the periods ended December 31, 1995, the operating expenses of the
   Portfolios were reduced either by a reduction of the investment adviser fee,
   the administrator fee, and the allocation of expenses to the Adviser, or a
   combination of these. Had such actions not been undertaken, the Portfolios
   would have had lower returns.

2  The total investment return does not reflect expenses that apply to the
   separate account or policies. If these charges had been included, the total
   return would be reduced.


Yield

     The yield of each Portfolio is computed by dividing its net investment
income per share earned during a recent 30-day period by the maximum offering
price (i.e. net asset value) per share on the last day of the period and
annualizing the resulting figure. Net investment income per share is equal to
the dividends and interest earned on a Portfolio's assets during the period,
with the resulting number being divided by the average daily number of shares
outstanding and entitled to receive dividends during the period. The formula is
as follows:

 
                     Yield = 2      a-b + 1  /6/  - 1
                                    ---
                                    cd
 
Where:
 
  a = dividends and interest earned during the period.
  b = expenses accrued for the period (after reductions).
  c = the average daily number of accumulation units outstanding during the 
      period.
  d = the maximum offering price per accumulation unit on the last day of the
      period.
 

  NOTE: "a" is calculated for stocks by dividing the stated dividend rate for
each security held during the period by 360. "a" is estimated for debt
securities other than mortgage certificates by dividing the year-end market
value times the yield to maturity by 360. "a" for mortgage securities, such as
GNMAs, is the actual income earned. Neither discount nor premium has been
amortized.

                                       10
<PAGE>
 
     For the 30-day period ended December 31, 1995, the yield of each of the
following Portfolios was:

<TABLE> 
<CAPTION> 
                                                             30-Day Period Ended
                                                              December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                          <C> 

   Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio                                   3.88%
   Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio                               0.71%
   Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio                                3.50%

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE> 


     Total return, yield and effective yield are based on historical earnings
and are not intended to indicate future performance. Total return and yield will
vary based on changes in market conditions and the level of expenses.

     A Portfolio's yield or total return may be compared to the Consumer Price
Index and various domestic securities indices. A Portfolio's yield or total
return and comparisons with these indices may be used in advertisements and in
information furnished to present or prospective shareholders.

     From time to time, evaluations of a Portfolio's performance made by
independent sources may be used in advertisements and in information furnished
to present or prospective shareholders. These include the rankings prepared by
Lipper Analytical Services, Inc., an independent service which monitors the
performance of mutual funds. The Lipper performance analysis includes the
reinvestment of dividends and capital gain distributions, but does not take
sales charges into consideration and is prepared without regard to tax
consequences.


                            PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS

     The investment adviser places the security transactions for each Portfolio,
which in some cases may be effected in block transactions which include other
accounts managed by the investment adviser. The investment adviser provides
similar services directly for bank trust departments and other investment
companies. In some instances, allocation of the securities to be purchased or
sold, and the expenses in connection with such transaction, is made in a manner
the investment adviser considers to be most equitable and consistent with its
fiduciary obligations to the Trust and such other clients. Such allocation may
adversely affect the size of the position obtainable by a Portfolio.

     The investment adviser seeks to execute portfolio security transactions on
the most favorable terms and in the most effective manner possible. In seeking
best execution, the investment adviser will use its best judgment in evaluating
the terms of a transaction, and will give consideration to various relevant
factors, including without limitation the size and type of the transaction, the
nature and character of the markets for the security, the confidentiality, speed
and certainty of effective execution required for the transaction, the
reputation, experience and financial condition of the broker-dealer and the
value and quality of service rendered by the broker-dealer in other
transactions, and the reasonableness of the brokerage commission or markup, if
any.

                                       11
<PAGE>
 
     It is expected that on frequent occasions there will be many broker-dealer
firms which will meet the foregoing criteria for a particular transaction. In
selecting among such firms, the Portfolios may give consideration to those firms
which supply brokerage and research services, quotations and statistical and
other information to the investment adviser for use in servicing their accounts
or firms which purchase its investment services. The term "brokerage and
research services" includes advice as to the value of securities, the
advisability of investing in, purchasing or selling securities, and the
availability of securities or purchasers or sellers of securities; furnishing
analyses and reports concerning issuers, industries, securities, economic
factors and trends, portfolio strategy and the performance of accounts; and
effecting securities transactions and performing functions incidental thereto
(such as clearance and settlement). Such services and information may be useful
and of value to the investment adviser in servicing all or less than all of its
accounts and the services and information furnished by a particular firm may not
necessarily be used in connection with the account which paid brokerage
commissions to such firm. The advisory fee paid by the Portfolios to the
investment adviser is not reduced as a consequence of its receipt of such
services and information. While such services and information are not expected
to reduce the investment adviser's normal research activities and expenses, the
investment adviser would, through use of such services and information, avoid
the additional expenses which would be incurred if it attempted to develop
comparable services and information through its own staff.

     Under the Investment Advisory Contract, the investment adviser has the
authority to pay commissions on portfolio transactions for brokerage and
research services exceeding that which other brokers or dealers might charge
provided certain conditions are met. The Investment Advisory Contract expressly
authorizes the selection of a broker or dealer which charges a Portfolio a
commission which is in excess of the amount of commission another broker or
dealer would have charged for effecting that transaction if it is determined in
good faith that such commission was reasonable in relation to the value of the
brokerage and research services which have been provided.

     Subject to the requirement that the investment adviser shall use its best
efforts to seek to execute each Portfolio's security transactions at
advantageous prices and at reasonably competitive commission rates, the
investment adviser, as indicated above, is authorized to consider as a factor in
the selection of any broker-dealer firm with whom a Portfolio's orders may be
placed the fact that such firm has sold or is selling shares of the Portfolio or
of other investment companies sponsored by the investment adviser.

     During the fiscal years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993, the
Portfolios that were offering their shares during such periods paid the
following amounts on brokerage commissions:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                              1995                  1994                 1993
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
   <S>                       <C>                   <C>                   <C>

   WNTB(1)                      0                     0                   -
   WSBCP(1)                  $3,551                $4,952                 -
   WTRBP(2)                     0                     0                   0
   WIBCP(1)                  $2,768                $2,812                 -

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

   (1) Start of business, January 6, 1994.
   (2) Start of business, December 7, 1993.

                                       12
<PAGE>
 
                            MANAGEMENT OF THE TRUST


Officers and Trustees

     The officers and Trustees of the Trust are listed below. Except as
indicated, each individual has held the office shown or other offices in the
same company for the last five years. Those Trustees who are "interested
persons," as defined in the 1940 Act, of the Trust, Wright, The Winthrop
Corporation ("Winthrop"), Eaton Vance, Eaton Vance's wholly-owned subsidiary,
Boston Management and Research ("BMR"), or Eaton Vance's parent company, Eaton
Vance Corp. ("EVC"), or Eaton Vance's Trustee, Eaton Vance, Inc. ("EV"), by
virtue of their affiliation with the Trust, Wright, Winthrop, Eaton Vance, EVC
or EV, are indicated by an asterisk (*).


PETER M. DONOVAN (53), President and Trustee*
President, Chief Executive Officer and Director of Wright and Winthrop
Vice President, Treasurer and a Director of Wright Investors' Service
Distributors, Inc.
Address: 1000 Lafayette Boulevard, Bridgeport, CT 06604

H. DAY BRIGHAM, JR. (69), Vice President, Secretary and Trustee*
Vice President of Eaton Vance, EVC and EV and Director, EV and EVC
Director, Trustee and officer of various investment companies managed by Eaton
Vance or BMR.
Address: 24 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110

WINTHROP S. EMMET (85), Trustee
Retired New York City Attorney at Law
Trust Officer, First National City Bank, New York, NY (1963-1971)
Address: Box 327, West Center Road, West Stockbridge, MA 01266

JATIN J. MEHTA, CFA (56), Trustee*
Executive Counselor and Director of Education of Wright and Winthrop
Executive of the Industrial Credit Investment Corporation of India, a World Bank
agency in India for financial assistance to private industry.
Member of the New York Society of Security Analysts and the Hartford Society of
Financial Analysts.
Address: 1000 Lafayette Boulevard, Bridgeport, CT 06604

A.M. MOODY III (59), Vice President & Trustee*
Senior Vice President, Wright and Winthrop
President, Wright Investors  Service Distributors, Inc.
Address: 1000 Lafayette Boulevard, Bridgeport, CT 06604

LLOYD F. PIERCE (77), Trustee
Retired Vice Chairman (prior to 1984 - President), People's Bank, Bridgeport, CT
Member, Board of Trustees, People's Bank, Bridgeport, CT
Board of Directors, Southern Connecticut Gas Company
Chairman, Board of Directors, COSINE
Address: 125 Gull Circle North, Daytona Beach, FL 32119

                                       13
<PAGE>
 
GEORGE R. PREFER (61), Trustee
Retired President and Chief Executive Officer, Muller Data Corp., New York, NY
(1983-1986) (1989-1990); President and Chief Executive Officer, InvestData
Corporation, A Mellon Financial Services Company (1986-1989)
Address: 7738 Silver Bell Drive, Sarasota, FL 34241

RAYMOND VAN HOUTTE (71), Trustee
President Emeritus and Counselor of The Tompkins County Trust Co., Ithaca, NY
(since January 1989); President and Chief Executive Officer, The Tompkins County
Trust Company (1973-1988); President, New York State Bankers Association 
(1987-1988); Director, McGraw Housing Company, Inc., Deanco, Inc., Evaporated
Metal Products and Tompkins County Area Development, Inc.
Address: One Strawberry Lane, Ithaca, NY 14850

JUDITH R. CORCHARD (57), Vice President
Executive Vice President, Investment Management: Senior Investment Officer;
Chairman of the Investment Committee and Director Wright and Winthrop.
Address: 1000 Lafayette Boulevard, Bridgeport, CT 06604

JAMES L. O'CONNOR (51), Treasurer
Vice President of Eaton Vance and EV.
Officer of various investment companies managed by Eaton Vance or BMR.
Address: 24 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110

JANET E. SANDERS (60), Assistant Secretary and Assistant Treasurer
Vice President of Eaton Vance and EV.
Officer of various investment companies managed by Eaton Vance or BMR.
Address: 24 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110

A. JOHN MURPHY (33), Assistant Secretary
Assistant Vice President of Eaton Vance, BMR and EV since March 1, 1994;
employee of Eaton Vance since March 1993. State Regulations Supervisor, The
Boston Company (1991-1993) and Registration Specialist, Fidelity Management &
Research Co. (1986-1991).
Officer of various investment companies managed by Eaton Vance or BMR.
Mr. Murphy was elected Assistant Secretary of the Trust on June 21, 1995.
Address: 24 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110

ERIC G. WOODBURY (38), Assistant Secretary
Vice President of Eaton Vance since February 1993; formerly, associate attorney
at Dechert, Price & Rhoads and Gaston & Snow.
Officer of various investment companies managed by Eaton Vance or BMR.
Mr. Woodbury was elected Assistant Secretary of the Trust on June 21, 1995.

WILLIAM J. AUSTIN, JR. (44), Assistant Treasurer
Assistant Vice President of Eaton Vance and EV.
Officer of various investment companies managed by Eaton Vance or BMR.
Address: 24 Federal Street, Boston, MA 02110

                                       14
<PAGE>
 
     All of the Trustees and officers (except Mr. Mehta) hold identical
positions with The Wright Managed Equity Trust, The Wright Managed Income Trust
and The Wright EquiFund Equity Trust. The Trustees (Messrs. Emmet, Pierce,
Prefer and Van Houtte) who are not affiliated persons of the Trust are paid by
the Portfolios. They also received additional payments from other investment
companies for which Wright provides investment advisory services. The Trustees
who are "interested persons" of the Trust receive no compensation from the
Trust. The Trust does not have a retirement plan for its Trustees. For Trustee
compensation for the fiscal year ended December 31, 1995, see the following
table.


           COMPENSATION TABLE - FISCAL YEAR ENDED DECEMBER 31, 1995

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                   Aggregate Compensation   Pension      Estimated     Total
                  From The Wright Managed   Benefits      Annual    Compensation
Trustees           Blue Chip Series Trust   Accrued      Benefits      Paid(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                         <C>             <C>          <C>        <C>
Winthrop S. Emmet           $1,250           None          None        $5,000
Leland Miles                $1,000           None          None        $5,000
Lloyd F. Pierce             $1,250           None          None        $5,000
George R. Prefer            $1,250           None          None        $5,000
Raymond Van Houtte          $1,250           None          None        $5,000
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

(1) Total compensation paid is from the The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series
Trust (4 Portfolios) and the other boards in the Wright Fund complex (27 Funds)
for a total of 31 Funds.


     Messrs. Emmet, Pierce, Prefer and Van Houtte are members of the Special
Nominating Committee of the Trustees. The Special Nominating Committee s
function is selecting and nominating individuals to fill vacancies, as and when
they occur, in the ranks of those Trustees who are not "interested persons" of
the Trust, Eaton Vance, Wright or Winthrop. The Trust does not have a designated
audit committee since the full board performs the functions of such committee.


The Investment Adviser

     The Trust has engaged The Winthrop Corporation ("Winthrop"), to act as the
Portfolio's investment adviser pursuant to an Investment Advisory Contract.
Pursuant to a service agreement effective February 1, 1996 between Winthrop and
its wholly-owned subsidiary, Wright Investors Service, Inc. ("Wright"), Wright,
acting under the general supervision of the Trust's Trustees, furnishes each
Portfolio with investment advice and management services. Winthrop supervises
Wright's performance of this function and retains its contractual obligations
under its Investment Advisory Contract with each Portfolio. The estate of John
Winthrop Wright may be considered a controlling person of Winthrop and Wright by
reason of its ownership of 29% of the outstanding shares of Winthrop. The
Trustees of the Trust are responsible for the general oversight of the conduct
of each Portfolio's business. An affiliate of the investment adviser receives an
annual service fee of .50% of the annuity purchase value from PFL for acting as
principal underwriter of the Contracts.

                                       15
<PAGE>
 
     Pursuant to the Investment Advisory Contract, Wright will carry out the
investment and reinvestment of the assets of the Portfolios, will furnish
continuously an investment program with respect to the Portfolios, will
determine which securities should be purchased, sold or exchanged, and will
implement such determinations. Wright will furnish to the Portfolios investment
advice and management services, office space, equipment and clerical personnel,
and investment advisory, statistical and research facilities. In addition,
Wright has arranged for certain members of the Eaton Vance and Wright
organizations to serve without salary as officers or Trustees of the Trust. In
return for these services, each Portfolio is obligated to pay a monthly advisory
fee calculated at the rates set forth in the Portfolio's current Prospectus.

     The following table sets forth the net assets of each Portfolio as at
December 31, 1995, and the advisory fee earned during the fiscal years ended
December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                         Aggregate        Fee Earned        Fee Earned       Fee Earned
                                                            Net         for the Fiscal    for the Fiscal   for the Fiscal  
                                                          Assets          Year Ended        Year Ended       Year Ended
PORTFOLIOS                                               12/31/95          12/31/95          12/31/94         12/31/93
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                     <C>             <C>               <C>              <C>
Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio (WNTBP)**               $  326,564       $   1,563(5)      $   1,921(1)             --
Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio (WTRBP)*             $  537,682       $   2,034(6)      $   1,861(2)      $      41
Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio (WSBCP)**           $2,238,830       $  11,367(7)      $   5,488(3)             --
Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio (WIBCP)**      $1,364,871       $   9,690(8)      $   5,535(4)             --
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

 * Start of business, December 7, 1993.  **  Start of business, January 6, 1994.
(1)  To enhance the net income of WNTBP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $16,824 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(2)  To enhance the net income of WTRBP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $23,275 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(3)  To enhance the net income of WSBCP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $12,240 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(4)  To enhance the net income of WIBCP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $13,935 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(5)  To enhance the net income of WNTBP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $29,915 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(6)  To enhance the net income of WTRBP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $29,886 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(7)  To enhance the net income of WSBCP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $7,494 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.
(8)  To enhance the net income of WIBCP, Wright made a reduction of its advisory
     fee in the full amount of such fee and Wright was allocated $12,813 of
     expenses related to the operation of such Portfolio.



The Administrator

     The Trust has engaged Eaton Vance to act as the administrator for each
Portfolio. For its services under the Administration Agreement, Eaton Vance
receives monthly administration fees based

                                       16
<PAGE>
 
on the net assets of each Portfolio at the annual rates set forth in the
Portfolio's current Prospectus. The following table sets forth the
administration fees that would have been earned, absent a fee reduction, from
each Portfolio for the fiscal years ended December 31, 1995, 1994 and 1993.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                              Administration Fees Paid
                                                        for the Fiscal Year Ended December 31
                                                        -------------------------------------
PORTFOLIOS                                               1995(1)         1994(1)         1993
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                     <C>             <C>             <C>
Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio (WNTBP)**                 $174            $214            -- 
Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio (WTRBP)*               $226            $207            $5 
Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio (WSBCP)**             $874            $422            -- 
Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio (WIBCP)**        $606            $346            -- 
- ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

*    Start of business, December 7, 1993.
**   Start of business, January 6, 1994.
(1)  Eaton Vance made a reduction of the administration fee in the full amount
     for each Portfolio.


     Eaton Vance and EV are both wholly owned subsidiaries of EVC. BMR is a
wholly-owned subsidiary of Eaton Vance. Eaton Vance and BMR are both
Massachusetts business trusts, and EV is the Trustee of Eaton Vance and BMR. The
Directors of EV are Landon T. Clay, H. Day Brigham, Jr., M. Dozier Gardner,
James B. Hawkes, and Benjamin A. Rowland, Jr. The Directors of EVC consist of
the same persons and John G. L. Cabot and Ralph Z. Sorenson. Mr. Clay is
chairman, and Mr. Gardner is president and chief executive officer of EVC, Eaton
Vance, BMR and EV. All of the issued and outstanding shares of Eaton Vance and
of EV are owned by EVC. All of the issued and outstanding shares of BMR are
owned by Eaton Vance. All shares of the outstanding Voting Common Stock of EVC
are deposited in a Voting Trust which expires December 31, 1996, the Voting
Trustees of which are Messrs. Brigham, Clay, Gardner, Hawkes, and Rowland. The
Voting Trustees have unrestricted voting rights for the election of Directors of
EVC. All of the outstanding voting trust receipts issued under said Voting Trust
are owned by certain of the officers of Eaton Vance and BMR who are also
officers and Directors of EVC and EV. As of March 31, 1996, Messrs. Clay,
Gardner and Hawkes each owned 24% of such voting trust receipts. Messrs. Rowland
and Brigham owned 15% and 13%, respectively, of such voting trust receipts. Mr.
Brigham is an officer and Trustee of the Trust, and a member of the Eaton Vance,
EV, BMR and EVC organizations. Messrs. Austin, Murphy, O Connor and Woodbury and
Ms. Sanders, are officers of the Trust, and are also members of the Eaton Vance,
BMR and EV organizations. Eaton Vance will receive the fees paid under the
Administration Agreements.

     EVC owns all of the stock of Energex Energy Corporation which is engaged in
oil and gas exploration and development. In addition, Eaton Vance owns all the
stock of Northeast Properties, Inc., which is engaged in real estate investment.
EVC owns all of the stock of Fulcrum Management, Inc. and MinVen, Inc., which
are engaged in precious metal mining venture investment and management. EVC, EV,
Eaton Vance and BMR may also enter into other businesses.

                                       17
<PAGE>
 
     The Trust's Investment Advisory Contract and Administration Agreement will
remain in effect until February 28, 1997. The Trust's Investment Advisory
Contract may be continued with respect to a Portfolio from year to year
thereafter so long as such continuance after February 28, 1997 is approved at
least annually (i) by the vote of a majority of the Trustees who are not
"interested persons" of the Trust, Eaton Vance or Wright cast in person at a
meeting specifically called for the purpose of voting on such approval and (ii)
by the Board of Trustees of the Trust or by vote of a majority of the
outstanding shares of that Portfolio. The Trust's Administration Agreement may
be continued from year to year after February 28, 1997 so long as such
continuance is approved annually by the vote of a majority of the Trustees. Each
agreement may be terminated as to a Portfolio at any time without penalty on
sixty (60) days' written notice by the Board of Trustees or Directors of either
party, or by vote of the majority of the outstanding shares of that Portfolio,
and each agreement will terminate automatically in the event of its assignment.
Each agreement provides that, in the absence of willful misfeasance, bad faith,
gross negligence or reckless disregard of its obligations or duties to the Trust
under such agreement on the part of Eaton Vance or Wright, Eaton Vance or Wright
will not be liable to the Trust for any loss incurred.



Custodian

     Investors Bank & Trust Company ("IBT"), 89 South Street, Boston,
Massachusetts acts as custodian for each of the Portfolios. IBT, directly or
through subcustodians, has the custody of all cash and securities of the
Portfolios, maintains the Portfolios general ledgers and computes daily the net
asset value per share of each Portfolio. In such capacity it attends to details
in connection with the sale, exchange, substitution, transfer or other dealings
with the Portfolios investments, receives and disburses all funds and performs
various other ministerial duties upon receipt of proper instructions from the
Portfolios. A portion of the custody fee for each Portfolio is based upon the
Trust's aggregate assets, the fees so determined being then allocated among the
Portfolios relative to their size. These fees are then reduced by a credit for a
Portfolio's cash balances at IBT equal to 75% of the 91-day, U.S. Treasury Bill
auction rate applied to such Portfolio's average daily collected balances for
the week. In addition, each Portfolio pays a fee based on the number of
portfolio transactions and a fee for bookkeeping and valuation services.



Independent Certified Public Accountants

     Deloitte & Touche LLP, 125 Summer Street, Boston, Massachusetts are the
Trust's independent certified public accountants, providing audit services, tax
return preparation, and assistance and consultation with respect to the
preparation of filings with the Securities and Exchange Commission.



Legal Matters

     Certain legal matters are passed on for the Trust by Hale and Dorr, 60
State Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02109.

                                       18
<PAGE>
 
                                NET ASSET VALUE


     Portfolio securities for which the primary market is on a domestic or
foreign exchange or which are traded over-the-counter and quoted on the NASDAQ
System will be valued at the last sale price on the day of valuation or, if
there was no sale that day, at the last reported bid price, using prices as of
the close of trading. Portfolio securities not quoted on the NASDAQ System that
are actively traded in the over-the-counter market, including listed securities
for which the primary market is believed to be the over-the-counter market, will
be valued at the most recently quoted bid price provided by the principal market
makers.

     With respect to WIBCP, foreign securities traded outside the United States
are generally valued as of the time their trading is completed, which is usually
different from the close of the New York Stock Exchange. Occasionally, events
affecting the value of such securities may occur between such times and the
close of the New York Stock Exchange that will not be reflected in the
computation of WIBCP's net asset value. If events materially affecting the value
of such securities occur during such period, these securities will be valued at
their fair value according to procedures decided upon in good faith by the
Trustees. All securities and other assets of WIBCP initially quoted or
denominated in foreign currencies will be converted to U.S. dollar values at the
mean of the bid and offer prices of such currencies against U.S. dollars last
quoted on a valuation date by any recognized dealer.

     In the case of any securities which are not actively traded, reliable
market quotations may not be considered to be readily available. These
investments are stated at fair value as determined under the direction of the
Trustees. Such fair value is expected to be determined by utilizing information
furnished by a pricing service which determines valuations for normal,
institutional-size trading units of such securities using methods based on
market transactions for comparable securities and various relationships between
securities which are generally recognized by institutional traders.

     If any securities held by a Portfolio are restricted as to resale, their
fair value will be determined following procedures approved by the Trustees. The
Trustees periodically review such procedures. The fair value of such securities
is generally determined to be the amount which the Portfolio could reasonably
expect to realize from an orderly disposition of such securities over a
reasonable period of time. The valuation procedures applied in any specific
instance are likely to vary from case to case. However, consideration is
generally given to the financial position of the issuer and other fundamental
analytical data relating to the investment and to the nature of the restrictions
on disposition of the securities (including any registration expenses that might
be borne by the Portfolio in connection with such disposition). In addition,
specific factors are also generally considered, such as the cost of the
investment, the market value of any unrestricted securities of the same class
(both at the time of purchase and at the time of valuation), the size of the
holding, the prices of any recent transactions or offers with respect to such
securities and any available analysts' reports regarding the issuer.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing, short-term debt securities with maturities
of 60 days or less will be valued at amortized cost.

                                       19
<PAGE>
 
                                     TAXES


Federal Income Taxes

     In order to qualify as a regulated investment company as described in the
Prospectus, a Portfolio must, among other things, (1) derive at least 90% of its
gross income in each taxable year from dividends, interest, payments with
respect to securities loans, gains from the sale or other disposition of stocks
or securities or foreign currencies, or other income (including but not limited
to gains from options and forward contracts) derived with respect to its
business of investing in such stocks or securities; (2) derive less than 30% of
its gross income in each taxable year from the sale or other disposition of
stocks or securities and certain other investments held less than three months;
and (3) diversify its holdings in compliance with the diversification
requirements of Subchapter M of the Code so that, at the end of each quarter of
the Portfolio's taxable year, (a) at least 50% of the market value of the
Portfolio's total assets is represented by cash, U.S. Government securities and
other securities limited in respect of any one issuer to not more than 5% of the
value of the Portfolio's total (gross) assets and to not more than 10% of the
voting securities of such issuer, and (b) not more than 25% of the value of its
total (gross) assets is invested in securities of any one issuer (other than
U.S. Government securities) or certain other issuers controlled by the
Portfolio.

     As a regulated investment company, a Portfolio will not be subject to
federal income tax on net investment income and net capital gains (short- and
long-term), if any, that it distributes to its shareholders if at least 90% of
its investment company taxable income (i.e., all of its net taxable income other
than the excess, if any, of net long-term capital gain over net short-term
capital loss ("net capital gain") for the taxable year is distributed in
accordance with applicable timing requirements, but will be subject to tax at
regular corporate rates on any investment company taxable income or net capital
gain that is not so distributed. In general, dividends will be treated as paid
when actually distributed, except that dividends declared in October, November
or December and made payable to shareholders of record in such a month will be
treated as having been paid by the Portfolio (and received by shareholders) on
December 31, if the dividend is paid in the following January. Each Portfolio
intends to satisfy the distribution requirement in each taxable year.

     Each Portfolio will not be subject to federal excise tax or the related
distribution requirements for any taxable year in which all of its shares are
held by segregated asset accounts of life insurance companies held in connection
with variable contracts or are attributable to certain "seed money" in
accordance with Section 4982(f) of the Code.

     Investment by a Portfolio in the stock of a "passive foreign investment
company" may cause the Portfolio to recognize income prior to the receipt of
distributions from such a company or to become subject to tax upon the receipt
of certain excess distributions from, or upon disposition of its stock of, such
a company, although an election may in some cases be available that would
ameliorate some of these adverse tax consequences.

     Each Portfolio intends to comply with the diversification requirements
imposed by Section 817(h) of the Code and the regulations thereunder. These
requirements, which are in addition to the

                                       20
<PAGE>
 
diversification requirements imposed on a Portfolio by the Investment Company
Act and Subchapter M of the Code, place certain limitations on the assets of
each separate account and, because Section 817(h) and those regulations treat
the assets of the Portfolio as assets of the related separate account, the
assets of a Portfolio, that may be represented by any one, two, three and four
investments. Specifically, the regulations provide that, except as permitted by
the "safe harbor" described below, as of the end of each calendar quarter or
within 30 days thereafter no more than 55% of the total assets of a Portfolio
may be represented by any one investment, no more than 70% by any two
investments, no more than 80% by any three investments and no more than 90% by
any four investments. For this purpose, all securities of the same issuer are
considered a single investment, and each U.S. Government agency and
instrumentality is considered a separate issuer. Section 817(h) provides, as a
safe harbor, that a separate account will be treated as being adequately
diversified if the diversification requirements under Subchapter M are satisfied
and no more than 55% of the value of the account's total assets are cash and
cash items (including receivables), U.S. Government securities and securities of
other regulated investment companies. Failure by a Portfolio to both qualify as
a regulated investment company and satisfy the Section 817(h) requirements would
generally result in treatment of the variable contract holders other than as
described in the applicable variable contract prospectus, including inclusion in
ordinary income of income accrued under the contracts for the current and all
prior taxable years. Any such failure may also result in adverse tax
consequences for the insurance company issuing the contracts.

     The Trust may therefore find it necessary to take action to seek to ensure
that a Contract continues to qualify as a Contract under federal tax laws,
although the insurance company that maintains each segregated asset account is
responsible for ensuring that the assets held in that account satisfy the
diversification requirements of Section 817(h) of the Code and the applicable
regulations and the Trust itself can control only the assets held within the
Portfolios. The Trust, for example, may be required to alter the investment
objectives of a Portfolio or substitute the shares of one Portfolio for those of
another. No such change of investment objectives or substitution of securities
will take place without notice to the shareholders of the affected Portfolio.

     The Portfolios are not subject to Massachusetts corporate excise or
franchise tax. Provided that a Portfolio qualifies as a regulated investment
company under the Code, it will also not be required to pay any Massachusetts
income tax.

                                       21
<PAGE>
 
                    WRIGHT NEAR TERM BOND PORTFOLIO (WNTBP)
                           PORTFOLIO OF INVESTMENTS
                               December 31, 1995

<TABLE> 
<CAPTION> 
====================================================================================================================
Face                                           Coupon    Maturity      Market                  Current   Yield To
Amount       Description                        Rate       Date         Price        Value     Yield(1)  Maturity(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>          <C>                               <C>       <C>          <C>         <C>          <C>       <C>
$  30,000    U.S. Treasury Bill                5.260%     2/22/96     $ 98.960     $ 29,688     5.32%     12.50%
   65,000    U.S. Treasury Note                5.625%     8/31/97      100.641       65,417     5.59%      5.21%
   40,000    Federal Nat l. Mortgage Assoc.    7.000%     8/11/99      102.422       40,969     6.83%      6.24%
   50,000    Federal Farm Credit Bank          8.650%    10/01/99      110.422       55,211     7.83%      5.53%
   50,000    Federal Home Loan Banks           7.780%     2/03/00      108.031       54,016     7.20%      5.56%
   40,000    Student Loan Marketing Assoc.     7.500%     3/08/00      107.125       42,850     7.00%      5.57%
                                                                                   --------
Total Investments (identified cost, $277,042) -- 88.2%                             $288,151     6.68%      6.29%
                                                                                                =====      =====
Other Assets, less Liabilities -- 11.8%                                              38,413
                                                                                   --------
Net Assets -- 100.0%                                                               $326,564
                                                                                   ========
Average Maturity -- 3.0 Years(1)
</TABLE> 

(1) Unaudited.


See notes to financial statements

                                       22
<PAGE>
 
                        WRIGHT NEAR TERM BOND PORTFOLIO

================================================================================
                      STATEMENT OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

                               December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

ASSETS:
<S>                                                                 <C>
  Investments --
    Identified cost..............................................   $277,042
    Unrealized appreciation......................................     11,109
                                                                    --------
     Total value (Note 1A).......................................   $288,151

  Cash...........................................................      3,318
  Interest receivable............................................      6,029
  Deferred organizational costs (Note 1D)........................      5,282
  Receivable from Investment Adviser.............................     29,915
                                                                    --------
     Total Assets................................................   $332,695
                                                                    --------

LIABILITIES:
  Payable for Fund shares reacquired.............................   $    257
  Trustees fees payable..........................................        335
  Custodian fee payable (Note 3).................................      1,300
  Accrued expenses...............................................      4,239
                                                                    --------
     Total Liabilities...........................................   $  6,131
                                                                    --------
NET ASSETS.......................................................   $326,564
                                                                    ========

NET ASSETS CONSIST OF:

Paid-in capital..................................................   $330,490
Accumulated net realized loss on investment
 transactions....................................................    (15,035)
Unrealized appreciation of investments...........................     11,109
                                                                    --------
Net assets applicable to outstanding shares......................   $326,564
                                                                    ========
SHARES OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST
 OUTSTANDING.....................................................     33,060
                                                                    ========
NET ASSET VALUE, OFFERING PRICE,
 AND REDEMPTION PRICE PER SHARE
 OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST..........................................     $ 9.88
                                                                    ========
</TABLE>

================================================================================
                            STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

                     For the Year Ended December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

INVESTMENT INCOME:
<S>                                                                 <C>
Income --
  Interest.......................................................   $ 19,133
                                                                    --------

Expenses --
  Investment Adviser fee (Note 3)................................   $  1,563
  Administrator fee (Note 3).....................................        174
  Compensation of Trustee not affiliated with
   the Investment Adviser or Administrator.......................      2,282
  Transfer and dividend disbursing agent fees....................        725
  Custodian fee (Note 3).........................................     18,261
  Amortization of organization expense
   (Note 1D).....................................................      1,748
  Audit..........................................................      6,753
  Legal..........................................................      2,223
  Printing.......................................................      1,010
  Registration costs.............................................         74
  Miscellaneous..................................................      1,681
                                                                    --------
     Total expenses..............................................   $ 36,494
                                                                    --------


Deduct --
  Reduction of Custodian fee.....................................   $  1,712
  Reduction of Investment Adviser fee............................      1,563
  Reduction of Administrator fee.................................        174
  Allocation of expense to the Investment Adviser................     29,915
                                                                    --------
     Total deducted..............................................   $ 33,364
                                                                    --------
     Net expenses................................................   $  3,130
                                                                    --------
        Net investment income....................................   $ 16,003
                                                                    --------


REALIZED AND UNREALIZED GAIN (LOSS):

Net realized loss on investment transactions.....................   $ (9,163)
Change in unrealized appreciation of investments.................     29,353
                                                                    --------
  Net realized and unrealized gain...............................   $ 20,190
                                                                    --------
  Net increase in net assets from operations.....................   $ 36,193
                                                                    ========
</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements

                                       23
<PAGE>
 
                        WRIGHT NEAR TERM BOND PORTFOLIO

================================================================================

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                                           For the Period from
                                                                           Year               January 6, 1994
                                                                           Ended          (start of business) to
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS                                  December 31, 1995       December 31, 1994
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<S>                                                                  <C>                  <C>
INCREASE (DECREASE) IN NET ASSETS:

From operations --
  Net investment income.............................................     $  16,003              $  14,658
  Net realized loss on investment transactions......................        (9,163)                (5,872)
  Change in unrealized appreciation of investments..................        29,353                (18,244)
                                                                         ---------              ---------

     Increase (decrease) in net assets from operations..............     $  36,193              $  (9,458)

Distributions to shareholders from net investment income (Note 2)...       (16,003)               (14,658)
Net increase (decrease) from fund share transactions (Note 4).......      (145,114)               475,604
                                                                         ---------              ---------

     Net increase (decrease) in net assets..........................     $(124,924)             $ 451,488

NET ASSETS:

  At beginning of year..............................................       451,488                     --
                                                                         ---------              ---------

  At end of year....................................................     $ 326,564              $ 451,488
                                                                         =========              =========
</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements

                                       24
<PAGE>
 
                  WRIGHT TOTAL RETURN BOND PORTFOLIO (WTRBP)
                           PORTFOLIO OF INVESTMENTS
                               December 31, 1995

<TABLE> 
<CAPTION> 
====================================================================================================================
Face                                           Coupon    Maturity      Market                  Current   Yield To
Amount       Description                        Rate       Date         Price        Value     Yield(1)  Maturity(1)
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>          <C>                               <C>       <C>          <C>         <C>          <C>       <C>
$ 50,000     Federal Farm Credit Bank          5.270%     2/01/99     $ 98.844    $ 49,422     5.33%     5.68%
  50,000     Federal Home Loan Bank            7.780%     2/03/00      108.031      54,016     7.20%     5.56%
  50,000     Tennessee Valley Authority        6.125%     7/15/03      100.187      50,093     6.11%     6.09%
  50,000     U.S. Treasury Note                5.750%     8/15/03      101.203      50,602     5.68%     5.55%
  50,000     Federal National Mortgage Assoc.  7.490%     3/02/05      108.310      54,155     6.92%     6.28%
 125,000     U.S. Treasury Note                5.875%    11/15/05      102.250     127,812     5.75%     5.57%
  20,000     AT&T Corp.                        7.750%     3/01/07      112.386      22,477     6.90%     6.20%
  50,000     U.S. Treasury Bond                7.500%    11/15/16      117.250      58,625     6.40%     6.03%
                                                                                 ---------

Total Investments (identified cost, $441,117) -- 86.9%                           $ 467,202     6.18%     5.81%
                                                                                               =====     =====
Other Assets, less Liabilities -- 13.1%                                             70,480
                                                                                 ---------
Net Assets -- 100.0%                                                             $ 537,682
                                                                                 =========
Average Maturity -- 9.4 Years(1)
</TABLE> 

(1) Unaudited.


See notes to financial statements

                                       25
<PAGE>
 
                      WRIGHT TOTAL RETURN BOND PORTFOLIO

================================================================================
                      STATEMENT OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

                               December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

ASSETS:
<S>                                                                 <C>

  Investments --
    Identified cost..............................................   $441,117
    Unrealized appreciation......................................     26,085
                                                                    --------
     Total value (Note 1A).......................................   $467,202

  Cash...........................................................     35,280
  Interest receivable............................................      8,383
  Deferred organizational costs (Note 1D)........................      5,153
  Receivable from Investment Adviser.............................     27,941
                                                                    --------
     Total Assets................................................   $543,959
                                                                    --------


LIABILITIES:
  Payable for Fund shares reacquired.............................   $    402
  Trustees fees payable..........................................        335
  Custodian fee payable (Note 3).................................      1,300
  Accrued expenses...............................................      4,240
                                                                    --------
     Total Liabilities...........................................   $  6,277
                                                                    --------
NET ASSETS.......................................................   $537,682
                                                                    ========


NET ASSETS CONSIST OF:

Paid-in capital..................................................   $526,131
Accumulated net realized loss on investment
 transactions....................................................    (14,534)
Unrealized appreciation of investments...........................     26,085
                                                                    --------
  Net assets applicable to outstanding shares....................   $537,682
                                                                    ========
SHARES OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST
 OUTSTANDING.....................................................     54,676
                                                                    ========
NET ASSET VALUE, OFFERING PRICE,
 AND REDEMPTION PRICE PER SHARE
 OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST..........................................   $   9.83
                                                                    ========
</TABLE>

================================================================================
                            STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

                     For the Year Ended December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

INVESTMENT INCOME:
<S>                                                                 <C>

Income --
  Interest                                                          $ 27,053
                                                                    --------

Expenses --
  Investment Adviser fee (Note 3)................................   $  2,034
  Administrator fee (Note 3).....................................        226
  Amortization of organization expense
   (Note 1D).....................................................      1,738
  Compensation of Trustees not affiliated with
   the Investment Adviser or Administrator.......................      2,282
  Custodian fee..................................................     19,138
  Audit services.................................................      6,753
  Legal..........................................................      2,223
  Transfer and dividend disbursing agent fees....................        725
  Printing.......................................................      1,010
  Registration costs.............................................         50
  Miscellaneous..................................................      1,683
                                                                    --------
     Total expenses..............................................   $ 37,862
                                                                    --------

Deduct --
  Reduction of Custodian fee.....................................   $  1,655
  Reduction of Investment Adviser fee............................      2,034
  Reduction of Administrator fee.................................        226
  Allocation of expense to the Investment Adviser................     29,886
                                                                    --------
     Total deducted..............................................   $ 33,801
                                                                    --------
     Net expenses................................................   $  4,061
                                                                    --------
        Net investment income....................................   $ 22,992
                                                                    --------

REALIZED AND UNREALIZED GAIN (LOSS):
Net realized loss on investment transactions.....................   $(13,757)
Change in unrealized appreciation of investments.................     65,400
                                                                    --------
  Net realized and unrealized gain...............................   $ 51,643
                                                                    --------
  Net increase in net assets from operations.....................   $ 74,635
                                                                    ========
</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements

                                       26
<PAGE>
 
                      WRIGHT TOTAL RETURN BOND PORTFOLIO

================================================================================

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                                                         Year                  Year
                                                                         Ended                 Ended
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS                                 December 31, 1995     December 31, 1994
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------


<S>                                                                 <C>                   <C>
INCREASE (DECREASE) IN NET ASSETS:

From operations --
  Net investment income...............................................   $ 22,992              $ 18,595
  Net realized loss on investment transactions........................    (13,757)                 (777)
  Change in unrealized appreciation of investments....................     65,400               (38,541)
                                                                         --------              --------

     Increase (decrease) in net assets from operations................   $ 74,635              $(20,723)

  Distributions to shareholders from net investment income (Note 2)...    (22,992)              (18,595)
  Net increase (decrease) from fund share transactions (Note 4).......    (34,344)              392,475
                                                                         --------              --------

     Net increase in net assets.......................................   $ 17,299              $353,157


NET ASSETS:

  At beginning of year................................................    520,383               167,226
                                                                         --------              --------
  At end of year......................................................   $537,682              $520,383
                                                                         ========              ========
</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements

                                       27
<PAGE>
 
                  WRIGHT SELECTED BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO (WSBCP)
                           PORTFOLIO OF INVESTMENTS
                               December 31, 1995

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
================================================================================

                                               Shares                Value
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                            <C>                 <C>
                           Equity Interests -- 87.0%

APPAREL -- 4.3%
Reebok International Ltd.................      1,500               $ 42,375
Russell Corporation......................        400                 11,100
VF Corp..................................        800                 42,200
                                                                   --------
                                                                   $ 95,675
                                                                   --------

AUTOMOTIVE -- 4.9%
Eaton Corporation........................        700               $ 37,538
Echlin Inc...............................      1,100                 40,150
Modine Manufacturing Co..................      1,300                 31,200
                                                                   --------
                                                                   $108,888
                                                                   --------

BEVERAGES -- 1.7%
Anheuser-Busch Companies.................        300               $ 20,062
Brown-Forman Corp........................        500                 18,250
                                                                   --------
                                                                   $ 38,312
                                                                   --------

CHEMICALS -- 6.5%
Clorox Company...........................        300               $ 21,488
Lubrizol Corporation (The)...............        400                 11,150
Morton International Inc.................      1,000                 35,875
PPG Industries, Incorporated.............        900                 41,175
Rohm & Haas Company......................        300                 19,312
Sherwin-Williams Company.................        400                 16,300
                                                                   --------
                                                                   $145,300
                                                                   --------

CONSTRUCTION -- 1.7%
Fleetwood Enterprises, Inc...............      1,500               $ 38,625
                                                                   --------

DIVERSIFIED -- 5.4%
Crane Co.................................      1,200               $ 44,250
Johnson Controls, Inc....................        300                 20,625
National Service Industries..............        500                 16,188
Rockwell International Corp..............        400                 21,150
Standex International Corp...............        600                 19,650
                                                                   --------
                                                                   $121,863
                                                                   --------

DRUGS, COSMETICS & HEALTH CARE -- 5.9%
Alberto Culver Company...................      1,200               $ 36,600
Bard (C.R.) Inc..........................        500                 16,125
Becton Dickinson & Co....................        400                 30,000
Bristol-Myers Squibb Co..................        300                 25,763
Lilly (Eli) & Co.........................        400                 22,500
                                                                   --------
                                                                   $130,988
                                                                   --------

ELECTRONICS -- 4.4%
Hewlett-Packard Co.......................        400               $ 33,500
Raytheon Company.........................        600                 28,350
Sun Microsystems, Inc.*..................        800                 36,500
                                                                   --------
                                                                   $ 98,350
                                                                   --------

FINANCIAL: BANKS -- 9.6%
Bancorp Hawaii, Inc......................      1,100               $ 39,463
Commerce Bancshares......................        441                 16,868
Compass Bancshares, Inc..................        700                 23,100
First Hawaiian, Inc*.....................      1,100                 33,000
First Virginia Banks, Inc................        400                 16,700
Southern National Corp...................        700                 18,375
Southtrust Corp..........................        900                 23,062
Star Banc Corp...........................        400                 23,800
Suntrust Banks, Inc......................        300                 20,550
                                                                   --------
                                                                   $214,918
                                                                   --------

FINANCIAL: REAL ESTATE & OTHER -- 6.2%
AFLAC Incorporated.......................        400               $ 17,350
Edwards A.G. Inc.........................        800                 19,100
</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements

                                       28
<PAGE>
 
                  WRIGHT SELECTED BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO (WSBCP)
                     PORTFOLIO OF INVESTMENTS - continued
                               December 31, 1995

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
================================================================================

                                               Shares                Value
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                            <C>                 <C>
FINANCIAL: REAL ESTATE & OTHER -- continued
First Colony Corp..........................    1,500                 38,063
Jefferson Pilot Corporation................      450                 20,925
MBIA, Inc..................................      300                 22,500
Raymond James Financial....................    1,000                 21,125
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $139,063
                                                                   --------

FOOD -- 2.5%
Dean Foods Company.........................      400               $ 11,000
Universal Foods Corp.......................    1,100                 44,138
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $ 55,138
                                                                   --------

MACHINERY & EQUIPMENT -- 1.8%
Briggs & Stratton Corp.....................      600               $ 26,025
Dover Corporation..........................      400                 14,750
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $ 40,775
                                                                   --------

METAL PRODUCTS MANUFACTURERS -- 3.8%
CLARCOR....................................    2,000               $ 40,750
Kaydon Corporation.........................      800                 24,300
Stanley Works (The)........................      400                 20,600
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $ 85,650
                                                                   --------

OIL, GAS, COAL & RELATED SERVICES -- 0.7%
Exxon Corporation..........................      200               $ 16,025
                                                                   --------

PRINTING & PUBLISHING -- 7.0%
Banta Corporation..........................      400               $ 17,600
Ennis Business Forms.......................    1,100                 13,475
Gannett Company, Inc.......................      300                 18,412
Harland (John H.) Co.......................    1,600                 33,400
Lee Enterprises............................    1,000                 23,000
Reynolds & Reynolds........................      600                 23,325
Wallace Computer Services..................      500                 27,312
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $156,524
                                                                   --------

RECREATION -- 3.9%
International Dairy Queen*.................    1,700               $ 38,675
Luby's Cafeterias Inc......................      700                 15,575
Sturm Ruger & Company, Inc.................    1,200                 32,850
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $ 87,100
                                                                   --------

RETAILERS -- 4.4%
Claire's Stores Inc........................    2,200               $ 38,775
Dress Barn (The)*..........................    1,400                 13,825
May Department Stores......................      500                 21,125
Ross Stores, Inc...........................    1,300                 24,862
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $ 98,587
                                                                   --------

UTILITIES - COMMUNICATION -- 2.9%
Ameritech Corporation......................      400               $ 23,600
Lincoln Telecommunications.................    1,000                 21,125
Sprint Corporation.........................      500                 19,937
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $ 64,662
                                                                   --------

UTILITIES - ELECTRIC POWER -- 5.8%
DQE Inc....................................      900               $ 27,675
Duke Power Company.........................      900                 42,638
Nipsco Industries..........................    1,100                 42,075
Wisconsin Energy...........................      600                 18,375
                                                                   --------

                                                                   $130,763
                                                                   --------
</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements

                                       29
<PAGE>
 
                  WRIGHT SELECTED BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO (WSBCP)
                     PORTFOLIO OF INVESTMENTS - continued
                               December 31, 1995

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
================================================================================

                                               Shares                Value
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                            <C>                 <C>
MISCELLANEOUS -- 3.6%
Dionex Corporation*......................        400               $   22,700
Marshall Industries*.....................        800                   25,700
Stanhome Inc.............................      1,100                   32,038
                                                                   ----------

                                                                   $   80,438
                                                                   ----------

TOTAL EQUITY INTERESTS -- 87.0%
(identified cost, $1,673,532)                                      $1,947,644

OTHER ASSETS
LESS LIABILITIES -- 13.0%                                             291,186
                                                                   ----------

NET ASSETS -- 100.0%                                               $2,238,830
                                                                   ==========
</TABLE>


* Non-income-producing security.


See notes to financial statements

                                       30
<PAGE>
 
                      WRIGHT SELECTED BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO

================================================================================
                      STATEMENT OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

                               December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

ASSETS:
<S>                                                                 <C>
  Investments --
    Identified cost..............................................   $1,673,532
    Unrealized appreciation......................................      274,112
                                                                    ----------
     Total value (Note 1A).......................................   $1,947,644

  Cash...........................................................      282,483
  Dividends receivable...........................................        3,518
  Deferred organizational costs (Note 1D)........................        5,287
  Receivable from Investment Adviser.............................        7,494
                                                                    ----------

     Total Assets................................................   $2,246,426
                                                                    ----------

LIABILITIES:
  Payable for Fund shares reacquired.............................   $    1,722
  Trustees fees payable..........................................          335
  Custodian fee payable (Note 3).................................        1,300
  Accrued expenses...............................................        4,239
                                                                    ----------

     Total Liabilities...........................................   $    7,596
                                                                    ----------

NET ASSETS.......................................................   $2,238,830
                                                                    ==========

NET ASSETS CONSIST OF:

Paid-in capital..................................................   $1,955,545
Undistributed net investment income..............................        9,173
Unrealized appreciation of investments...........................      274,112
                                                                    ----------

  Net assets applicable to outstanding shares....................   $2,238,830
                                                                    ==========

SHARES OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST
 OUTSTANDING.....................................................      196,276
                                                                    ==========

NET ASSET VALUE, OFFERING PRICE,
 AND REDEMPTION PRICE PER SHARE
 OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST..........................................       $11.41
                                                                    ==========
</TABLE>

================================================================================
                            STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

                     For the Year Ended December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
INVESTMENT INCOME
<S>                                                                 <C>

Income --
Dividends........................................................   $   36,987
                                                                    ----------
                                                                             
Expenses --                                                                  
  Investment Adviser fee (Note 3)................................   $   11,367
  Administrator fee (Note 3).....................................          874
  Amortization of organization expense                                       
    (Note 1D)....................................................        1,748
  Compensation of Trustees not affiliated with                               
   the Investment Adviser or Administrator.......................        2,282
  Custodian fee (Note 3).........................................       20,193
  Audit..........................................................        5,450
  Legal..........................................................        2,228
  Transfer and dividend disbursing agent fees....................          725
  Printing.......................................................        1,010
  Registration costs.............................................           62
  Interest expense...............................................           56
  Miscellaneous..................................................        1,661
                                                                    ----------
                                                                             
      Total expenses.............................................   $   47,656
                                                                    ----------
                                                                             
                                                                             
Deduct --                                                                    
  Reduction of Custodian fee.....................................   $    7,796
  Reduction of Investment Adviser fee............................       11,367
  Reduction of Administrator fee.................................          874
  Allocation of expense to the Investment Adviser................        7,494
                                                                    ----------
       Total deducted............................................   $   27,531
                                                                    ----------
                                                                             
       Net expenses..............................................   $   20,125
                                                                    ----------
          Net investment income..................................   $   16,862
                                                                    ----------

REALIZED AND UNREALIZED GAIN:

Net realized gain on investment transactions.....................   $   79,060
Change in unrealized appreciation of investments.................      300,016
                                                                    ----------
  Net realized and unrealized gain...............................   $  379,076
                                                                    ----------
  Net increase in net assets from operations.....................   $  395,938
                                                                    ==========
</TABLE>

See notes to financial statements

                                       31
<PAGE>
 
                      WRIGHT SELECTED BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO

<TABLE>  
<CAPTION> 
==========================================================================================================

                                                                                    For the Period from  
                                                                     Year             January 6, 1994    
                                                                     Ended         (start of business) to
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS                            December 31, 1995     December 31, 1994   
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                            <C>                 <C> 



INCREASE (DECREASE) IN NET ASSETS:
 
  From operations --
    Net investment income.......................................  $   16,862             $    9,806
    Net realized gain (loss) on investment transactions.........      79,060                (24,751)
    Change in unrealized appreciation of investments............     300,016                (25,904)
                                                                  ----------             ----------

       Increase (decrease) in net assets from operations........  $  395,938             $  (40,849)

Distributions to shareholders from net investment income........     (13,333)                (9,294)
Distributions to shareholders from net realized gain on
  investment transactions.......................................     (54,284)                 --
Undistributed net investment income included in price of
  shares sold and redeemed (Note 1E)............................       3,662                  4,501
Net increase from fund share transactions (exclusive of
  amounts allocated to net investment income) (Note 4)..........     454,382              1,498,107
                                                                  ----------             ----------

       Net increase in net assets...............................  $  786,365             $1,452,465


NET ASSETS:

  At beginning of year..........................................   1,452,465                  --
                                                                  ----------             ----------

  At end of year................................................  $2,238,830             $1,452,465
                                                                  ==========             ==========

UNDISTRIBUTED NET INVESTMENT INCOME
  INCLUDED IN NET ASSETS........................................  $    9,173             $    5,013
                                                                  ==========             ==========  
</TABLE>

See notes to financial statements

                                       32
<PAGE>
 
               WRIGHT INTERNATIONAL BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO (WIBCP)
                           PORTFOLIO OF INVESTMENTS
                               December 31, 1995

================================================================================

                                                        Shares          Value
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
[S]                                                     [C]          [C]     
                           Equity Interests -- 86.5%


AUSTRALIA --3.2%
Broken Hill Proprietary (ADR).......................       350       $   19,775
F.H. Faulding (ADR).................................     1,320           23,566
                                                                     __________
                                                    
                                                                     $   43,341
                                                                     __________
                                                    
BELGIUM --2.0%                                      
Colruyt SA *........................................       100       $   27,013
                                                                     __________
                                                    
CANADA -- 1.2%                                      
Corel Systems Corp*.................................     1,300       $   16,900
                                                                     __________
                                                    
DENMARK -- 1.1%                                     
ISS Int'l. Service Systems*.........................       640       $   14,383
                                                                     ----------
                                                    
FRANCE -- 4.4%                                      
L'Oreal (ADR).......................................       360       $   19,302
Legrand SA *........................................       130           20,030
LVMH Moet-Hennessy                                  
  Louis Vuitton.....................................       500           20,938
                                                                     ----------
                                                                     $   60,270
                                                                     ----------
                                                    
GERMANY -- 1.5%                                     
Bayerische Motoren Werke*...........................        40       $   20,467
                                                                     ----------
                                                    
HONG KONG -- 7.2%                                   
Hang Lung Devel. Co. (ADR)..........................     2,700       $   21,476
Hong Kong Aircraft Engineering*.....................     5,600           14,482
Hong Kong & China Gas Co. (ADR).....................    12,238           19,706
Hong Kong Electric Hold. (ADR)......................     5,700           18,688
Swire Pacific Limited (ADR).........................     3,100           24,056
                                                                     ----------
                                                                     $   98,408
                                                                     __________
                                                    
IRELAND -- 1.8%                                     
Greencore PLC*......................................     2,750       $   24,661
                                                                     __________

ITALY -- 1.4%                                       
Sirti SpA*..........................................     3,500       $   19,678
                                                                     __________
                                                    
JAPAN -- 9.8%                                       
Kurita Water Industries Ltd.*.......................     1,000           26,596
Nintendo Corp. Ltd. (ADR)*..........................     2,800           26,635
Santen Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. *...................     1,000           22,727
Seven Eleven Japan..................................       330           23,290
Yurtec Corporation *................................     2,000           35,010
                                                                     ----------
                                                                     $  134,258
                                                                     ----------
                                                    
MALAYSIA -- 4.1%                                    
Amalgamated Industrial Steel*.......................    19,200       $   14,292
Genting Berhad (ADR)................................     2,000           16,700
Perlis Plantations Berhad (ADR).....................     8,000           25,049
                                                                     ----------
                                                                     $   56,041
                                                                     ----------
                                                    
MEXICO -- 3.4%                                      
Cifra SA............................................     9,400       $    9,880
Kimberly Clark de Mexico............................       700           21,169
Telefonos de Mexico.................................       500           15,938
                                                                     ----------
                                                                     $   46,987
                                                                     ----------
                                                    
NETHERLANDS -- 10.4%                                
Elsevier (ADR)......................................       750       $   19,969
Koninklijke Ahold (ADR)*............................       800           32,900
NV Verenigd Bezit VNU*..............................       250           34,248
Unilever NV.........................................       200           28,150
Wolters Kluwer (ADR)*...............................       280           26,516
                                                                     ----------
                                                                     $  141,783
                                                                     ----------
                                                    
NEW ZEALAND -- 1.5%                                 
Wilson & Horton Limited *...........................     3,300      $    19,731
                                                                    -----------
                                                    
SINGAPORE -- 1.6%                                   
Singapore Press Holdings *..........................     1,200      $    21,211
                                                                    ___________

See notes to financial statements  

                                       33
<PAGE>
 
               WRIGHT INTERNATIONAL BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO (WIBCP)
                           PORTFOLIO OF INVESTMENTS
                               December 31, 1995

================================================================================

                                                        Shares          Value
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
[S]                                                     [C]        [C]     

SOUTH AFRICA -- 2.2%
South Arican Breweries Limited......................       800     $     29,296
                                                                   ____________

SPAIN -- 3.7%
Empresa Nacional de Electricidad
(ADR)...............................................       500     $     28,625
Repsol S.A. *.......................................       650           21,248
                                                                   ____________
                                                                   $     49,873
                                                                   ____________

SWEDEN -- 5.0%
Astra AB............................................     1,240     $     49,124
H & M Hennes & Mauritz AB*..........................       350           19,507
                                                                   ____________
                                                                   $     68,631
                                                                   ____________

SWITZERLAND -- 3.6%
Nestles (ADR).......................................       400     $     22,179
Sandoz (ADR)........................................       600           27,532
                                                                   ____________
                                                                   $     49,711
                                                                   ____________

UNITED KINGDOM -- 17.4%
Cable & Wireless (ADR)..............................     1,030     $     21,759
Christian Salvesen (ADR) *..........................     1,130           23,202
Farnell Electronics*................................     2,000           22,316
Halma*..............................................     9,866           26,813
Kwik Save Group *...................................     2,800           21,742
Marks & Spencer (ADR)...............................       700           29,344
Polypipe PLC *......................................     8,000           21,866
Scapa Group PLC *...................................     6,000           20,686
Tesco (ADR).........................................     4,400           20,289
Wolseley *..........................................     4,200           29,417
                                                                   ------------
                                                                   $    237,434
                                                                   ____________

TOTAL EQUITY INTERESTS -- 86.5%
(identified cost, $1,121,967).......................               $  1,180,077


OTHER ASSETS
LESS LIABILITIES -- 13.5%...........................                    184,794
                                                                   ____________



NET ASSETS -- 100.0%................................               $  1,364,871
                                                                   ============

* Non-income-producing security.

ADR - American Depositary Receipt

See notes to financial statements  

                                       34
<PAGE>
 
               WRIGHT INTERNATIONAL BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO (WIBCP)

================================================================================

                      STATEMENT OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES

                               December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<TABLE>

<S>                                                         <C>  
ASSETS:
 
   Investments --
     Identified cost.....................................   $1,121,967
     Unrealized appreciation.............................       58,110
                                                            ----------
       Total value (Note 1A).............................   $1,180,077

     Cash................................................      194,138
     Dividends receivable................................        2,055
     Deferred organizational costs (Note 1D).............        5,282
     Receivable from Investment Adviser..................       10,726
     Receivable for foreign taxes withheld...............          110
                                                            ----------
       Total assets......................................   $1,392,388
                                                            ----------

   LIABILITIES:
     Payable for Fund shares reacquired..................   $    1,039
     Payable for investments purchased...................       20,603
     Trustees fees payable...............................          335
     Custodian fee payable (Note 3)......................        1,300
     Accrued expenses....................................        4,240
                                                            ----------
       Total liabilities.................................   $   27,517
                                                            ----------

   NET ASSETS............................................   $1,364,871 
                                                            ==========          
   NET ASSETS CONSIST OF:

   Paid-in capital.......................................   $1,307,506
   Accumulated net realized loss on investment
     transactions........................................       (3,656)
   Undistributed net investment income...................        2,946
   Unrealized appreciation of investments and
     foreign currency....................................       58,075
                                                            ----------

     Net assets applicable to outstanding shares.........   $1,364,871
                                                            ==========

   SHARES OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST
     OUTSTANDING.........................................      135,715
                                                            ==========
   NET ASSET VALUE, OFFERING PRICE,
     AND REDEMPTION PRICE PER SHARE
     OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST..............................       $10.06
                                                            ==========
</TABLE> 

================================================================================

                            STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS

                     For the Year Ended December 31, 1995
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------

<TABLE>

<S>                                                         <C>   
INVESTMENT INCOME:
 
Income --
  Dividends..............................................   $   26,086
  Less: Foreign taxes....................................       (2,893)
                                                            ----------
    Gross income.........................................   $   23,193
                                                            ----------
Expenses --
  Investment Adviser fee (Note 3)........................   $    9,690
  Administrator fee (Note 3).............................          606
  Amortization of organization expense
   (Note 1D).............................................        1,749
  Compensation of Trustees not affiliated with
   the Investment Adviser or Administrator...............        2,282
  Custodian fee (Note 3).................................       25,149
  Audit..................................................        5,450
  Legal..................................................        2,226
  Transfer and dividend disbursing agent fees............          725
  Printing...............................................        1,010
  Registration costs.....................................           94
  Interest expense.......................................           50
  Miscellaneous..........................................        1,659
                                                            ----------
       Total expenses....................................   $   50,690
                                                            ----------

Deduct --
  Reduction of Custodian fee.............................   $    5,143
  Reduction of Investment Adviser fee....................        9,690
  Reduction of Administrator fee.........................          606
  Allocation of expense to the Investment Adviser........       12,813
                                                            ----------
       Total deducted....................................   $   28,252
                                                            ----------
       Net expenses......................................   $   22,438
                                                            ----------
          Net investment income..........................   $      755
                                                            ----------

REALIZED AND UNREALIZED GAIN (LOSS):

Net realized loss on investment transactions.............   $   (3,923)
Change in unrealized appreciation of investments
  and foreign currency...................................      130,826
                                                            ----------

  Net realized and unrealized gain.......................   $  126,903
                                                            ----------
  Net increase in net assets from operations.............   $  127,658
                                                            ==========
</TABLE>

See notes to financial statements

                                       35
<PAGE>
 
                   WRIGHT INTERNATIONAL BLUE CHIP PORTFOLIO

<TABLE>  
<CAPTION> 
==========================================================================================================

                                                                                    For the Period from  
                                                                     Year             January 6, 1994    
                                                                     Ended         (start of business) to
STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS                            December 31, 1995     December 31, 1994   
- ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                            <C>                 <C> 



INCREASE (DECREASE) IN NET ASSETS:
 
  From operations --
    Net investment income...................................        $      755            $    1,299
    Net realized loss on investments........................            (3,923)                  --
    Change in unrealized appreciation of investments
     and foreign currency...................................           130,826               (72,751)
                                                                    ----------            ----------

     Increase (decrease) in net assets from operations......        $  127,658            $  (71,452)

  Undistributed net investment income included in
    price of shares sold and redeemed (Note 1E).............              (344)                2,907
  Distributions to shareholders from net investment income..            (2,477)                 (673)
  Tax distribution from paid-in capital.....................            (4,280)                  --
  Net increase (decrease) from fund share transactions
    (exclusive of amounts allocated to net investment income)
    (Note 4)................................................            15,368             1,298,164
                                                                    ----------            ----------

       Net increase in net assets...........................        $  135,925            $1,228,946


NET ASSETS:

  At beginning of year......................................         1,228,946                    --
                                                                    ----------            ----------
  At end of year............................................        $1,364,871            $1,228,946
                                                                    ==========            ==========
                                                                                                    
UNDISTRIBUTED (DISTRIBUTIONS IN EXCESS OF) NET                                                      
INVESTMENT INCOME INCLUDED IN NET ASSETS....................        $   (2,946)           $    3,533
                                                                    ==========            ========== 
</TABLE>

See notes to financial statements

                                       36
<PAGE>
 
                     WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST
                         NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

  ==========================================================================

(1)  SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

     The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust (the "Trust") is registered under
the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, as an open-end, management
investment company. The Trust presently consists of four diversified separate
portfolios: Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio (WNTBP), Wright Total Return Bond
Portfolio (WTRBP), Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio (WSBCP), and Wright
International Blue Chip Portfolio (WIBCP) (the "Portfolios"). The shares of the
Portfolios are sold only to variable accounts established by PFL Life Insurance
Company and other participating insurance companies. The following is a summary
of significant accounting policies consistently followed by the Trust in the
preparation of its financial statements. The policies are in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles.

     A.  Investment Valuations -- Securities, other than fixed-income
         investments, listed on securities exchanges or in the NASDAQ National
         Market, are valued at closing sale prices. Unlisted or listed
         securities for which closing sale prices are not available are valued
         at the last reported bid price. Fixed income investments (other than
         short-term obligations) including listed investments, and investments
         for which price quotations are available, will normally be valued on
         the basis of market valuations furnished by a pricing service.
         Investments for which valuations are not readily available will be
         appraised at their fair value as determined in good faith by or at the
         direction of the Trustees. Short-term obligations maturing in sixty
         days or less are valued at amortized cost, which approximates value.

     B.  Foreign Currency Translation -- Investment security valuations, other
         assets, and liabilities initially expressed in foreign currencies are
         translated each business day into U.S. dollars based upon current
         exchange rates. Purchases and sales of foreign investment securities
         and income and expenses are translated into U.S. dollars based upon
         currency exchange rates prevailing on the respective dates of such
         transactions. The Trust does not isolate that portion of the results of
         operations resulting from changes in foreign exchange rates on
         investments from the fluctuations arising from changes in market prices
         of securities held. Such fluctuations are included with the net
         realized and unrealized gain or loss from investments.

     C.  Taxes -- The Trust's policy is to comply with the provisions of the
         Internal Revenue Code (the Code) available to regulated investment
         companies and distribute to shareholders each year all of its taxable
         income, including any net realized gain on investments. Accordingly, no
         provision for federal income tax is necessary. Withholding taxes on
         foreign dividends have been provided for in accordance with the Trust's
         understanding of the applicable country's tax rules and rates. At
         December 31, 1995, the Trust, for federal income tax purposes, had a
         capital loss carryover of $15,035 for WNTBP, $14,499 for WTRBP, and
         $3,656 for WIBCP, which will reduce taxable income arising from future
         net realized gain on investments, if any, to the extent permitted by
         the Code, and thus will reduce the amount of the distribution to
         shareholders which would otherwise be necessary to relieve the
         respective Fund of any liability for federal income or excise tax.

                                       37
<PAGE>
 
                     WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - continued

    ============================================================================

      Pursuant to the Code, such capital loss carryovers will expire as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
          12/31              WNTBP              WTRBP              WIBCP
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
          <S>                <C>                <C>               <C>
          2002               $ 5,872            $   641           $   --
 
          2003                 9,163             13,858             3,656
    ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

D.  Deferred Organization Expenses -- Costs incurred by the Portfolios in
    connection with their organization are being amortized on a straight line
    basis over five years from the date the Portfolio commenced operations.

E.  Equalization -- The Portfolios follow the accounting practice known as
    equalization by which a portion of the proceeds from sales and costs of
    redemptions of Portfolio shares, equivalent on a per-share basis to the
    amount of undistributed net investment income on the date of the
    transaction, is credited or charged to undistributed net investment income.
    As a result, undistributed net investment income per share is unaffected by
    sales or redemptions of Portfolio shares.

F.  Use of Estimates -- The preparation of financial statements in conformity
    with generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make
    estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and
    liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported amounts
    of revenue and expense during the reporting period. Actual results could
    differ from those estimates.

G.  Other -- Investment transactions are accounted for on a trade date basis.
    Interest income is determined on the basis of interest accrued and discount
    earned, adjusted for amortization of premium or accretion of discount on
    long-term debt securities when required for federal income tax purposes.
    Dividend income and distributions to shareholders are recorded on the ex-
    dividend date. However, if the ex-dividend date has passed, certain
    dividends from foreign securities are recorded as the Portfolios are
    informed of the ex-dividend date.

(2) DISTRIBUTIONS

    Dividends from investment income of WSBCP and WIBCP are expected to be
    declared annually. Dividends from investment income of WNTBP and WTRBP will
    be declared daily and paid monthly. However, the Trustees may decide to
    declare dividends at other intervals. All net realized long- or short-term
    capital gains of each Portfolio, if any, will be declared and distributed at
    least annually. All distributions will be distributed in the form of
    additional full and fractional shares of the Portfolios and not in cash.
    Differences in the recognition or classification of income between the
    financial statements and tax earnings and profits, which result in temporary
    overdistributions for financial statement purposes, are classified as
    distributions in excess of net investment income or accumulated net realized
    gains. Distributions in excess of tax basis earnings and profits are
    reported in the financial statements as a return of capital. Permanent
    differences between book and tax accounting treatments may result in
    reclassifications among various components of net assets.

                                       38
<PAGE>
 
                     WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - continued

     ===========================================================================

     During the period ended December 31, 1995, the following amounts were
reclassified due to differences between book and tax accounting created
primarily by the unavailability of a tax benefit for operating losses, deferral
of certain losses for tax purposes, and recharacterization of short-term gains
between net investment income and net realized capital gains.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                               Accumulated Undistributed Net    Undistributed
              Paid-in       Realized Gain (Loss) on Investment  Net Investment
              Capital        and Foreign Currency Transactions   Income (Loss)
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>              <C>        <C>                                 <C>
 
     WSBCP     $3,056                  ($25)                    ($3,031)
     WIBCP    ($1,746)                 $267                      $1,479
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

     These changes had no effect on the net assets per share.

(3)  INVESTMENT ADVISER FEE AND OTHER TRANSACTIONS WITH AFFILIATES

     The Trust has engaged Wright Investors' Service ("Wright") to perform
investment management, investment advisory, and other services ("Investment
Adviser"). For its services, Wright is compensated based upon a percentage of
average monthly net assets which rate is adjusted as average monthly net assets
exceed certain levels. The Trust also has engaged Eaton Vance Management ("Eaton
Vance" or "Administrator") to act as administrator of the Trust. Under the
Administration Agreement, Eaton Vance is responsible for managing the business
affairs of the Trust and is compensated based upon a percentage of average
monthly net assets which rate is reduced as average monthly net assets exceed
certain levels. For the year ended December 31, 1995, the effective annual rate
for advisory and administration charges for each Portfolio was as follows:

<TABLE> 
<CAPTION> 
 
                                                   WNTBP  WTRBP   WSBCP   WIBCP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                <C>    <C>     <C>     <C>  
     Investment Advisory                           0.45%  0.45%   0.65%   0.80%
     Administration                                0.05%  0.05%   0.05%   0.05%
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

     To enhance the net income of the Portfolios, Wright and Eaton Vance reduced
their fees and Wright was allocated a portion of each Portfolio's expenses as
follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
 
                                               WNTBP    WTRBP    WSBCP    WIBCP
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                           <C>      <C>      <C>      <C>
 
     Reduction of Investment Adviser fees     $ 1,563  $ 2,034  $11,367  $ 9,690
     Allocation of expense to the Investment
      Adviser                                  29,915   29,886    7,494   12,813
     Reduction of Administrator fees              174      226      874      606
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------
</TABLE>

     The Trust has engaged Investors Bank & Trust Company (IBT) to serve as
custodian and transfer agent of the Trust. Prior to November 10, 1995, IBT was
an affiliate of Eaton Vance. Pursuant to the agreement, IBT receives a fee
reduced by credits which are determined based on the average daily cash balances
the Trust maintains with IBT. All significant credit balances are reported as a
reduction of expenses in the Statement of Operations. Certain of the Trustees
and officers of the Trust are directors/trustees and/or officers of the above
organizations.

                                       39
<PAGE>
 
                     WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - continued

     ===========================================================================

(4)  SHARES OF BENEFICIAL INTEREST

     The Declaration of Trust permits the Trustees to issue an unlimited number
of full and fractional shares of beneficial interest (without par value).
Transactions in Portfolio shares were as follows:

<TABLE> 
<CAPTION> 
                                                   Year Ended                  Year Ended     
                                                December 31, 1995           December 31, 1994 
                                                -----------------           ----------------- 
                                              Shares         Amount       Shares         Amount
- -----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                        <C>            <C>          <C>           <C>      
                                                             
Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio(1) --
     Sales...............................     14,521      $ 141,824       97,510     $  945,206
     Issued to shareholders in payment of
       distributions declared............      1,644         15,922        1,542         14,658
     Redemptions.........................    (31,513)      (302,860)     (50,644)      (484,260)
                                           ---------      ---------    ---------     ----------

          Net increase (decrease)........    (15,348)     $(145,114)      48,408     $  475,604
                                           =========      =========    =========     ==========


Wright Total Return Bond Portfolio --
     Sales...............................     18,926      $ 183,434       81,960     $  762,268
     Issued to shareholders in payment
       of distributions declared.........      2,433         22,812        2,069         18,830
     Redemptions.........................    (25,529)      (240,590)     (42,018)      (388,623)
                                           ---------      ---------    ---------     ----------

          Net increase (decrease)........     (4,170)     $ (34,344)      42,011     $  392,475
                                           =========      =========    =========     ==========


Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio(1) --
     Sales...............................     74,735      $ 808,667      160,250     $1,538,743
     Issued to shareholders in payment
       of distributions declared.........      5,957         67,259        1,018          9,263
     Redemptions.........................    (40,303)      (421,544)      (5,381)       (49,899)
                                           ---------      ---------    ---------     ----------

          Net increase...................     40,389      $ 454,382      155,887     $1,498,107
                                           =========      =========    =========     ==========
</TABLE> 

                                       40
<PAGE>
 
                     WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - continued

  ==========================================================================

<TABLE> 
<CAPTION> 
                                                             Year Ended                  Year Ended     
                                                          December 31, 1995           December 31, 1994 
                                                          -----------------           ----------------- 
                                                        Shares         Amount       Shares         Amount
- ------------------------------------------------------- ----------------------------------------------------
<S>                                                  <C>            <C>          <C>           <C>       
 
Wright International Blue Chip Portfolio/1/  --
     Sales.........................................     46,535      $ 453,824      143,858        $1,388,265
     Issued to shareholders in payment of
       distributions declared......................        678          6,757           74               671
     Redemptions...................................    (46,025)      (445,213)      (9,405)          (90,772)
                                                     ---------      ---------    ---------        ----------

           Net increase............................      1,188      $  15,368      134,527        $1,298,164
                                                     =========      =========    =========        ==========

- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 
</TABLE>

(1) Period from January 6, 1994 (start of business) to December 31, 1994.


(5)    INVESTMENT TRANSACTIONS

     Purchases and sales and maturities of investments, other than short-term
obligations, for the year ended December 31,1995, were as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                       Wright            Wright               Wright                   Wright      
                                     Near Term        Total Return           Selected               International  
                                   Bond Portfolio    Bond Portfolio     Blue Chip Portfolio      Blue Chip Portfolio 
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                <C>               <C>                <C>                      <C>           
                                                                                                               
Purchases --
  Non-U.S. Gov't Obligations.....  $       --        $       19,900     $        1,114,038       $       330,166
                                   ==============    ==============     ==================       ===============
  U.S. Gov't Obligations.........  $      274,149    $      726,428     $           --           $        --
                                   ==============    ==============     ==================       ===============

Sales --
  Non-U.S. Gov't Obligations.....  $       --        $       --         $          972,260       $       446,508
                                   ==============    ==============     ==================       ===============
  U.S. Gov't Obligations.........  $      455,929    $      834,141     $           --           $        --
                                   ==============    ==============     ==================       ===============  
</TABLE>

                                       41
<PAGE>
 
                     WRIGHT MANAGED BLUE CHIP SERIES TRUST
                   NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS - continued

   =========================================================================

(6)  FEDERAL INCOME TAX BASIS OF INVESTMENT SECURITIES

     The cost and unrealized appreciation (depreciation) in value of the
investments owned at December 31, 1995, as computed on a federal income tax
basis, are as follows:

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
                                          Wright              Wright               Wright                  Wright         
                                         Near Term         Total Return           Selected              International   
                                       Bond Portfolio     Bond Portfolio     Blue Chip Portfolio     Blue Chip Portfolio
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------
<S>                                    <C>                <C>                <C>                     <C>
                                                                                                                       
Aggregate Cost......................   $      277,042     $      441,152      $      1,673,532         $     1,121,967
                                       ==============     ==============      ================         ===============
Gross unrealized appreciation.......   $       11,109     $       26,050      $        305,122         $       133,522
Gross unrealized depreciation.......              --                 --                (31,010)                (75,412)
                                       --------------     --------------      ----------------         ---------------

  Net unrealized appreciation.......   $       11,109     $       26,050      $        274,112         $        58,110
                                       ==============     ==============      ================         =============== 
- ------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------ 
</TABLE>

(7)  LINE OF CREDIT

     The Trust participates with other funds managed by Wright in a line of
credit with a bank which allows the funds to borrow up to $20,000,000
collectively. The line of credit consists of a $10,000,000 committed facility
and a $10,000,000 uncommitted facility. Interest is charged to each Portfolio
based on its borrowings, at a rate equal to the bank's base rate. In addition,
the Portfolios pay a fee computed at a rate of 1/4 of 1% on any borrowings in
excess of $10,000,000. The Portfolios did not have any significant borrowings
outstanding under the line of credit during the year ended December 31, 1995.

                                       42
<PAGE>
 
                        INDEPENDENT  AUDITORS'  REPORT



To the Trustees and Shareholders of
The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust:


We have audited the accompanying statements of assets and liabilities, including
the portfolios of investments, of The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust (the
"Trust") (comprising, respectively, the Wright Near Term Bond Portfolio, Wright
Total Return Bond Portfolio, Wright Selected Blue Chip Portfolio and Wright
International Blue Chip Portfolio series) as of December 31, 1995, the related
statements of operations for the year then ended, the statements of changes in
net assets for the years ended December 31, 1995 and 1994, and the financial
highlights (see pages 3-6 in the Prospectus) for each of the years in the three-
year period ended December 31, 1995. These financial statements and financial
highlights are the responsibility of the Trust's management. Our responsibility
is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial highlights
based on our audits.

We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain
reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements and financial
highlights are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a
test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial
statements. Our procedures included confirmation of the securities owned at
December 31, 1995, by correspondence with the custodian and brokers. An audit
also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates
made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement
presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our
opinion.

In our opinion, such financial statements and financial highlights present
fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the above respective
Portfolios constituting The Wright Managed Blue Chip Series Trust as of December
31, 1995, the results of their operations, the changes in their net assets, and
their financial highlights for the respective stated periods in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles.

DELOITTE & TOUCHE LLP
Boston, Massachusetts
February 2, 1996

                                       43
<PAGE>
 
                                   APPENDIX

                              -------------------

Wright Quality Ratings


     Wright Quality Ratings provide a means by which Wright evaluates certain
fundamental criteria for the measurement of the quality of an issuer's
securities.

     Each rating is based on 32 individual measures of quality which can be
grouped into four components: (1) Investment Acceptance, (2) Financial Strength,
(3) Profitability and Stability, and (4) Growth. The total rating is three
letters and a numeral. The three letters measure (1) Investment Acceptance, (2)
Financial Strength, and (3) Profitability and Stability. Each letter reflects a
composite measurement of eight individual standards which are summarized as A:
Outstanding, B: Excellent, C: Good, D: Fair, L: Limited, and N: Not Rated. The
numeral rating reflects Growth and is a composite of eight individual standards
ranging from 0 to 20.


Equity Securities


     Investment Acceptance reflects the acceptability of a security by and its
marketability among investors, and the liquidity of the market for such
securities.

     Financial Strength represents the amount, adequacy and liquidity of the
corporation's resources in relation to current and potential requirements.  Its
principal components are aggregate equity and total capital, the ratio of
invested equity capital to debt, the adequacy of net working capital, its fixed
charges coverage ratio and other appropriate criteria.

     Profitability and Stability measures the record of a corporation's
management in terms of (1) the rate and consistency of the net return on
shareholders' equity capital investment at corporate book value, and (2) the
profits or losses of the corporation during generally adverse economic periods,
including its ability to withstand adverse financial developments.

     Growth measures the growth per common share of the corporation's equity
capital, earnings, and dividends, rather than the corporation's overall growth
of revenues and income.

     These ratings are determined by specific quantitative formulae.  A
distinguishing characteristic of these ratings is that The Wright Investment
Committee must review and accept each rating.  The Committee may reduce a
computed rating of any company, but may not increase it.

                                       44
<PAGE>
 
Debt Securities


     Wright ratings for commercial paper, corporate bonds and bank certificates
of deposit consist of the two central positions of the four position
alphanumeric corporate equity rating. The two central positions represent those
factors which are particularly relevant to fixed income and reserve investments.

     The first letter rating of the Wright four-part alphanumeric corporate
rating is not included in the ratings of fixed income securities since it
primarily reflects the adequacy of the floating supply of the company's common
shares for the investment of substantial funds. The numeric growth rating is not
included because this element is identified only with equity investments.


A-1 and P-1 Commercial Paper Ratings
by Standard & Poor's and Moody's


     A Standard & Poor's Commercial Paper Rating is a current assessment of the
likelihood of timely payment of debt having an original maturity of no more than
365 days. 

     'A': Issues assigned this highest rating are regarded as having the
greatest capacity for timely payment. Issues in this category are delineated
with the numbers 1, 2, and 3 to indicate the relative degree of safety. The 
'A-1' designation indicates that the degree of safety regarding timely payment
is either overwhelming or very strong. Those issues determined to possess
overwhelming safety characteristics will be denoted with a plus (+) sign
designation.

     Issuers (or related supporting institutions) rated P-1 by Moody's have a
superior capacity for repayment of short-term promissory obligations.  P-1
repayment capacity will normally be evidenced by the following characteristics:

     -- Leading market positions in well-established industries.           

     -- High rates of return on funds employed.                            

     -- Conservative capitalization structures with moderate reliance on debt 
        and ample asset protection.

     -- Broad margins in earnings coverage of fixed financial charges and high
        internal cash generation.

     -- Well-established access to a range of financial markets and assured 
        sources of alternate liquidity. 

                                       45
<PAGE>
 
     The commercial paper rating is not a recommendation to purchase or sell a
security.  The ratings are based on current information furnished to Standard &
Poor's by the issuer or obtained from other sources it considers reliable.  The
ratings may be changed, suspended or withdrawn as a result of changes in or
unavailability of such information.


Bond Ratings

     In addition to Wright quality ratings, bonds or bond insurers may be
expected to have credit risk ratings assigned by the two major rating companies,
Moody's and Standard & Poor's. Moody's uses a nine-symbol system with Aaa being
the highest rating and C the lowest. Standard & Poor's uses a 10-symbol system
that ranges from AAA to D. Bonds within the top four categories of Moody's (Aaa,
Aa, A, and Baa) and of Standard & Poor's (AAA, AA, A, and BBB) are considered to
be of investment-grade quality. Only the top three grades are acceptable for the
taxable Income Funds and only the top two grades are acceptable for the tax-free
Income Funds. Note that both Standard & Poor's and Moody's currently give their
highest rating to issuers insured by the American Municipal Bond Assurance
Corporation (AMBAC) or by the Municipal Bond Investors Assurance Corporation
(MBIA).

     Bonds rated A by Standard & Poor's have a strong capacity to pay principal
and interest, although they are somewhat more susceptible to the adverse effects
of change in circumstances and economic conditions than debt in higher-rated
categories. The rating of AA is accorded to issues where the capacity to pay
principal and interest is very strong and they differ from AAA issues only in
small degree. The AAA rating indicates an extremely strong capacity to pay
principal and interest.

     Bonds rated A by Moody's are judged by Moody's to possess many favorable
investment attributes and are considered as upper medium grade obligations.
Bonds rated Aa by Moody's are judged by Moody's to be of high quality by all
standards. Together with the Aaa group they comprise what are generally known as
high-grade bonds. They are rated lower than Aaa bonds because margins of
protection may not be as large or fluctuations of protective elements may be of
greater degree or there may be other elements present which make the long-term
risks appear somewhat larger. Bonds rated Aaa by Moody's are judged to be of the
best quality. Interest payments are protected by a large or by an exceptionally
stable margin and principal is secure. While the various protective elements are
likely to change, such changes as can be visualized are most unlikely to impair
the fundamentally strong position of such issuers.

                                       46
<PAGE>
 
                      This Page Intentionally Left Blank.

                                       47


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission